Quarterlytics / Technology / Semiconductors / Nanoco Group plc

Nanoco Group plc

nano · LSE Technology
Claim this profile
Ticker nano
Exchange LSE
Sector Technology
Industry Semiconductors
Employees 51-200
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Nanoco Group plc
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Annual Report 
and Accounts 2024

Nanoco is a market leader in the 
research, development, licensing 
and large scale manufacture of novel 
nanomaterials for use in a wide range 
of commercial applications
About us
Our platform technology is used to design and 
manufacture bespoke nanomaterials. This means 
that they can be custom made for our customers 
and specific end-use applications.
Our leading-edge R&D team exploits both the 
emissive and absorptive properties of the materials 
we design. These are critical properties in electronics 
markets for sensing, imaging and display uses.
Our CFQD® quantum dots are free of the toxic 
cadmium which many of our competitors and display 
manufacturers still use today despite the ban in 
European RoHS legislation.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 001
Revenue
£7.9m
+40%
Adjusted EBITDA1
£1.2m
+175%
1	 See page 31 for reconciliation.
Billings2
£61.0m
-3%
2	 See page 30 for reconciliation.
Cash
£20.3m
+147%
Our year in brief
Strategic report
Contents
2024 put Nanoco on a firm financial and operational footing with a series of targeted investments in new capabilities 
while returning significant capital to shareholders.
	
| Fulfilled first ever commercial production orders for two 
different first generation materials for use in infra-red 
sensing applications.
	
| Commenced two-year Joint Development Agreement 
(“JDA”) with ST Microelectronics to optimise the performance 
of a second generation sensing material. Post year end, this 
programme has been cancelled by the customer. However, 
Nanoco will continue to invest resources in this material.
	
| Commenced two-year JDA with Asian chemical customer 
to optimise another different second generation 
sensing material.
	
| Completed major investment and fit out of new device and 
analytical testing facility at our Runcorn base in Cheshire, UK.
	
| All operations accredited to ISO 14001 Environmental 
Management Systems, a key customer requirement.
	
| Post year end, we have brought in an experienced CEO, 
and during the year, appointed two new independent 
Non-Executives with significant experience in consumer 
electronics markets.
	
| Second and final tranche of litigation proceeds (net £58.8 million) 
received from Samsung after settling last year on a no-fault 
basis for the alleged infringement of the group’s IP, including 
a net foreign exchange gain of £1.8 million compared to 
spot rates on the date of receipt.
	
| Completed tender offer at a 25.1% premium to the closing 
mid-market price per ordinary share on the day before the 
tender was announced to return £30.0 million to shareholders 
following receipt of the second tranche of the litigation proceeds.
	
| Commenced broker managed market buy-back to return 
a further £3.0 million to shareholders, completed post 
year end. 
For more on Nanoco, visit our new website: 
www.nanocotechnologies.com
Strategic report
Our year in brief
001
Nanoco at a glance
002
Chairman’s statement
005
Operational Review
009
Our markets 
016
Leveraging our IP
018
Revenue streams
020
Section 172(1) statement
021
Our business model
024
Our strategy
026
Our key performance indicators
028
Financial review
030
Principal risks and uncertainties
033
Viability statement
036
Sustainability report
038
TCFD disclosure 2024
048
Corporate governance
Board of Directors
050
Corporate governance statement
052
Nominations Committee report
062
Audit Committee report
065
Remuneration Committee report
070
Directors’ remuneration report
073
Directors’ report
089
Statement of Directors’ 
responsibilities in respect 
of the financial statements
092
Financial statements
Independent auditors’ report to 
the members of Nanoco Group plc
093
Consolidated statement 
of comprehensive income
098
Consolidated statement of changes 
in equity
099
Company statement of changes
in equity
099
Group and Company statements 
of financial position
100
Group and Company 
cash flow statements
101
Notes to the financial statements
102
Investor information
132

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
002
We design, develop, scale 
up and manufacture novel 
nanomaterials for use in a wide 
range of potential applications
Our core competencies
	
| We custom design bespoke 
nanomaterials to exploit 
emission, absorption and 
other properties
	
| Our materials can be 
used in a wide variety of 
commercial applications
	
| Continuous expansion of 
our portfolio of materials
	
| Scale up capability 
to move from laboratory 
to industrial scale
	
| ISO-certified, low cost 
in-house production 
facilities in Runcorn, UK
World-class talent
	
| At 31 July 2024, 
47 employees, of whom 
10 are inventors
	
| 13 staff with PhDs
	
| 4 nationalities of staff: 
British, German, Indian 
and Italian
Respected globally
	
| International partnerships 
with global players from US 
to Europe to Asia
	
| R&D, scale up and twin 
production facilities all 
located in Runcorn, UK
	
| Customers operate in 
multi-billion dollar markets 
with a wide range of 
applications for our materials
1	 Source – Infinity Business Insights Global Quantum Dot Market, Forecast to 2030.
Nanoco at a glance
Why invest in Nanoco?
Platform technology gives access to a wide range of large and rapidly growing end markets with our focus currently on consumer 
electronics, Internet of Things, automotive and multiple display devices.
QD materials market valued at
$10.5bn
1
by 2030
IP enabling QD displays
Large and defensible IP portfolio
366
patents granted or pending
Significant manufacturing scale
500m+
devices per annum can be enabled 
through our production capacity
Display
$13.1bn
addressable market by c.20301
	
| CFQD® film
	
| QD on micro-LED
	
| Electro-luminescence
SWIR imaging
$2.9bn
addressable market by c.20301
	
| Consumer electronics
	
| Automotive applications
	
| Internet of Things
World’s leading display 
company has taken 
a licence over Nanoco IP

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 003
What are nanomaterials 
and what is a quantum dot?
Nanomaterials are any material that has a dimension or structure measured at the 
nanoscale, typically 10,000 to 100,000 times narrower than human hair (1–100 nm). 
Nanomaterials have unique optical, electrical and mechanical properties often not 
accessible in the bulk material. This can enhance properties such as light absorption, 
emission, strength, reactivity and conductivity.
Quantum dots are a subclass of nanomaterials whose optical and electronic 
properties depend on their size, shape and composition.
10-12 m
Cosmic rays
Visible light
Infra-red
Gamma rays
X-rays
IR
Microwaves
Radar
Radio
Broadcast
Long wavelengths
Short wavelengths
UV
10-9 m
10-6 m
10-3 m
1 m
103 m
1 km
1 m
1 mm
1,000 nm
1 nm
400 nm
600 nm
800 nm
1,000 nm
1,200 nm
1,400 nm
1,600 nm
1,800 nm
Display applications
(400–800 nm)
In the visible region, the emissive 
properties of QDs have revolutionised 
the display industry. The efficiency 
and nature of quantum dots leads 
to ultra-pure colour emission. This 
leads to enhanced display and 
lighting applications. 
NIR
(800–1,000 nm) 
Quantum dots can both emit and 
absorb very pure light, the latter of 
which can be exploited for sensors. 
Traditionally, very expensive InGaAs 
sensors have been used. QDs can 
be combined with cheap silicon 
CMOS image sensors to extend the 
spectral range of silicon. In the NIR, 
applications include facial 
recognition and night vision.
SWIR
(1,000–2,000 nm) 
Beyond the NIR, by selecting the correct size of 
quantum dots, the spectral range of CMOS image 
sensors can be extended into the SWIR at a much 
lower cost than InGaAs detectors. Potential 
applications in this region are wide ranging, with 
the ability to see through water vapour and fog 
enabling LiDAR, while skin penetration in the SWIR 
is being explored for security applications such 
as anti-spoofing, as well as the development 
of novel optical diagnostic techniques.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
004
Our core markets of sensing 
and display are forecast to 
experience rapid growth
Sensing
Yole Intelligence forecasts growth in SWIR 
imaging from $322 million in 2022 to $2.9 billion in 
2028. This is expected to be driven by emerging 
markets in consumer electronics and automotive.
The CMOS imaging sensor market is forecast 
to increase from revenues of $21.3 billion in 2022 
to $28.8 billion in 2028.
Display
Infinity business insights estimates 
the quantum dot display market was 
valued at $3.2 billion in 2022 and is 
projected to reach $13.1 billion by 2030, 
at a CAGR of 19.9%.
$2.9bn
SWIR camera market 
forecast for 2028
$13.1bn
Quantum dot display market 
forecast for 2030
$28.8bn
CMOS imaging sensor market 
forecast for 2028

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 005
Chairman’s statement
Overview
This has been another important year 
for Nanoco. We delivered our first ever 
commercial production orders while 
commencing significant new development 
projects with two global electronics players. 
The receipt of the second tranche of the 
Samsung litigation proceeds has allowed 
us to make a significant return of capital 
to shareholders while retaining sufficient 
cash to secure the group’s 
medium‑term future.
Our European customer’s decision after 
the year end to focus on other larger 
short-term opportunities was clearly 
disappointing. This decision came after 
our technology had been proven and 
there remain meaningful, albeit smaller, 
commercial opportunities for Nanoco 
to pursue directly in the short to medium 
term. We have announced a reduction 
in our staffing levels and plans to 
progressively reduce the size and cost 
of the Board to match our new 
activity levels.
Our focus now is on the prudent use of 
those retained funds to drive forward our 
efforts to commercialise our technology 
across a wider range of customers and 
potential applications in our chosen 
markets of sensing and display. The 
expansion of our Runcorn facility to 
create our new device fab is one such 
investment that will rapidly accelerate 
new product development and enhance 
customer outreach. We are also significantly 
increasing our future-focused business 
development spend.
Commercial strategy
The Board has a clear vision for Nanoco’s 
trading business. Underpinned by our IP, 
we aspire to be the “go-to” manufacturer 
of quantum dots for a variety of 
applications and markets. By focusing on 
our core competencies, we play to our 
key strengths while ensuring that we 
understand enough about the full 
device stacks to be a credible and 
trusted supply chain partner to some 
of the world’s largest companies. Our 
sensing materials can provide significant 
improvements over existing technologies 
at a competitive price point while our 
display materials offer performance and 
clear environmental benefits over highly 
toxic, cadmium-based quantum dots. 
We will continue to add to our IP assets 
– the value of which was amply proven 
in the litigation with Samsung – and to 
defend it vigorously. 
Group strategy to realise value
This commercial strategy goes hand in 
hand with the Board’s strategy for the 
group to deliver value for shareholders, 
which was outlined to shareholders on 
3 October 2024. 
The Board is strongly of the view that 
there are significant organic commercial 
applications for Nanoco’s technology 
across a range of markets that will 
generate value for the business 
over time.
Summary
	
| Fulfilled first ever commercial 
production orders for two different 
first generation materials for use 
in infra-red sensing applications.
	
| Commenced two-year Joint 
Development Agreements (“JDA”) 
with the Asian chemical customer 
to optimise the performance of 
second generation sensing materials.
	
| Completed fit out of new device 
and analytical testing facility at 
our Runcorn base in Cheshire, UK.
	
| Second and final tranche of 
litigation proceeds (net £58.8 million) 
received from Samsung, including 
a net foreign exchange gain of 
£1.8 million compared to spot rates 
on the date of translation.
	
| Completed £30.0 million tender 
offer. Started £3 million buy-back.
Post year end
	
| Completed £3 million broker 
managed buy-back.
	
| Post-year-end restructure 
underway following contract 
termination by European customer.
	
| Outlined new strategy to minimise 
costs, divest the group’s operating 
business and return surplus cash 
to shareholders.
	
| Appointed Dmitry Shashkov as 
Chief Executive Officer to lead new 
strategy and deliver value from 
operating business.
A clear strategy to 
maximise value and 
deliver returns to 
shareholders
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
006
Group strategy to realise value 
(continued)
Pursuing these commercial and licence 
opportunities will require investment and 
the maintenance of critical technology 
and commercial capabilities. The Board 
is confident that the group can succeed 
in pursuing these commercial objectives 
with the appropriate investment of money 
and time. The Board believes that it is 
now prudent to consider if this growth 
and investment would be best led in a 
different ownership setting than allowed 
for as the sole business of a listed group. 
The Board has concluded that it is in the 
group’s best interests to appoint advisers 
to review the options for the group’s 
business and assets, including the 
potential for a sale of the trading 
business (including IP).
With this in mind, post period end, we 
took steps to rationalise the group’s cost 
base. This includes reducing headcount, 
reducing the cost and size of the Board 
during FY25 and reducing non-critical 
operating costs across the group.
Once complete, these measures will 
reduce the group’s annualised cash 
cost base by £2.6 million (or 34%) on 
a like-for-like basis compared to the 
Q4 FY24 run rate, with an associated, 
one-off, cash restructuring cost of 
just over £0.1 million.
The Board is determined to deliver 
shareholder value as rapidly as possible. 
In light of the plans set out above, the 
Board believes that it is now appropriate 
to make plans to return surplus cash to 
shareholders during the course of FY25. 
The timing and size of further returns 
of surplus cash will be contingent on 
the completion of the right-sizing noted 
above, working capital needs and 
progress on the execution of a potential 
sale process.
Our people
Nanoco benefits from an exceptional 
group of staff, who have come to 
Runcorn from many countries to build 
our exceptional technology capability. 
Our staff are focused on delivering the 
focused tasks we set for them. We are 
repaying that commitment by further 
investments in learning and 
development opportunities.
This was recognised when Nanoco was 
featured in the prestigious Sunday Times 
Best Places to Work 2024 award in the 
Small Organisations category.
Sustainability and ESG strategy
The Board is committed to the promotion 
and achievement of environmental, social 
and governance objectives within the 
context of a small, listed group. During 
the year, we achieved the important 
milestone of ISO 14001 Environmental 
Management Systems accreditation, 
a key criterion from our customers. 
We are now pursuing accreditation to 
ISO 45001 Occupational Health and 
Safety Management Systems. We have 
also appointed an ESG steering committee 
represented at Board level by Liam Gray, 
our CFO.
Governance
We remain committed to the highest 
standards of corporate governance 
and we comply with all of the provisions 
of the UK Corporate Governance Code 
as outlined on page 57.
Return of capital
We have now completed the promised 
£33.0 million return of capital to shareholders. 
This represents just under half of the total 
equity raised by the Company since its 
founding in 2001. This has resulted in the 
cancellation of just over 128 million shares 
(40% of the equity in issue prior to the 
return of capital). A further 13.8 million 
shares are held in the Employee Benefit 
Trust to meet future obligations arising 
from the group’s employee share plans, 
mitigating any future dilution.
As outlined above, the Board is 
determined to deliver shareholder value 
as rapidly as possible. The timing and 
size of further returns of surplus cash will 
be contingent on the completion of the 
right-sizing noted above, working capital 
needs, progress on the execution of a 
potential sale process and the 
availability of distributable reserves. 
Board and Annual General Meeting
We have further strengthened the 
Board with the addition in the second 
half of the year of two new Independent 
Non‑Executive Directors, Dieter May and 
Dr Jalal Bagherli. Dieter and Jalal add 
significant experience in the group’s 
key target markets of industrial and 
consumer electronics markets.
In July 2024, CEO Brian Tenner advised 
the Board of his intention to leave the 
group to pursue new opportunities.
Chairman’s statement continued
We are increasing our 
pipeline of commercial 
engagements to a 
broader range of 
potential customers.”

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 007
Brian led the group through a period 
of significant change that delivered a 
multi disciplinary team based in Runcorn, 
a successful outcome to the Samsung 
litigation and financial stability. 
As outlined above, Dmitry Shashkov took 
up the post of CEO post period end. 
And finally, after nine years with Nanoco, 
I will not be putting myself forward for 
re‑election at the upcoming AGM. Dr Jalal 
Bagherli has agreed to take over the role 
of Chairperson from the next AGM.
Requisitioned General Meeting
Ahead of the Annual General Meeting to 
be held in January 2025, the Company 
has received a requisition from The 
Milkwood Fund to appoint two of their 
representatives to the Nanoco Board of 
Directors. This general meeting is to be 
held at 11.30 am on 13 December 2024, 
and further details are included on the 
Nanoco website. The Nanoco Board do 
not believe this is in the interest of all 
shareholders, and firmly believe 
shareholders should vote against both 
resolutions. It is a point of deep frustration 
that we find ourselves once again having 
to defend shareholders’ cash against an 
activist acting in their own interests.
Dividends
No dividend is proposed for the year 
(2023: none). 
Outlook
The Board is highly confident in the 
inherent value and commercial potential 
of our technology, IP and trading business. 
A balance needs to be struck, in the interests 
of all of its shareholders, between supporting 
this growth and prudence with regard to 
risk, to preserve cash and to take a highly 
disciplined approach to investment.
We have concluded that it is in the 
group’s best interests to appoint CDX 
Advisors to review the options for the 
group’s trading business, IP and other 
assets, including the potential for a sale 
of these assets.
While this process will be undertaken at 
pace, the group’s considerable financial 
resources mean that the trading business 
will continue to be supported to grow 
and not compromise its potential.
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024
Our industrial capacity positions us 
well to benefit from any widespread 
adoption of quantum dots in 
commercial applications whilst our 
validated IP creates a strong barrier 
to entry to the industry.”

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
008
Our investment in our 
device R&D facility has 
enabled quicker feedback 
on product development
At Nanoco, we are prototyping 
QD‑based short wavelength infra-red 
(“SWIR”) sensors using tools capable of 
handling 200 mm wafers. It is currently 
feasible to fabricate SWIR sensors on 
ROIC CMOS wafers within one month 
for prototyping purposes.
QD-based image sensors offer several 
advantageous and unique features. 
One key benefit is the customisable 
wavelength response, achieved by 
selecting specific quantum dot sizes 
and material systems. These sensors 
also support monolithic integration, 
as the direct processing onto the CMOS 
wafer surface eliminates the need for 
hybridisation, reducing both cost and 
complexity. Additionally, the pixel 
dimensions and density are scalable, 
with the primary limitations being set by 
the resolution of the underlying CMOS 
process, allowing for flexible adaptation 
to various imaging needs.
The device facility is equipped with a 
range of advanced tools for thin film 
deposition and device fabrication. 
The facility includes thin film deposition 
systems capable of handling substrates 
up to 200 mm, allowing for versatile 
material deposition across various 
substrate sizes. Among the key tools 
is an Atomic Layer Deposition (“ALD”) 
system, which provides atomic-level 
control for thin film coating, essential for 
achieving precise, conformal layers in 
advanced devices. The facility houses 
both thermal and e-beam evaporators, 
supporting material deposition for 
multiple applications, ensuring flexibility 
in the fabrication process. A specialised 
glove box, equipped with a spin coater, 
is designed for quantum dot (“QD”) ink 
formulation, enabling contamination-free 
processing on substrates up to 200 mm 
in size. This setup is crucial for handling 
sensitive materials in a controlled 
environment. Electrical characterisation 
is performed using a manual probe 
system for IV testing, which is integrated 
with an LED and heater, enabling detailed 
IV characterisation of devices under 
varying thermal and lighting conditions, 
also accommodating substrates up 
to 200 mm. To ensure the quality and 
uniformity of thin films, the facility is 
equipped with an advanced ellipsometer, 
which provides accurate thickness 
measurements and optical characterisations. 
This comprehensive setup supports 
the development and optimisation of 
cutting-edge devices, ensuring high 
quality output across various stages 
of fabrication.
Synthesis of quantum dot
Nanoco capability
Standard CMOS 
fabrication of 
image sensor Read 
Out Integrated 
Circuit (“ROICs”)
Image sensor 
packaging and 
camera assembly
Al2O3 by ALD
Device lab
Device fabrication 
equipment
TEM image of QDs
AZO (TCO) by ALD
ZnO by ALD
MoOx by thermal 
evaporation
Fabrication of photo sensor 
layers on CMOS wafer
Encapsulation
Top contact
Hole transporting layer (“HTL”)
QD (depending on wavelength)
Electron transporting layer (“ETL”)
Si ROIC (CMOS) provided by customer
SWIR stack on Si CMOS ROIC

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 009
Operational Review
The Nanoco team worked throughout the 
year to develop novel nanomaterials for 
use in sensing and display applications 
for a number of customers. We met every 
technical specification required as part 
of the work programmes that commenced 
H1 FY24 and are looking at other 
opportunities to apply our technology.
We have continued to invest in our 
capabilities with our new device team 
and facility, and this allows us to 
understand more about the impact of 
changes to our quantum dot chemistry 
on sensors. This shortened feedback 
loop will reduce the time required to 
develop new products in generation 
2 and generation 3 infra-red sensing 
materials. The associated ability to 
demonstrate device performance to 
potential customers will significantly 
strengthen our commercial outreach.
The case for the use of quantum dots 
in new generations of displays and the 
multitude of potential infra-red sensing 
applications continues to grow. This 
remains true in sensing despite the 
setback in the European customer 
deciding to focus their own efforts away 
from QD-enabled CMOS sensors. Growing 
investment by major players in display 
technology development and M&A 
activity in both sectors reinforces this 
growing commercial interest.
The case for the use of quantum 
dots in new generations of displays 
and the multitude of potential 
infra-red sensing applications 
continues to grow
Business performance
Electronics
We successfully delivered two sensing 
materials for low volume commercial 
production with our European customer 
in H1 FY24. Critically, this is the first time 
in our history that we have had a product 
in commercial production. The subsequent 
decision by the European customer to 
withdraw from the QD CMOS sensing market 
was no reflection on the effectiveness of 
Nanoco’s technology but instead reflected 
their own commercial focus on larger 
short-term business priorities.
There remain a number of other routes 
to market for Nanoco’s first generation 
sensing materials in a range of niche 
markets that are attractive to a group 
of our size and scale. As previously 
announced, the size of the next production 
orders for our first generation materials 
is likely to be modest in scale, enabling 
potentially a few million devices. This is 
typical of many new technologies initial 
use cases and is expected to grow over 
time if and when end users adopt the 
technology. Some initial market feedback 
indicates reluctance among some 
electronics companies to incorporate 
lead-based products in their supply 
chains. This is not true of all potential 
customers and markets so first generation 
materials still have a viable 
commercial future.
This situation does, however, emphasise 
the importance of the development 
programmes that Nanoco is delivering 
for lead-free materials. These new materials 
should also result in significantly higher 
performance (speed, response times) 
and the ability to be used in more 
demanding applications such as 
automotive where first generation 
materials struggle to meet the required 
operating temperature.
Turning to those second generation 
sensing products, prior to the termination 
of the JDA with the European electronics 
customer, we had achieved all development 
milestones as part of our two-year 
development project. This now includes 
the incorporation of quantum dots onto 
silicon wafers within Nanoco’s device 
facility. We intend to self-fund the final 
development steps to get this material 
ready for scale up because of its exceptional 
performance. We also achieved all 
technical milestones for our major 
Asian chemical customer as part of our 
two-year development programme for 
a different second generation material 
for use in infra-red sensing. We have 
also fulfilled some smaller orders for 
this customer of different materials.
Christopher Richards
Chairman

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
010
As shown in the infographic on page 15, 
our offering of nanomaterials for use in 
sensing applications continues to progress 
from a single customer/single product 
offering in early 2018 to a position today 
where we are engaged with multiple 
customers and are working with many 
distinct materials and wavelength 
combinations. The infographic also 
shows the advancing position of a 
number of materials as they move 
through the steps from development 
towards final validation – the last step 
before commercial production orders 
are placed.
Display (CFQD® quantum dots)
Display materials remain a key focus for 
Nanoco. Our analysis divides the market 
into existing display technologies and 
nascent display technologies. The former 
includes QD film (whether the QDs are in 
a barrier film sandwich or an extruded 
product) and QD-OLED. Independent 
market research continues to support 
Business performance continued
Electronics continued
We are adapting our approach to 
commercial business development by 
engaging with a wider range of smaller 
players in the sensing markets. We retain 
the capacity to service mass market 
applications and are supplementing that 
with a service offering for smaller but still 
attractive niche markets. Adoption of our 
technology in smaller niche markets will 
provide valuable proof points on the 
journey towards our overarching goal 
of mass market adoption in consumer 
electronics applications. Visibility on the 
size and ramp up in any demand for our 
materials is inevitably limited, as is the 
case for any new material awaiting 
mass market adoption.
a growing share of quantum dot 
technology in these early generation 
display technologies where consumer 
and environmental concerns mean that 
cadmium-free solutions are sometimes 
preferred (source: Omdia, TDR).
In early generation QD displays, the 
opportunity for Nanoco primarily relates 
to licensing opportunities as opposed to 
commercial supply. These displays are of 
lower commercial supply interest for two 
primary reasons: firstly cadmium-based 
solutions continue to dominate the 
market despite the impending RoHS 
limits and secondly because of the 
strategy pursued by a number of market 
participants in commoditising what 
should be a premium product in mass 
markets (ultimately leading to their 
own financial difficulties). For Nanoco, 
interest in supply agreements for early 
generation displays is now focused on 
niche applications where quality, IP 
protection and a lack of toxicity can 
attract premium pricing.
Operational Review continued
The graphics below show a sample of the wide range of potential 
applications for NIR and SWIR technologies in electronics supply chains.
Quality control
ADAS
Fog/smog
Iris recognition
Agriculture
Surveillance
We delivered all of the 
challenging technical 
milestones set by our 
customers for our high 
performing nanomaterials.”
Consumer device use of 
cameras and imagers
Consumer device 
use of imagers
$650m
$322m
$2,900m
2022
2028
Consumer device
use of imagers
$97m

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
011
The nascent display technologies which 
have now been demonstrated at various 
trade shows and which are attracting 
significant investment include the use of 
quantum dots in micro-LED devices and 
in electro-luminescent devices. The 
application of quantum dots to micro‑LEDs 
for small screen devices, such as smart 
watches or phones, is an area of growing 
focus for a number of companies. In such 
applications, the volume of quantum 
dots, as a ratio to the area covered, is 
significantly higher than in a film for a 
television. So, while the end devices may 
be smaller, this is partly compensated 
for by the higher concentration required. 
The group has completed some initial 
development work and is supplying 
the resultant material to a number of 
customers, including a global capital 
equipment manufacturer.
These nascent technologies are of much 
greater potential interest to Nanoco for a 
number of reasons:
	
| our IP is equally relevant to the 
production of quantum dots for 
these technologies;
	
| the density of active material required 
is much higher (more quantum dots);
	
| the quantum dots in these 
applications are eliminating other 
layers needed in the stacks in the first 
generation technologies – meaning 
the value add is much higher allowing 
a premium price for an IP backed 
premium product; and
	
| the likely timeline to commercialisation 
of these new display technologies fits 
strongly with RoHS requirements, 
which should reduce the temptation 
to detour via cadmium-based systems.
Our routes to revenue generation are 
therefore still threefold in display:
	
| development services for new materials;
	
| supply of consistent high quality 
materials from our Runcorn facility 
which can be easily expanded; and
	
| the licensing of our IP that protects 
our unique scale up process for the 
mass market production of cadmium-
free nanomaterials.
In the post-year-end restructuring 
necessitated by the end of the sensing 
project with our European customer, we 
are being careful to maintain these core 
capabilities to service the display markets 
and retain our potential revenue sources. 
We will continue to adopt a dual approach 
to commercial exploitation of our display 
materials, whether through licensing or 
material supply from our own 
manufacturing capability.
Market developments
The Board recognises that the adoption 
of nanomaterial technology has taken 
longer than expected for both Nanoco 
and its competitors, creating commercial 
challenges for Nanoco and leading to 
terminal financial distress for other market 
participants. Development cycles tend to 
be long because the whole supply chain 
often needs to be re‑engineered on top 
of developing new materials with every 
Addressable display market for Nanoco CFQD® and IP 
set to rise from ~6% to ~34% of the total TV market
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
Millions of TVs
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
 Non-QD 
 Samsung QD TVs 
 Other QD TVs
step of the process subject to stringent 
testing. One of the advantages of the 
sensing and display materials that 
Nanoco specialises in is that the material 
represents an extra layer in a pre-existing 
material stack or is actually removing 
cost from existing supply chains (and 
hence adding value).
Our small scale allows us to be much 
more agile and responsive to our customers 
when compared to our competitors. The 
in-depth nature of our technological 
insight also means that we do tend to 
“punch above our weight” in terms of 
direct engagement with very large end 
customers and their technology teams. 
Reaching final product validation for 
two novel nanomaterials within six years 
demonstrates Nanoco’s clear ability to 
meet the exacting standards of consumer 
electronics applications in a relatively 
short timeframe. Of course, the downside 
to this situation is that our small scale 
and position in the supply chain mean 
that we are inevitably exposed to customer 
concentration risk and have lower visibility 
of demand that we would like. We leverage 
our expertise and IP in negotiating 
commercial terms to mitigate some 
of these supply chain risks.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
012
Operations
We have invested significantly in our 
capabilities in the year, with the new 
device facility costing £1.2 million, with 
the vast majority of the second-hand 
equipment being heavily discounted 
from cost “as new”. As mentioned 
previously, this strategic investment 
significantly reduces the duration of the 
feedback loop on the impact of changes 
in our chemistry on the devices. A process 
which used to take circa three months 
now takes one week. This is critical as 
long-term success in developing new 
materials is driven by the number of 
new reactions and recipes that can 
be run in a period of time. This new 
capability can be applied to various 
generations of our technology, and 
we have complete freedom to operate 
the facility with any customer.
During the year, and in line with our 
investment in our quality management 
systems, we implemented electronic 
batch recording and line side systems 
to match our position in important 
electronics supply chains. This, along 
with some other improvements, has 
ensured we can meet and have been 
accredited to ISO 14001 Environmental 
Management Systems. This again 
demonstrates Nanoco’s position 
as a robust supply chain partner for 
electronic materials. This certification is 
often a fundamental requirement of our 
electronics customers before they will 
even consider signing a supply contract.
Leveraging intellectual property
We continue to proactively manage 
our IP portfolio to maximise value and 
protect our core competencies while 
carefully managing our IP maintenance 
spend. We finished the year with 366 
patents and patents pending (2023: 375). 
Our annual IP maintenance spend is 
approximately £0.2 million, which is a 
significant reduction from the figure of 
approximately £0.4 million in 2020.
We continue to preserve trade secrets 
and have targeted our financial resources 
on strategic areas such as infra-red 
sensing where there is a strong overlap 
with our pre-existing IP. These are also 
areas with clear future commercial 
opportunities and benefits to be had 
from holding high quality patents.
As we explained last year, to drive 
licensing value from an IP portfolio, any 
business needs firstly a “commanding IP 
portfolio” and secondly, a “deep and 
impacted market.” Our success in generating 
an IP licence with Samsung shows that 
we already have the first of these. The 
market for devices containing cadmium-
free quantum dots is growing in line with 
the low end of external market forecasts. 
However, new technologies using 
quantum dots, such as micro-LED and 
electro‑luminescence, are attracting 
significant investment and if successful 
in their own right will lead to an increase 
in demand for cadmium-free materials. 
Until such time as the market becomes 
attractive enough to pursue such 
opportunities, we will continue to 
proactively engage with parties who 
would benefit from sourcing material 
from Nanoco or having a licence over 
our IP. It is a frustrating but unavoidable 
fact that the economics of IP enforcement 
and licensing programmes strongly 
favour the infringer and not the patent 
holder. Even when it is clear that a 
company is likely to be infringing our IP, 
the cost of legal action is often prohibitive, 
especially when the likely infringer is a 
small competitor.
People and community
Our employees make Nanoco and have 
provided great service to our customers 
throughout the year by delivering high 
quality materials on time and achieving 
challenging milestones and deliverables 
in our development work.
Our Employee Voice Committee (“EVC”) 
has been very active throughout the year 
to support the group and all staff on 
matters of physical and mental wellbeing, 
relaying concerns to the Board and 
helping with our CSR activities. The EVC 
was instrumental in choosing Emmaus as 
our charity of choice for the forthcoming 
year. Emmaus is a charity local to Runcorn 
that focuses on supporting the homeless.
We continue to invest in our LEAN 
programme, with all staff trained on LEAN 
techniques to improve problem solving 
and quality control processes. All staff 
remain actively engaged on health and 
safety, with initiatives to improve our 
working environment and reduce the 
overall risk environment. We will continue 
to invest in further training and development 
for all staff as part of their career 
development and our staff retention 
aims. This includes general management 
training that feeds into succession planning.
Operational Review continued
We continue 
to strengthen our 
operational capabilities 
to assure our critical 
place in complex global 
supply chains for 
electronic devices.”

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
013
We have awarded a general cost of 
living increase for all staff for FY25 of 3% 
of salary (excluding the Executive Directors 
who are receiving 2.5%). In FY24, we 
implemented a workplace health 
programme for all staff that has an 
equivalent cost of 1% of salary. We also 
completed a further benchmarking 
exercise post year end, and we believe 
that all staff are now paid around 
median salaries or higher. All staff are 
also eligible to participate in the group’s 
Deferred Bonus Plan and Long Term 
Incentive Plan.
We will review other benefits options and 
further potential improvements to pension 
contributions as our financial situation 
improves and when the group becomes 
self-financing in its organic operations.
Post-year-end events and 
our response
We announced on 30 August that our 
European customer had decided to focus 
their priorities away from QD-enabled 
CMOS sensors and hence will not be 
placing any further orders for first 
generation sensing materials and have 
cancelled the development project for 
second generation sensing materials. 
The group continues to negotiate the 
final commercial compensation payable 
as a result of these actions, including the 
fate of potentially surplus customer assets. 
Nanoco now has complete freedom 
to operate with respect to all materials 
developed with the European customer 
(first and second generation). Nanoco 
is also now focusing directly on niche 
market opportunities that were too small 
to be of interest to our European customer 
but which can be meaningful for Nanoco. 
This will inevitably require an expansion 
of a “fabless” supply chain for Nanoco 
and efforts are already underway to 
replicate the previous supply chain.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
014
The Board has therefore appointed 
advisers (CDX Advisors LLC (“CDX”)) to 
review the options for the group’s trading 
business and assets (which include our IP), 
including a potential sale. To be clear, 
this is not a proposed sale of the whole 
group. Work with CDX has commenced 
with a view to achieving the best 
possible financial outcome and to secure 
the long-term future of the group’s IP and 
operations. This process will be 
undertaken at pace and the group’s 
considerable financial resources mean 
that the trading business will continue to 
be supported to grow and not 
compromise its potential.
The Board is highly confident in the 
potential of the business. A balance 
needs to be struck, in the interests of all 
of its shareholders, between supporting 
this growth and prudence with regard 
to risk, to preserve cash and to take a 
highly disciplined approach to 
investment. A successful outcome to the 
current activities to secure the long-term 
future of the trading business is intended 
to lead to a further return of capital 
to shareholders.
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024
Operational Review continued
Post-year-end events and our 
response continued
The lower activity levels that have 
resulted from the termination of the 
development agreement with the European 
customer have necessitated a review of 
our staffing levels and costs. We regrettably 
had to announce a consultation on the 
restructuring of the business that has 
seen twelve valued and trusted, highly 
skilled employees leave the business 
(27% of our workforce). A summary of 
the actions being taken includes:
	
| a reduction of approximately 27% of 
employees in the operating business;
	
| a planned reduction in the size of the 
Board over FY25;
	
| all Non-Executive Directors have 
agreed to defer at least 50% of their 
salaries until the earlier of either 
31 July 2025, their cessation as 
Directors, or a sale transaction 
of the underlying business;
	
| a switch of all Executive Director 
potential bonuses to being paid in 
options rather than cash;
	
| mothballing of equipment and, where 
possible, facilities to reduce the holding 
costs of critical capabilities; and
	
| a reduction in activity-based costs 
consequent with the reduction in 
activity levels.
The result of these actions is that the Q4 
FY25 cash cost run rate is expected to be 
approximately £2.6 million (34%) below 
the equivalent Q4 run rate in FY24.
Outlook
The Board is strongly of the view that 
there are significant organic commercial 
applications for Nanoco’s technology 
across a range of markets that will 
generate value for the business over 
time. Initial applications are likely to be 
in various niche markets that can deliver 
meaningful revenue for Nanoco in the 
short to medium term growing into mass 
market applications over time. The current 
collaboration with the Asian customer 
specifically targets mass market applications 
for a leading global sensing company. 
This assessment is based on growing 
market interest and participation in 
quantum dot technology in display and 
sensing markets. It also draws on direct 
customer feedback, independent expert 
technical analysis and the group’s own 
extensive knowledge.
The vast majority of long-term investors 
in the group are, like the Board, believers 
in the long-term inevitability of the adoption 
of quantum dots across a very broad range 
of commercial electronics applications. 
With validated products for sensing and 
display applications, a robust and valuable 
IP portfolio, leading-edge skills and 
capabilities in our talented staff and 
complex assets, and growing commercial 
interest in QD technology, it would be 
economic terrorism to abandon all of 
those valuable foundations.
That being said, the group’s trading 
business clearly remains in the scale up 
phase of business growth and is exposed 
to what can appear as binary decisions 
by a concentrated customer base of 
global players. The Board therefore 
believes that it is now prudent to consider 
if the growth and investment in the 
trading business and IP assets would be 
best led in a different ownership setting 
than allowed for as the sole business of 
a listed group given also the costs of the 
Company’s listing.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
015
Investment in new material sets this 
year has increased our customer 
reach for new applications leading 
to new R&D service income
< 1.0 µm
NIR
Development
Material
Wavelength
July 2023
Optimisation
Scale up
Validation
Production
1.0-1.3 µm
1.3-1.5 µm
SWIR
> 1.5 µm
NIR
SWIR
A
B
C
A
B
C
A
A
B
B
C
C
Sensing goals: one material in production, a second validated
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Continued development of our sensing portfolio

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
016
Significant potential for revenue 
generation from multiple 
commercial markets
Our markets
Independent market researcher Yole Group estimates 6.1% 
compound annual growth rate for complementary metal oxide 
semiconductor (“CMOS”) image sensors in the period to 2028 to 
reach approximately $30 billion1. During the same period, they 
forecast an increasing share of that market for 3D sensors 
and multi-spectral cameras where the performance of these 
devices can be significantly enhanced by the integration 
of quantum dots.
QD-enhanced CMOS sensors operating at short wave 
infra-red (“SWIR”) wavelengths are the most viable alternative 
to extremely expensive indium gallium arsenide (“InGaAs”) 
sensors for use in consumer electronics. According to Yole2, 
“Quantum dots appear to be the most well-positioned 
technology for potential integration in consumer devices”.
Yole predicts the adoption of SWIR technologies in high end 
mobile phones during 2026 and penetration to higher volume 
phones in 2028, helped by under-display capability (equivalent 
to 86% CAGR between 2026 and 2028 to reach $2.1 billion for 
3D sensing modules). This research is consistent with Nanoco’s 
view that initial use cases in 2024 will be for low volume applications 
outside mobile phones. Nanoco’s existing Runcorn production 
facility has capacity to produce sensing materials for hundreds 
of millions of CMOS sensors. The group’s position in the supply 
chain has contractual protection to mitigate the risk of a 
competitor becoming a major supplier to our European customer.
1	 “Yole” – Image Sensors Europe 2023.
2	 “Yole” – SWIR Imaging 2023, Market Technology Report.
Applications
Market forecast
Cameras and modules
Key
 Defence, aerospace 
and research
 Industry
 Medical
 Consumer
 Automotive
Source: Yole
Face/iris 
recognition
Quality control 
systems
Agricultural 
drones
Wearable 
diagnostics
$395m
+32%
CAGR 23-28
$19m
+41%
CAGR 26-28
$7m
+5%
CAGR 23-28
$6m
$2,074m
+86%
CAGR 26-28
ADAS
Security and 
surveillance
20
2
8 
$
2,
9
0
0
m
2
0
2
3
 
$
3
5
5
m
$405m
+10%
CAGR 23-28
$251m
$99m
Sensing markets

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
017
The current market for flat panel TVs is approximately 
250 million units per annum and is forecast to grow by 
a modest 1% per annum to 2030.
During the same period, the market share for displays 
containing quantum dots is forecast to grow from around 
20 million TVs (8% of the market in 2023) to around 37 million 
TVs by 2030 (14% of the forecast market). Based on a combination 
of market research and group estimates, the group estimates 
that approximately 60% of the QD TVs sold today (excluding 
Samsung TVs) are using cadmium technology. Within the QD 
TV market, the market research suggests that the number of 
cadmium-based units is expected to fall over time, reflecting 
toxicity and environmental concerns (“RoHS”) in various 
territories.
Samsung’s relative share of the market is also forecast to 
decline over the same period. As a result of this combination 
of factors, the sale of QD TV’s without cadmium by companies 
other than Samsung is expected to double by 2030. At the 
same time, new display technologies (such as micro-LED 
(“uLED”) and electro-luminescence (“QD-EL”)) are forecast 
to make significant use of quantum dots in a number of new 
applications beyond large scale TVs such as monitors, 
smart watches, tablets and smart phones.
Applications
TV
Headsets
Tablets
Monitors
Phones
Smart watch
Display markets
Evolution of the flat panel TV market
Other QD display devices
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
800
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
Millions of TVs
Millions of units
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
 Non-QD 
 Samsung QD TVs 
 Other QD TVs
 Monitor 
 Laptop 
 Tablet/phablet 
 Other

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
018
25
20
15
10
5
0
Number of 
claims
1
46
Retained
Sold
Time to expiry (years)
Retained litigation claims
PTAB validated four 
retained patents
Remaining patent lives
Delivering value from our 
IP requires two things:
1. Commanding patent portfolio
1
53
106
159
212
265
318
375
Settlement
$150m
Leveraging Our IP
Strong case for enforcement
As a UK-based business specialising in 
the design, scale up and manufacture 
of novel nanomaterials, we will continue 
to take steps to protect our platform 
technology and our IP portfolio. Following 
the validation of all 46 claims in the four 
retained patents by the Patent Trial and 
Appeal Board and the subsequent licensing 
of our remaining patent portfolio by 
Samsung, the group is confident in the 
applicability of our IP to other participants 
in the cadmium‑free quantum dot 
display market. 
Leveraging Samsung litigation
The experience gained by the Nanoco 
team during the Samsung litigation, 
combined with our retained experts, is 
a strong platform for delivering further 
value from our IP portfolio and ensuring 
that income is for the benefit of Nanoco 
and its shareholders.
The $150 million agreement with 
Samsung to settle the litigation also sets 
a precedent for future discussions with 
potential infringers.
Expert working group
Nanoco continues to monitor the market 
for potential infringement of its IP.
Our expert team is made up of internal 
staff and external advisers.
We have analysed a range of consumer 
devices available in the market to focus 
on devices and manufacturers most likely 
to be infringing our IP. We continue to 
analyse further devices and review 
market data for potential other infringers.
Key: 
  Lawsuit 
  Lawsuit reserve 
  Other

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
019
Number of TVs examined
Value to pursue (today) 
Probability
Initial engagement, 
seek collaboration
Monitor activity
Direct engagement 
in near term
Initial engagement, 
await volume growth
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
0
100%
80%
60%
40%
20%
0%
Year
QD Co
Tear downs
Cadmium
Film Co
No QDs
Panel Co
Cadmium-free
Brand
Retailer
Forecast QD TV market
Analysis of potentially infringing products
Infringement heat map
Value chain analysis
2. Deep and impacted market
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
Summary
Nanoco is focused on maximising value 
from its IP portfolio. Whilst we have already 
settled with the largest manufacturer of 
cadmium-free quantum dot televisions, 
as the market develops there will be more 
opportunity for licensing or potential 
litigation. This will be a gradual process 
as market adoption of cadmium-free 
quantum dots in displays continues to 
be slower than expected.
We will also continue to build our IP 
portfolio to ensure future technological 
developments are protected.
As QD TVs and other devices capture 
a larger share of the total flat panel TV 
market and as more market participants 
build market presence, we see an 
opportunity to generate income by 
licensing our IP.
Millions of TVs
Gross “value” to each player

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
020
Revenue streams 
Products
Our Runcorn facility has the capacity to 
make high volumes of CFQD® quantum 
dots and HEATWAVE® nanomaterials for 
IR sensing applications. The revenue 
generation capacity can be easily 
scaled by adding additional shifts with 
the overall potential return on the asset 
base being attractive and benefiting 
strongly from operational leverage if 
extra shifts and volumes are added. 
Revenue potential: HIGH.
Royalties
As well as the ability to make and sell 
materials directly to our customers, the 
agreements with our channel partners 
allow them to manufacture or distribute 
our materials themselves and then pay a 
royalty on the value of their sales to their 
customers. This revenue stream has the 
potential for high leverage since it is not 
constrained by manufacturing scale and 
also has minimal costs associated with 
incremental sales via this channel. 
Success in the Samsung litigation has 
increased the potential of this income 
stream. Revenue potential: MEDIUM.
Services
Our highly skilled R&D and scale up 
teams are able to design, develop and 
scale new materials for customer‑specific 
applications. We are able to charge 
customers for professional services when 
we carry out these sorts of development 
activities for them, with rewards often 
linked to achieving technical milestones 
or outcomes. The last two financial years 
have seen significant revenue generated 
in this area. Revenue potential: LOW.
Licences
When a channel partner initially acquires 
a right of access to, or use of, Nanoco 
technology and IP, it typically pays a 
one-off licence fee. These fees reflect 
the costs already previously incurred by 
Nanoco in developing its technology and 
IP and hence represent a return on those 
historical investments. Success in the 
Samsung litigation has increased the 
potential of this income stream. Revenue 
potential: LOW.
All revenue streams can contribute 
to our growth
Products
Our
revenue
Royalties
Licences
Services
Key
	 Low – < £5 million per annum
	 Medium – < £10 million per annum
	 High – > £10 million per annum

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
021
Case study
Delivery of milestones in customer SoWs
Background
Nanoco has continued to achieve all milestones in 
the customer statement of works (“SoWs”).
s.172 factors considered:
	
| Long-term consequences: Investment in, and 
development of, new quantum dot technologies.
	
| Interests of the Company employees: Our staff are 
developing the ideas which are leading to breakthroughs 
in this area.
	
| Impact on customers: Achievement of their targets helps 
aid adoption of the technology in the wider market.
Case study
Return of capital to shareholders
Background
The Company decided to return up to £33 million to shareholders 
of the Company through a tender offer and subsequent 
share buy-back.
s.172 factors considered:
	
| Long-term consequences: The cash resources required 
for the Company to continue to operate.
	
| Interests of shareholders: The Company retained enough 
cash to see it through to break even, whilst also returning 
excess cash to shareholders.
	
| Impact on customers: Customers have increased faith 
in the financial security of Nanoco as a supplier.
	
| Impact on suppliers: Suppliers can offer improved terms 
to Nanoco due to the financial security provided.
Section 172(1) statement
How we engage with 
our stakeholders
Section 172(1) report
In line with section 172(1) of the Companies Act 2006, the 
Directors of the Company must act in a way which they 
consider, in good faith, would most likely promote the success 
of the Company for the benefit of its members as a whole, and 
in doing so must have regard to a number of other key matters.
Likely long-term consequences of decisions (s.172(1)(a))
Given the nature of the business, the Board takes a medium‑term 
approach to its decision making to ensure that the Company is 
able to deliver its strategy of creating value for all of its stakeholders. 
Risk management is also key to understanding the likely 
consequences of actions. 
The Board plays a key role in reviewing the Company’s 
approach to risk, including an assessment of its emerging 
and principal risks. See pages 33 to 35 of the Strategic report 
for a description of the identified risks and how these are being 
controlled or mitigated. Given the group’s finances, the Board 
has been continually reviewing the Company’s current and 
forecast financial position. This year, the Directors selected a 
four-year timeframe over which to assess the viability of the 
Company. The Viability statement can be found on pages 36 and 
37 of the Strategic report.
Maintaining a reputation for high standards of business 
conduct (s.172(1)(e))
The Company has in place a Code of Conduct which acts as 
a guide for employees to do the right thing. The Company also 
has well-embedded policies in place which assist with ensuring 
high standards of conduct, including with respect to the 
following key areas: health, safety and environment; whistleblowing; 
anti-bribery and corruption; human rights; and modern slavery. 
The environmental, social and governance (“ESG”) disclosures 
section of the Directors’ report, from pages 38 to 49, provides 
further insight into measures put in place by the Board to assist 
with maintaining a reputation for high business conduct standards.
Acting fairly between members of the Company (s.172(1)(f))
The Directors also have regard to the need to act fairly between 
members of the Company, aiming to understand their views 
and act in their best interests. The ownership of the Company 
follows a “one share, one vote” structure, which assists with 
promoting parity in shareholder rights. The Board ensures 
that there is fair and equal dissemination of information to all 
shareholders and has a dedicated Investors section on the 
Company’s website which is available to all shareholders. 
This provides easy access to RNS announcements and reports 
and publications. All members are invited to attend the Annual 
General Meetings of the Company, offering an opportunity for 
members of any size shareholding to have a conversation with, 
and ask questions to, each of the Directors. For any Annual 
General Meetings where in-person attendance is not possible, 
all shareholders will be offered the opportunity to submit 
questions to the Board ahead of the meeting with answers 
being made available to them.
Having regard to specific stakeholder groups (s.172(1)(b) 
to s.172(1)(d))
The table which follows on the next page seeks to provide 
insight into how the Board carries out its duty under this section.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
022
Strategic report
Section 172(1) statement continued
Having regard to specific stakeholder groups (s.172(1)(b) to s.172(1)(d)) continued
Why we engage
How we engage and respond
Shareholders
	
| To enable shareholders to understand 
Nanoco’s strategic aims and results
	
| To help shareholders to understand 
management’s aims, responsibilities 
and incentive structures
	
| To help shareholders to understand our 
commitment to our staff, communities 
and the wider environment
	
| We build relationships with our investors 
through our investor relations activities
	
| In our Annual Reports, we update all 
stakeholders on our strategic progress 
and explain any financial implications
	
| We consider investor feedback and what 
impact this may have on the business
Employees
	
| To ensure employees feel valued for 
their contributions
	
| To empower our employees
	
| To enhance our employees through 
training and progression
	
| We communicate key decisions and 
collaborate through our Employee Voice 
Committee, which includes a Director,
	
| A director, Liam Grey, was appointed from the 
workforce and communicates the views of 
employees to the Board.
	
| We give them the tools to work effectively
	
| We encourage our employees to provide 
solutions to problems
Customers
	
| To ensure we can provide the best service 
and products possible to meet the 
customers’ needs
	
| To protect our customers’ technology
	
| To ensure we are complying with 
regulatory requirements
	
| We ensure open and constant communication 
with customers to ensure our products and 
services are world leading
	
| We welcome feedback from customers 
and work collaboratively to achieve our 
customers’ goals
Suppliers
	
| To develop long-term, collaborative partnerships 
for key, difficult-to-source materials
	
| To mitigate the risk of not being able to 
succeed commercially
	
| To comply with regulatory requirements
	
| We create close, collaborative working 
relationships with key suppliers to ensure 
clear communication, active issue resolution 
and effective qualification of products
	
| We encourage open engagement to 
ensure compliance with the relevant 
regulatory requirements
Regulators
	
| To ensure compliance with regulatory requirements
	
| To protect our staff and communities
	
| To ensure best practice
	
| We review our operations periodically 
to ensure compliance with regulations
	
| We actively maintain standards through 
external reviews (e.g. ISO 9001 accreditation)
Community
	
| To make a meaningful contribution to 
the community
	
| To create a positive working culture
	
| To attract and retain talent
	
| Our Employee Voice Committee (“EVC”) looks 
at ways in which we can help the community
	
| We invite both members and non-members 
to ask questions at our general meetings
Environment
	
| To improve our ESG credentials
	
| To mitigate environmental damage 
from business activities
	
| We have engaged an external party to review 
our materiality assessment
	
| We are reviewing our ESG strategy
	
| Looking at ways of reducing our 
environmental footprint
	
| Ensuring we recycle as much waste as possible
	
| Engaging with our landlord to make facilities 
more environmentally friendly

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 023
Impact of engagement
Engagement during the year
	
| We aim to create long-term investor value 
through growing from an R&D services 
business to a commercially viable niche 
production company
	
| The successful conclusion to the Samsung 
litigation provides a means to return capital 
to shareholders in the short term
	
| We engaged openly with shareholders through briefings, subsequent 
Q&A sessions and general meetings
	
| We expanded engagement in Investor Meet Company presentations
	
| We ensured an open forum at the general meetings held during the year
	
| Following consultation and feedback from shareholders, we committed to 
a return of capital which was completed post year end
	
| Our employees feel empowered to achieve 
solutions to problems
	
| Our employees feel more valued and 
aligned to the business 
	
| We improve as our employees improve
	
| We were awarded a Sunday Times Best Places to Work 2024 award 
following a poll of our employees
	
| We held a number of all-Company days to explain our Company strategy 
to employees
	
| We set our employee targets in line with corporate goals
	
| Following feedback from employees, we reviewed our employee value 
proposition to ensure it aligned with what employees most valued
	
| We build strong relationships with 
customers, who believe in the capabilities 
of our platform technology and our 
employee expertise
	
| Our customers trust us to be able 
to meet their requirements to create 
world-leading products
	
| Through the year, we collected feedback and actively engaged in weekly 
technical updates to aid development and collaboration
	
| We openly discussed any logistical challenges due to import/export 
regulations, helping customers with their own compliance goals
	
| We discussed technical specifications with a wider remit of customers 
to ensure our materials could meet the market demands
	
| This helps us to attain best value from our 
supply chain and mitigates the risk of a 
breakdown in process negatively impacting 
the business
	
| Through regulatory checks, we ensure our 
suppliers are complying with regulatory 
requirements, e.g. payment of minimum wage
	
| We performed audits on suppliers to ensure their compliance 
with legislation
	
| We engaged with a number of suppliers on the qualities of our raw 
materials and considered their impact on our products for our customers
	
| We maintained dialogue on the availability of raw materials and took 
action when there was a risk that this could be compromised
	
| We have begun conversations on the scope 3 impact of our raw materials
	
| Compliance with regulatory requirements 
enables the business to operate in a safe 
manner, protecting our employees and 
wider communities
	
| We were re-certified to ISO 9001 and achieved ISO 14001 during 
the financial year
	
| We constantly reviewed operating procedures to ensure best practice
	
| We monitored changes to European RoHS regulations to remove exposure 
to toxic cadmium from EU customers
	
| Our EVC looks at ways in which we can have 
a positive impact on the local community
	
| Being involved with the local community 
improves morale across the employees and 
improves external perceptions of Nanoco 
as a company
	
| We held a number of Company events, organised by the EVC, 
which benefited the communities 
	
| Provided matched fundraising
	
| Introduced a sponsored charity and have started arranging 
fundraising events
	
| Allowed employees to donate blood during work time
	
| To reduce carbon emissions as a result of 
business activity
	
| To ensure waste is recycled where possible
	
| To improve our impact on the environment
	
| We have looked at purchasing raw materials in bulk to reduce emissions 
from deliveries
	
| We discussed a number of ESG projects with landlords (such as installation 
of electric car charging points)
	
| We have implemented a process to consolidate waste to reduce emissions 
from deliveries and excess packaging

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
024
Our platform technology 
is the basis for our growth 
and commercialisation 
is the ultimate goal for 
all stakeholders
Our business model
E
X
P
E
R
T
I
S
E
A
G
I
L
I
T
Y
INTELLECTUAL 
PROPERTY
P
L
A
T
F
O
R
M
 
T
E
C
H
N
O
L
O
G
Y
O
PE
RA
TI
O
NS
E
M
PL
OY
EE
S
Intellectual 
property
Deep IP portfolio, 
a key investment 
proposition
Platform 
technology 
High performing 
nanomaterials
Expertise
Our platform and people 
deliver novel solutions to 
new application challenges
Agility
Broad skill set and agile 
team structures enable rapid 
resource pivot to alternative 
commercial opportunities
Partners and customers
Major channel partners with 
global reach to multiple markets 
and applications
Employees
Highly skilled staff with extensive 
technical knowledge and 
flexible skill sets
Operations 
Installed an asset base capable 
of generating significant 
revenue in multiple markets
AN
D 
C
US
TO
ME
RS
P
A
RT
N
ER
 L
I
C
EN
S
E
E
S

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 025
About our business model
Our business model has a number of key 
strengths. It also enjoys a diverse range 
of potential income streams. This was 
amply demonstrated over the last two 
years where services income featured 
strongly compared to previous years. 
Our overarching medium-term goal is 
to maximise our revenue from direct 
product sales.
Intellectual property (“IP”)
IP and process technology know-how are 
foundational assets for the group and a 
key strength. Our technology is heavily 
patented to secure its use for the group. 
New IP is continually generated through 
our R&D activities and all potential patents 
are reviewed by our internal Patent Review 
Board for commercial value before being 
filed. We continue to strengthen our IP 
position by patenting technology we 
believe will have real commercial value 
in the future.
It is worth noting that on top of our formal 
IP portfolio, we also have significant 
know-how around our methods and 
processes. We tend to hold this information 
as commercial secrets rather than as 
formally registered IP. 
Platform technology
Our nanomaterials have a wide range of 
electronic properties, usually opto‑electrical 
in nature. These include absorption of 
different forms of energy and its emission 
and potentially its conversion to a different 
form of energy (electricity to light, for 
example) or a different variety of the 
same energy (blue light to green light, 
for example).
One specific class of our materials is our 
CFQD® quantum dots that avoid the use 
of toxic cadmium in display applications. 
The same absence of toxic chemicals 
means we can also develop dots that 
can be applied in life sciences applications 
for use in the human body, although this 
is not currently something the group is 
working on.
Expertise and agility
We take advantage of our extensive 
technical expertise and agile workforce 
to be able to respond to complex and 
challenging customer requirements. We 
can also do this much faster than many 
of our competitors. Whilst development 
cycles may take a number of years, we 
believe our expertise in these areas 
means we can solve technical challenges 
quickly to develop and scale up novel, 
new nanomaterials.
Employees
Our staff are highly skilled in a number of 
specialist areas. There are 13 employees 
with PhDs and other postgraduate 
qualifications. In R&D, our expertise 
ranges from chemistry to physics. Staff 
are also adept at taking lab scale processes 
and scaling them up to industrial production 
scale. We also have strong process 
improvement and yield optimisation skills 
that improve both production volumes 
and our input costs. We further invest in 
our employees through training to ensure 
they are developing their capabilities further.
Production capacity
Our Runcorn production facility has two 
distinct production labs. One is focused 
on CFQD® quantum dots for use in display. 
The other facility is focused on nanomaterials 
for use in infra-red sensing applications. 
In combination, they create an extensive 
revenue-generating capacity for the 
group through direct product sales to 
our customers. The nature of the facilities 
means they also deliver strong operational 
leverage if additional volumes are added 
with additional shifts, and we continue to 
identify ways to improve our efficiencies.
Operator assessing the performance of raw materials.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
026
Our strategy
Growth
KPIs
	
| Revenue
	
| EBITDA
	
| Billings
Risks
	
| Strategic
	
| Operational
	
| Financial
Objective
	
| To become a full service 
production company
	
| To become self-sustaining financially
How
	
| Own manufacture and direct 
supply to customers
	
| Non-exclusive technology licensing
	
| Professional services
	
| Royalty income
Future focus
	
| Converting current opportunities 
into revenues with a strong 
emphasis on nanomaterials 
	
| Exploring opportunities with a 
number of potential customers
1
We are expanding 
our “dot only” strategy 
to a “dot plus” 
strategy that will 
continue to deliver 
world-class 
nanomaterials for 
our customers while 
also developing 
our knowledge and 
understanding of the 
interaction of our 
materials with the 
devices into which 
they are placed.
Our IP and staff 
ensure we continue 
to be at the forefront 
of quantum dot 
advancements.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 027
KPIs
	
| Year-end cash
	
| Investment in R&D
	
| Portfolio of patents and 
patents pending
Risks
	
| Strategic
	
| Compliance
KPIs
	
| Investment in R&D
	
| Portfolio of patents and 
patents pending
Risks
	
| Strategic
Objective
	
| To maintain our 
competitive advantage 
	
| To continue investing for future 
product pipeline
Objective
	
| To utilise our core IP to generate 
future revenue streams
How
	
| Continuing to create and 
patent new IP with clear 
short to medium‑term 
commercial opportunities
	
| Continuing to develop in-house 
manufacturing capabilities
How
	
| Assisting licensees in maximising 
their manufacturing opportunities
	
| Potential litigation against 
infringers of our IP
Future focus
	
| Continuing to invest in R&D in 
order to remain at the forefront 
of this technology
	
| Exploring ways to open up new 
market opportunities
Future focus
	
| Giving partners the best 
performing dots 
	
| Identifying companies which 
may be infringing our IP
Investment
IP monetisation
2
3

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
028
Strategy link	
1
 2  3
Strategy link	
1
 3
2024
1.2
2023
(0.4)
2022
(2.3)
2021
(2.8)
2020
(2.9)
2024
20.3
2023
8.2
2022
6.8
2021
3.8
2020
5.2
2024
7.9
2023
5.6
2022
2.5
2021
2.1
2020
3.9
We have made strong progress in 
safeguarding the future of the group 
and delivering value to shareholders 
in the medium term 
Our key performance indicators
Measurement
Cash and cash equivalents.
This reflects the cash reserves of 
the business and the resources it 
has to invest.
Why it is important
The business operates on a cash 
consuming basis and this KPI indicates 
the duration of funding available.
What it means
In combination with the group’s 
operating plans and budgets, 
the current balance underpins 
the Directors’ going concern 
and viability statements.
Measurement
The value of goods and services 
recognised as income in accordance 
with IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts 
with Customers. Grant income of 
£0.1 million (2023: £0.2 million) is also 
important and included under other 
operating income.
Why it is important
Revenue (and its change year on year) 
shows the speed with which the 
business is growing or contracting.
What it means
In combination with gross margins and 
overheads, it shows whether the group 
is getting closer to the targeted break 
even position.
Measurement
Operating profit excluding exceptional 
items, share-based payment charges, 
depreciation and amortisation.
Why it is important
Increasing EBITDA is a critical 
medium‑term goal as it demonstrates 
progress towards the organic business 
being self-funding.
What it means
The group’s EBITDA, excluding licence 
revenue, is a very good proxy for its 
organic cash flows and shows how 
close the group is to being self‑financing.
1	 Calculation provided on page 31.
Strategy link	
1
Year-end cash
£ million
Revenue
£ million
Adjusted EBITDA
£ million
£20.3m
+147%
£7.9m
+40%
£1.2m
1
+175%

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 029
Strategy link	
1
Strategy link	
2  3
Strategy link	
2  3
2024
61.0
2023
63.0
2022
2.7
2021
1.7
2020
2.5
Measurement
The value of invoices raised during the 
year for goods and services delivered 
or to be delivered to customers 
including those relating to the sale 
of IP (excluding VAT).
Why it is important
Billings are a useful indicator of 
current cash generation.
What it means
Billings are a leading indicator of cash 
generation in the year. An element of 
the billings to Samsung will be 
deferred and the income recognised 
over future periods.
Impact of Samsung settlement
Billings to Samsung in the year totalled 
$75 million USD (£59.3 million GBP).
1	 Calculation provided on page 30.
Measurement
The sum of all costs incurred in 
research and development ("R&D") 
activities. This includes salary costs 
and other direct R&D costs.
Why it is important
Nanoco prides itself on the scale and 
quality of its R&D efforts – which feed 
its IP portfolio and also commercial 
opportunity pipeline as it develops 
new materials for potential new 
markets and applications.
What it means
R&D spend is a leading indicator 
of new product development. 
It also impacts potential 
customer pipelines.
Measurement
The group’s IP lawyers report 
monthly on patents granted or filed 
in the respective patent offices in 
various countries.
Why it is important
Our IP portfolio is a key strength 
of Nanoco and a strong reason 
to invest. It supports our efforts 
to monetise our investments in R&D.
What it means
The overall quality of our IP portfolio 
continues to improve. We continue 
to proactively review the portfolio for 
relevance and value. As our business 
focus changes, this can lead to a 
decision to allow no longer relevant 
IP to lapse.
Billings
£ million
Investment in R&D
£ million
Portfolio of patents and patents pending
Number of patents
£61.0m
1
-3%
£1.6m
2
-10%
366
-2%
Key
Strategy link
1  Growth
2  Investment
3  IP monetisation
2024
1.6
2023
1.8
2022
1.8
2021
2.2
2020
3.1
2024
366
2023
375
2022
503
2021
559
2020
731

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
030
Financial review
Revenue increased by £2.3 million to 
£7.9 million (2023: £5.6 million). The 
increase is due to the licence agreement 
signed with Samsung which contributed 
£6.0 million, with the remaining revenue 
largely related to the ongoing project 
with the European electronics customer. 
Excluding Samsung licence income, 
revenue declined by 29% due primarily to 
timing differences in the start and end of 
a number of development projects.
The sale of products and services 
rendered accounted for 23% (2023: 45%) 
of revenue, with the balance being 
licence income. Revenue from services 
has decreased from £1.7 million to 
£1.4 million due to the time gap prior 
to the current development agreements 
being started. Revenue from the sale 
of products, including development 
products, was £0.4 million (2023: £0.9 million). 
Summary
	
| Revenue increased by 40% to 
£7.9 million (2023: £5.6 million), 
driven by the licence income from 
Samsung. Excluding Samsung 
licence income, revenue declined 
by 29% due primarily to timing 
differences in the start and end of 
a number of development projects.
	
| The gain on a foreign exchange 
forward contract on the second 
tranche of the Samsung litigation 
proceeds generated a one-off 
gain of £1.8 million in the year, in 
addition to a £0.3 million gain on 
the cash which was held in USD 
before utilising the forward contract.
	
| Adjusted EBITDA has increased 
to £1.2 million (2023: £0.4 million 
loss), reflecting the additional 
revenue in the period.
	
| Completed tender offer at a 25.1% 
premium to the closing mid-market 
price per ordinary share on the day 
before the tender was announced 
to return £30.0 million to shareholders 
following the receipt of litigation 
proceeds noted above.
	
| Commenced broker managed 
market buy-back to return a further 
£3.0 million to shareholders, 
completed post year end.
	
| £5.1 million of loans were repaid in 
the year, leaving the group debt free.
Financially underpinned group 
with growth opportunities
Liam Gray
Chief Financial Officer
Highlights
2024
£ million
2023
£ million
% change
Revenue
7.9
5.6
40%
Other operating income
0.1
0.2
(38%)
Adjusted EBITDA
1.2
(0.4)
175%
Net (loss)/profit
(1.3)
11.1
(92%)
(Loss)/profit per share (p)
(0.43)
3.44
(91%)
Billings
61.0
63.0
(3%)
Cash and cash equivalents
20.3
8.2
147%
Non-GAAP measures 
Billings, including those to Samsung, decreased by £2.0 million to £61.0 million 
(2023: £63.0 million). Excluding the impact of any Samsung related billings, billings 
were £1.8 million, which was in line with revenue.
Billings reconciliation
2024
£ million
2023
£ million
Revenue
7.9
5.6
Movement in deferred income
19.6
23.3
Movement in accrued income
33.1
34.5
FX movement between billing and recognition
0.4
(0.4)
Billings
61.0
63.0
The movement in deferred income reflects the second tranche of the payment 
less licence income in the period. Other operating income generated £0.1 million 
(2023: £0.2 million) related to grant income for two projects with Innovate UK which 
were successfully completed during the year. An additional £1.8 million gain 
related to the foreign currency contract on the second tranche of the Samsung 
litigation proceeds.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
031
The non-GAAP measure of adjusted earnings/(loss) before interest, tax, depreciation, 
amortisation, share-based payment charges and exceptional items (“EBITDA”) is 
provided in order to give a clearer understanding of the underlying profit for the 
year that more closely reflects the recurring operational earnings of the business. 
The calculation of these non-GAAP measures is shown in the table below:
2024
£ million
2023
£ million
Operating profit
1.7
15.0
Settled litigation costs
—
49.3
Profit on sale of IP
—
(68.7)
Gain on derivative financial instrument
(1.8)
—
Requisitioned general meeting
—
0.5
Foreign exchange
(0.9)
1.7
Share-based payment charge
1.0
1.0
Employer’s NI on SBP
0.0
(0.2)
Depreciation
0.8
0.6
Amortisation1
0.4
0.4
Adjusted EBITDA 
1.2
(0.4)
1	 Includes impairment of intangible assets (2024: £0.2 million, 2023: £0.1 million).
Finance income and expense 
During the year, the group generated 
finance income of £0.8 million on the 
group’s cash deposits, earned primarily 
in the six months following receipt of the 
second tranche of the Samsung litigation 
proceeds. The finance expense in the 
year of £0.7 million (2023: £5.5 million) 
included £0.5 million of interest on loans 
which were repaid in the year with the 
balance being the inherent interest 
charge on finance leases under IFRS 16.
The profit before tax was £1.9 million 
(2023: £9.6 million profit).
Taxation 
The tax charge for the year was 
£3.1 million (2023: £1.5 million credit). 
This comprises a UK corporation tax 
charge of £nil (2023: £1.0 million) and 
an overseas corporation tax charge of 
£0.6 million (2023: £0.3 million), offset by 
an R&D tax credit of £0.2 million (2023: 
£0.3 million) and the derecognition of 
deferred tax assets of £0.2 million 
(2023: £2.5 million recognition). In addition, 
the Group incurred withholding tax in 
Korea of £2.6 million in the year, of which 
£1.8 million has been recognised as 
an asset as it can be offset against 
future profits.
The group has £30.0 million of 
accumulated losses to offset against 
future profits (2023: £30.8 million).
Cash flow and balance sheet 
During the year, cash, cash equivalents, 
deposits and short-term investments 
increased to £20.3 million (2023: £8.2 million) 
caused by a net cash inflow of £12.1 million 
(2023: £1.4 million inflow). The increase 
reflects the £58.8 million Samsung receipt, 
offset by £33.0 million returned to 
shareholders via the tender and buy‑back, 
£5.1 million of loan repayments, £1.5 million 
investment in new facilities and £7.1 million 
operating cash outflow. Interest on cash 
deposits of £0.8 million was received in 
the year. Tax payments of £0.8 million 
(2023: £0.5 million receipt) were made 
during the year.
Expenditure incurred in registering patents 
totalled £0.1 million (2023: £0.1 million). 
Capitalised patent spend is amortised 
over ten years in line with the established 
group accounting policy. 
IP impairment charges during the year 
were £0.1 million (2023: £0.1 million). 
This reflects the rationalisation of the 
patent portfolio in prior years to ensure 
the remaining patents are commercially 
and technologically viable in the short 
to medium term.
Expenditure on tangible fixed assets 
increased to £1.5 million (2023: £0.3 million) 
as the group invested in its new 
device facility.
During the year, the group repaid all of 
its outstanding loans totalling £5.1 million, 
leaving the group debt free.
Capital reduction
At the end of the prior year, the group 
carried out a capital reduction that was 
approved by the High Court in England 
to eliminate the share premium and 
capital redemptions reserves. This 
increased the group’s distributable 
reserves and allowed the return of 
capital below to take place.
Return of capital
In April 2024, the Company completed 
a tender offer at 24 pence, a 25.1% premium 
to the closing mid-market price per ordinary 
share on the day before the tender was 
announced, to return £30.0 million to 
shareholders. Of the 125 million shares 
acquired by the Company via the tender 
offer, 90% were subsequently cancelled 
with the remainder being held by the 
Employee Benefit Trust for use in the 
future to satisfy employee share options 
granted under the Nanoco Long Term 
Incentive Plan and the Deferred 
Bonus Plan.
Immediately following the tender offer, 
the Company commenced a broker 
managed on-market buy-back to return 
a further £3.0 million to shareholders. 
As at 31 July 2024, £2.0 million had been 
returned via this mechanism, which led 
to the purchase and subsequent 
cancellation of a further 10.9 million 
shares. The remainder of the buy-back 
was completed post year end. The 
Company’s outstanding share capital 
was 202,571,497 shares as at 31 July 2024 
and 194,608,038 on completion of the 
on-market buy-back on 29 October 2024.
The group incurred fees and taxes on 
the tender offer and buy-back totalling 
£1.0 million, the cost of which was charged 
directly to reserves.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
032
Foreign exchange management
The group invoices most of its revenues in 
US Dollars. The group is therefore exposed 
to movements relative to Sterling. The 
group will use forward currency contracts 
to fix the exchange rate on invoiced or 
confirmed foreign currency receipts 
should the amount become significant 
and more predictable.
The second tranche of the litigation 
proceeds was received in January 2024 
(gross $75 million, net $71.75 million after 
$3.25 million withholding tax paid at 
source). The group took out a one-off 
hedge at a rate of GBP1:USD1.22, which 
meant the net cash receipt of $71.75 million 
was converted to £58.8 million. This was a 
£1.8 million gain over the prevailing rate in 
February 2024 when the hedge was utilised.
There were no open forward contracts as 
at 31 July 2024 (2023: none). The indicative 
impact of movements in the Sterling 
exchange rate on the group’s net profits 
and equity based on the retranslation of 
the closing balance sheet is summarised 
in note 27 to the financial statements.
Credit risk
The group only trades with recognised, 
creditworthy third parties. Credit risk is 
increased by the concentration of 
receivables to a small number of 
customers. Receivable balances are 
monitored on an ongoing basis and 
any late payments are promptly 
investigated to ensure that the group’s 
exposure to bad debts is not significant.
Treasury activities and policies
The group manages its cash deposits 
prudently. Cash balances are regularly 
reviewed by the Board and cash forecasts 
are updated monthly to ensure that 
there is sufficient cash available 
for foreseeable requirements.
More details on the group’s treasury 
policies are provided in note 27 to the 
financial statements. 
Going concern
Following the receipts from Samsung 
and the return of capital to shareholders, 
the group retains a cash balance of 
£20.3 million at 31 July 2024. Given the 
remaining cash balance, our low cost 
base, and the identified commercial 
opportunities, the Directors have a 
reasonable expectation that the group 
has access to adequate resources to 
continue in operational existence for 
the foreseeable future. Any future return 
of surplus cash will take into account the 
on-going viability of the group.
Accordingly, the Board concluded that 
it remains appropriate to continue to 
adopt the going concern basis in 
preparing the consolidated financial 
statements. Further detail is included in 
the going concern statement on page 37.
Macroeconomic factors
We continue to see inflationary pressures 
on raw materials. We attempt to mitigate 
these by regularly reviewing suppliers 
where possible, negotiating with new 
suppliers and trying to achieve volume 
breaks. We will continue to review market 
conditions and assess the impact on 
all stakeholders.
Summary
Nanoco is now financially underpinned 
with a stable cost base and IP that has 
been validated by the US PTAB and we 
have commercial opportunities in large 
and growing markets. We look forward 
to updating shareholders on progress 
against our strategic objectives in 
due course.
Liam Gray
Chief Financial Officer
21 November 2024
Financial review continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 033
In common with all businesses at Nanoco’s 
stage of development, the group is exposed 
to a range of risks, some of which are not 
wholly within our control or capable of 
complete mitigation or protection 
through insurance.
Specifically, a number of the group’s 
products and potential applications are 
at an early stage in their development, 
or still being validated by customers, and 
hence it is not possible to be certain that 
a particular project or product will lead 
to a commercial application. Other products 
require further development work to 
confirm a commercially viable application. 
The technology, particularly in the sensing 
division, is still in its infancy and has yet to 
see end market adoption in higher 
volume applications.
Equally, a number of products are 
considered commercially viable but 
have yet to see demand for full scale 
production. It is also the case that the 
group is often only one part of a long 
and complex supply chain for new 
product applications. 
The group therefore has little visibility 
of demand other than from contracts 
already in place. There are therefore 
a range of risks that are associated 
with the different stages of product 
development as well as for the group 
as a whole.
Risk management process
The group has established a process 
for carrying out a robust risk assessment 
that evaluates and manages the principal 
risks faced by the group. A detailed 
review of individual risks was undertaken 
initially by the leadership team and then 
reviewed by the Board during the financial 
year ended 31 July 2024. That review also 
incorporated climate-related risks, as 
required by TCFD reporting. The Board 
has also established an acceptable level 
of risk (risk appetite) that informs the 
scale and urgency of actions required. 
Where risks are deemed to be outside of 
management control, efforts are focused 
on mitigating any potential impact. 
Where all practical measures to prevent 
or mitigate risks have been taken and 
a residual element of risk still remains, 
these risks are accepted by the group.
Risks are evaluated with respect to 
the probability of occurrence and the 
potential impact if a risk crystallised. 
Where the group has identified risks, 
these are monitored with controls and 
action plans to reduce the probability 
of a risk crystallising and the impact 
of each potential event if it did occur. 
The residual risk score, after mitigating 
controls, is then plotted on a “risk heat 
map”. The group’s principal risks are 
shown on the heat map below and 
are discussed in further detail in the 
pages following.
Principal overarching risk
The historical principal overarching 
strategic risk faced by the business was 
that the group exhausted its available 
funding before achieving a self-financing 
level of commercial revenue. This risk has 
significantly mitigated in the short 
to medium term following the proceeds 
from the Samsung litigation settlement. 
The underlying risk relating to market 
adoption of Nanoco’s technology 
remains but has been shifted further 
out in time due to the improved cash 
position noted above.
Other principal risks
Risks are broadly categorised as 
strategic, operational, financial or 
compliance. The table overleaf focuses 
on those risks that the Directors believe 
are the most important currently faced 
by the business. Other risks may be 
unknown at present and some that are 
currently rated as low risk could become 
more material risks in the future. The 
group’s risk management process 
tracks risks as they evolve and change.
Managing risk is key to the delivery 
of the group’s strategic objectives
Principal risks and uncertainties
Likelihood and impact of principal risks
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Impact
Probability
  FY23	
  FY24
C
H
G
A
B
B
F
F
C
D
E
H
A
E
D

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
034
Likelihood and impact of principal risks continued
Risk description
Potential causes and impact
Mitigation
Change
Link to
strategy
Strategic
A 
Lack of market 
adoption of 
technology
Responsibility:
CEO/CTO
Market fails to commercially adopt 
technology incorporating the 
group’s nanomaterials.
The group targets a wide range 
of potential applications in the 
sensing industry.
Work with industry leaders 
to differentiate products from 
current offerings.
Make products commercially competitive.
De-risk Nanoco as a supply 
chain partner.
Maintain capacity to scale to meet 
demand from very large customers.

First commercial order has 
been shipped, but no further 
first‑generation material orders.
Expanded range of materials 
addressing more potential 
market applications.
One of our customers cancelling 
the second generation project 
may delay market adoption of the 
technology.
However, continued investment in 
this area by our customers and 
other companies (e.g. Onsemi). 
1
B 
Competing 
technology in 
sensing applications
Responsibility:
CEO/CTO
A different competing technology 
achieves commercialisation in 
sensors ahead of Nanoco (whether 
QD or another technology).
The group works with a number 
of market-leading companies in 
this area.
The R&D leaders in the group stay 
abreast of advancements to 
understand their implications.
The group’s technology enjoys a very 
significant cost advantage 
over competitor products.

The European customer cancelling 
the project on second generation 
materials may delay market 
adoption and allow a competing 
technology to advance.
1
C 
Competing 
technology in 
display applications
Responsibility:
CEO/CTO
A different competing technology 
(either QD or another) reduces 
the quantum dot share of TVs in 
the market.
The group licenses its technology 
to the market leader in this area 
and will be discussing further 
licensing opportunities.
The R&D leaders in the group stay 
abreast of advancements to 
understand their implications.
Nanoco’s cadmium-free solutions 
deliver clear environmental benefits.

Prominence of micro-LED and 
introduction of EL displays at 
recent conferences – different 
technology to Nanoco.
1
3
D 
Customer 
concentration risk
Responsibility:
CEO/CTO
Reliance on a small number of key 
customers exposes the group to risk of 
delays in the customers’ own supply 
chains over which the group can exert 
limited influence (one customer was 
66% of revenue excluding licences in 
FY24). These delays can then have a 
knock-on adverse effect on the group’s 
expected revenue streams.
Commercial strategy in the medium 
term is to dilute customer concentration 
risk by selling into various markets, 
through various channels and to a 
range of customers.
Continue to work with new customers to 
develop commercial offerings.

Same core significant customers 
as in prior years.
This risk has increased post 
year end following the 
cancellation of the project 
with the European customer.
1
3
Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Key
Risk change
Strategy
 Up
1  Growth
 Neutral
2  Investment
 Down
3  IP monetisation

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 035
Risk description
Potential causes and impact
Mitigation
Change
Link to
strategy
Operational
E 
Loss of key 
personnel
Responsibility:
CFO
While the group maintains a high level 
of protected documented IP, our staff 
remain a critical asset with significant 
levels of technical and sector know-how. 
Loss of key personnel would have an 
adverse impact on the group’s 
development and commercialisation. 
The group offers rewarding careers that 
allow staff to develop new skills while 
pursuing interesting research ideas.
The group reviews remuneration 
to ensure that appropriate reward 
packages accompany the fulfilling 
work environment.
Post-employment obligations 
and protected IP expose potential 
competitors to the threat of litigation.

Continued investment in 
infrastructure and focus on 
remuneration and benefits.
Cancellation of project with 
European customer may create 
further uncertainty amongst staff.
Staff turnover in line with industry.
1
2
Financial
F 
Lack of adequate 
resources to sustain 
the group until 
it becomes 
self‑sustaining
Responsibility:
CFO
Revenues from own product sales, 
services rendered and licensee 
royalties do not materialise as planned.
The group is unable to carry out its 
operations and hence cannot deliver 
on medium-term or strategic goals.
Cash will continue to be 
prudently managed.
Focus on revenue-generating activities 
without abandoning worthwhile and 
focused R&D work.
Cost reduction actions identified 
if necessary.
Retention of a portion of the 
litigation proceeds.

Delays in commercialisation of 
first and second generation of 
material may result in the group 
being loss making for an 
extended period.
1
2
Compliance
G 
Major 
environmental, 
health and safety 
(“EHS”) issue
Responsibility:
CEO
Failure to follow existing procedures or 
a new unforeseen risk could result in 
injury to staff, equipment, reputation 
and finances and potential loss of 
operating licences.
Extensive and ongoing efforts to 
continuously improve procedures.
Renewed leadership focus on the “tone 
at the top” and cultural change.
Continuous training of staff in risks and 
how to mitigate risks.

Continued focus on EHS including 
incentivisation of staff.
1
2
Governance
H 
Shareholder 
relations
Responsibility:
CEO/CFO
Shareholder activism has an impact on 
a number of stakeholders, including, but 
not limited to, customers, suppliers and 
employees, and also has significant 
financial and non-financial implications.
Continued engagement 
with shareholders.
Focus on the commercial business 
being successful.
Open and transparent communication 
with stakeholders.

Delays in commercialisation 
and decline in share price may 
increase shareholder activism. 
1
2
The Executive team manages a greater number of more detailed risks on an ongoing basis, none of which are considered of 
strategic importance to the group. The Board reviews the detailed risk register annually to ensure that all strategic risks are being 
appropriately considered at the Board level while business as usual (“BAU”) risks are actively managed by the Executives.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
036
The litigation settlement provided 
Nanoco with sufficient resources to 
continue to deliver on its strategy 
for the foreseeable future
Viability statement
In accordance with the provisions in 
the UK Corporate Governance Code 
(Provision 31 of the 2018 UK Corporate 
Governance Code), the Directors have 
assessed the viability of the group’s 
business model and determined that a 
four-year period is a suitable period to 
be utilised, which is in line with the prior 
year. A four-year period is considered 
appropriate given the increased financial 
stability of the group. However, it should 
still be emphasised that the early stage 
of development and evolving nature 
of the markets for the group’s products 
mean that forecasting time horizons 
with any degree of certainty remains 
relatively short.
The Directors’ assessment has been 
made with reference to the current 
position of the group and the group’s 
current strategy and principal risks 
as described on page 33 in this 
Strategic report.
While inflationary pressures have 
weakened over the last year, the group 
remains vigilant in monitoring input costs, 
particularly employee costs which represent 
approximately 54% of the group’s cost base.
Changes during the year
We continue to see progress with our 
customers in sensing. Both the European 
electronics customer and the Asian 
chemical customer signed long-term 
collaboration agreements to continue 
development work in this area. In addition, 
Nanoco shipped its first ever commercial 
production orders. 
We have continued to add other 
customers in the year in both sensing 
and display, although these are 
currently relatively small and early 
stage engagements.
After the year end the European 
electronics customer terminated its 
collaboration agreement and confirmed 
it would place no further production orders.
The viability assessment process
In assessing the viability of the group, 
the Directors have utilised their forecasts 
for the period to 31 October 2028, which 
take into account the group’s current 
and expected business activities and 
commercial opportunity pipeline, the 
current cash resources (£20.3 million as 
at 31 July 2024), the contracted 
receivables, the contracted revenue and 
prospects for FY25, and any liabilities as 
they fall due. These inputs form the basis 
of a conservative base case with the 
main assumptions shown below in the 
section on going concern. The events 
between the 31 July 2024 and the signing 
date as described in the strategic report, 
including the loss of the European 
customer and the subsequent 
restructuring, were factored into 
the viability forecasts.
The base case assumptions were then 
flexed to create a “severe but plausible” 
downside stress test. This includes the 
assumption that commercial production 
is delayed by a year and that no new 
development engagements are started 
for two years. The group remains viable 
in this scenario with significant cash 
reserves. Given the cash resources of the 
group, in all scenarios, all outstanding 
liabilities are settled. 
Any future distribution of surplus cash 
will take into consideration the viability 
of the group and sufficient cash will be 
retained to ensure viability for the full 
assessment period.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 037
Conclusion
As a result of the assessment outlined 
above, the Directors have confirmed 
that they have a reasonable expectation 
that the group will remain viable and 
able to continue in operation and meet 
liabilities as they fall due over the 
four-year period of their assessment.
Going concern
All of the following matters are taken into 
account by the Directors in forming their 
assessment of going concern:
	
| the group’s business activities and 
market conditions are set out on 
pages 9 to 27;
	
| the principal risks and uncertainties 
are shown on pages 33 to 35;
	
| the group’s financial position is 
described in the Financial review on 
pages 30 to 32; and
	
| note 27 to the accounts summarises 
the group’s financial risk management 
objectives, policies and processes.
For the purposes of their going 
concern assessment and the basis for 
the preparation of the 2024 Annual 
Report, the Directors have reviewed the 
same trading and cash flow forecasts 
and sensitivity analyses that were used 
by the group in the viability assessment 
as noted above, with the going concern 
assessment covering the period to 
November 2025. The same base case 
and downside sensitivities were also used.
The base case represents the Board’s 
current expectations. Assumptions in 
the base case are:
	
| reduced revenue in FY25 following the 
loss of the European electronics customer;
	
| new services revenue will be 
generated from CY25;
	
| ramp up of product sales from FY26 
moving to larger scale in FY27;
	
| other companies pay to access 
Nanoco’s technology in the future;
	
| reduction in headcount and 
overheads to reflect reduced 
short‑term revenue expectations;
	
| costs associated with being a listed 
entity and other costs reflect the 
current inflationary environment; and
	
| the reduced cost base is capable of 
supporting significant increases in 
revenue above those assumed in the 
base case so there is no immediate 
requirement for short-term increases 
or new capital expenditure.
The downside case then flexes those 
assumptions as follows:
	
| a full-year delay in small scale 
commercial production revenues 
(into FY26); and
	
| no new service customers until FY27.
Both cases above produce cash flow 
statements that demonstrate that the 
group has sufficient cash throughout the 
period of the going concern forecast.
Going concern conclusion
Considering the current financial resources 
and monthly cash costs of the group, 
and after making appropriate enquiries, 
the Directors have a reasonable expectation 
that the group has access to adequate 
resources to continue in operational 
existence for the foreseeable future.
Accordingly, the Directors continue 
to adopt the going concern basis in 
preparing the consolidated financial 
statements. The financial statements 
do not reflect any adjustments that 
would be required to be made if they 
were prepared on a basis other than 
the going concern basis.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
038
Nanoco recognises that 
sustainability is core to building 
a business for the long term and 
the achievement of our strategy
Sustainability report
Our progress in the year
As a business, we have made significant 
progress in our environmental, social and 
governance ("ESG") approach during the 
year and are developing a better 
appreciation of ESG risk management 
and performance. We are in the early 
phases of taking a more strategic 
Highlights:
	
| Formation of cross-functional 
ESG committee 
	
| ISO 14001 implementation
	
| Completion of Nanoco’s first 
materiality assessment and 
development of a new ESG strategy
	
| Sunday Times Best Places to Work 
2024-Small Organisations
approach to managing and tracking our 
environmental and social performance, 
whilst developing the frameworks and 
reporting systems to be able to monitor 
key metrics and putting in place the 
building blocks which will underpin our 
strategy and reporting.
At the start of the year, a new ESG steering 
committee with Board representation 
from the CFO was established with the 
aim of increasing our understanding of 
the risks and opportunities for the 
business posed by ESG issues. This has 
helped to identify the areas that are most 
significant to the business and implement 
an ESG strategy, aligned with the core 
business strategy to address those 
significant risks and opportunities. Liam 
Gray, CFO, said “the ESG committee 
highlights our commitment to sustainability. 
The committee will help drive 
improvements, identify risks and 
opportunities and set targets to ensure 
Nanoco is consistently improving on its 
ESG credentials.”
A key milestone for Nanoco’s ESG 
progress in the year has been the 
implementation and certification of 
ISO 14001 Environmental Management 
Systems. This project involved teams 
from across the business from shop floor 
to Directors and included a thorough 
assessment of the environmental 
aspects and impacts of the business 
and identification of associated risks 
and opportunities. A new management 
system was then implemented to address 
those areas and a new environmental 
policy was published. The project resulted 
in a successful certification in May 2024 
and forms a basis for ongoing improvements, 
with annual re‑certification audits 
performed by an external assessor.
In order to better understand our key ESG 
issues we commissioned an externally 
facilitated materiality assessment which 
included insights from industry intelligence 
research, comparison with peers and 
engagement with key stakeholders. This 
provided us with valuable insight into the 
issues most important to our stakeholders 
and resulted in a double materiality 
matrix which assessed each issue 
against its significance to stakeholders 
and the business’s exposure to risks 
and opportunities.
We used this assessment to create the 
pillars of our ESG strategy and set both 
short-term and long-term objectives 
aligned with the overall strategy of the 
group. These pillars will form the basis 
of our ESG roadmap for the coming 
years and are discussed in detail in the 
following pages. The pillars are linked to 
the UN’s Sustainable Development Goals 
to highlight Nanoco’s commitment to 
having a positive impact on wider society.
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Exposure/impact on the business
Significance to stakeholders
Climate 
adaption, 
resilience and 
transition
GHG emissions
Supply chain 
management
Energy 
management
Air emissions
Water and 
effluents
Labour practices and 
human rights
Opportunities 
in clean tech
Anti-bribery 
and corruption
Diversity, equity 
and inclusion
Product design and 
lifecycle management
Talent attraction, retention 
and development
Employee engagement
Waste
Community 
impact
Biodiversity
Product safety and quality
Privacy and data 
security
Employee 
wellbeing
Employee health and safety
Intellectual property 
protection and 
competitive behaviour
Materials sourcing
  Environmental 
  Social 
  Governance

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 039
Our ESG strategy
Future-forward 
chemistry
Investing in 
people
Innovation 
protection
Product design and 
lifecycle management
Transition to less harmful chemicals 
(CFQD®) (PbS-InAs-InSb)
Employee health and safety
Implement ISO 45001
IP protection
Build know-how and internal 
skill levels to bring device and 
analysis in house
Enhance IP portfolio
Product safety and quality
ISO 14001 implementation
ISO 9001 maintain compliance
Employee engagement
Improve employee satisfaction 
based on survey results
Privacy and data security
Achieve and maintain a secure 
score of 80 points over a rolling 
six-month period
Material sourcing
Review provenance of core materials 
and suppliers
Talent attraction, retention 
and development
New people promise including 
values and reward
25% of employees receive 
development training
Waste
Reduce waste by 30% by 2030
Review all air pollutants 
and their impact
GHG emissions
Achieve net zero by 2050

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
040
Sustainability continued
Future-forward chemistry
The first pillar of our sustainability strategy 
is preparing the group for a long-term 
future in an increasingly environmentally 
focused world. This pillar covers the ESG 
impact of our products and processes 
across the full lifecycle, including product 
design, material sourcing, waste and 
other emissions.
Product design and 
lifecycle management
Integrating considerations such as energy 
efficiency and possible materials used in 
production of products and services into 
the business's decision‑making processes.
Why it’s important: Issues will arise if 
Nanoco acts too slowly in integrating 
environmental considerations of 
products into its buying decisions 
and product development.
Where we are: Nanoco’s products 
are inputs into consumer goods and 
macroeconomic pressures driven by 
climate-related hazards could impact 
the future revenues of the business. The 
group also acknowledges the potential 
reputational consequences of failing 
to meet the climate expectations of 
stakeholders as the world transitions to 
a low carbon economy. In consideration 
of climate-related opportunities, Nanoco’s 
product portfolio has potential to support 
the energy transition. 
Nanoco’s CFQD® display products are 
notably free of toxic cadmium, which reduces 
emissions associated with managing the 
disposal of toxic waste and removes a 
dangerous chemical from the supply 
chain for QD televisions. In May 2024, 
the European Commission published 
a new Delegated Directive to amend 
Exemption 39 of the RoHS Directive 
that allows the use of cadmium in 
certain display applications. To reflect 
the advancement in Cadmium-free QD 
technology, the existing Exemption 39(a), 
which permitted the use of cadmium 
selenide-based QDs in display 
applications and was relied on by a 
number of manufacturers of QD display 
films, will expire on 21 November 2025. 
A new Exemption 39(b) has been added 
to allow the use of cadmium in LED 
semiconductor chips for display and 
projection applications (< 5 µm per 
mm2 of LED chip surface area with a 
maximum amount per device of 1 mg) 
until 31 December 2027. This represents 
a significant tightening of the use of 
cadmium in displays, which after the 
expiry of Exemption 39(a) will be limited 
to “on-chip” technology until the end 
of 2027.
HEATWAVE® QD sensing products sit in 
the energy efficiency and low environmental 
impact arena and, as such, will enable 
customer companies to increase the 
uptake of their products while reducing 
their impact on the environment.
The first generation of HEATWAVE® QDs 
contains lead, which, as a heavy metal 
with the potential to cause environmental 
harm, is coming under increased external 
scrutiny, reducing the likelihood that those 
products will see adoption in a consumer 
mass market. The second generation 
currently being developed is lead free 
and will combine improved performance 
with reduced potential for harm. 
What next: Nanoco will continue work on 
the development of its second generation 
of lead-free HEATWAVE® QDs and adapting 
its CFQD® products for new markets. The 
group is also investigating a third generation 
HEATWAVE® product, again working 
towards combining improved performance 
with a reduction in the risk of harms. In 
addition, Nanoco will conduct a full review 
during FY25 of all materials used in the 
business against key harms registers in 
the UK, Europe and the US in order to 
identify further areas where use of 
potentially harmful chemicals can be 
reduced whilst maintaining or improving 
the quality of Nanoco products.
Product safety and quality
Business exposure to possible recalls or 
product safety concerns and the quality 
management efforts in manufacturing.
Why it’s important: There is the potential 
for product defects or failures that could 
harm users to damage the group's 
reputation and result in legal liabilities.
Where we are: Nanoco has a 
well‑established quality management 
system and has held ISO 9001 Quality 
Management Systems certification since 
2016. In addition to this, Nanoco has 
implemented a new environmental 
management system during the year 
and achieved ISO 14001 Environmental 
Management Systems certification in 
May 2024.
What next: Nanoco is currently working 
on the implementation of an improved 
health and safety management system 
and expects to achieve accreditation 
for ISO 45001 Occupational Health and 
Safety Management Systems during 
FY25, as discussed in greater detail in 
the health and safety section below. 
Following this all three management 
systems will be integrated into a single 
management system which will embed 
quality, environment and health and 
safety into everything we do. 
Material sourcing
The ability to manage potential material 
shortages, supply disruptions, price 
volatility and reputational risks, which 
is made more difficult by the fact that 
commonly sourced materials come from 
supply chains that often lack transparency.
Why it’s important: Issues may arise 
when Nanoco is reliant on critical 
materials which may have few or no 
available substitutes and are therefore 
vulnerable to many shocks, which could 
lead to the inability to source materials. 
There is also an environmental risk from 
the provenance of raw materials and the 
associated reputational risk that may result.
Where we are: Nanoco purchases the 
majority of its raw materials from large, 
reputable multi-national suppliers and 
has historically relied on those primary 
suppliers to manage their own supply 
chains while also holding sufficient levels 
of material stocks to mitigate any short 
or medium-term disruption to supply. 
However, the international nature of the 
supply chains makes them vulnerable to 
interruption from environmental, social 
or political disruption around the world. 
As part of the implementation of ISO 
14001 during FY24, Nanoco has begun 
to include environmental factors in its 
supplier assessments and audits in order 
to mitigate the environmental risks 
associated with its raw materials.
What next: During FY25 Nanoco will 
conduct a review of the supply chain for 
each of its core raw materials to ensure 
a full understanding of the environmental, 
social and governance risks associated 
with those supplies. The risks identified 
from that review will be managed in line 
with our risk management procedures 
and any required mitigating actions 
performed. In future years, the review will 
be extended to supplies of other materials 
and services in order of their criticality to 
the business. Future plans also include 
embedding environmental considerations 
such as energy efficiency, reusability, 
supply chain emissions and lifecycle 
impact into all purchasing decisions 
but this is still at an early stage.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
041
Waste
The management of waste and 
potential environmental contamination 
and toxic or carcinogenic waste arising 
from operations.
Why it’s important: Risks will arise if Nanoco 
is unable to manage operational waste 
and any toxic waste in line with regulation 
and stakeholder/societal expectations.
2030 target
2024
2023
Risk change
 Recycled
 Net unrecycled
Where we are: During the year, the 
group generated 10.6 tonnes of waste 
(2023: 10.8 tonnes) and recycled 
5.0 tonnes of this (2023: 5.0 tonnes). 
Net unrecycled waste was 5.6 tonnes 
(2023: 5.8 tonnes); however, even 
unrecycled waste is incinerated with 
energy recovery and therefore doesn’t 
go direct to landfill. The group engages 
a specialist 
contractor to incinerate batches of chemicals 
and dispose of other materials no longer 
required. All waste contractors are assessed 
to ensure the waste hierarchy approach 
is applied to all of our materials handled 
and that their operations and systems 
are compliant with the relevant legislation. 
Audits are performed every three years 
in line with our duty of care as a 
waste producer. 
What next: Nanoco has set the 
ambitious target of reducing its waste 
production by 30% by 2030. As the group 
is expected to be in a rapid growth 
phase during this period, level of waste 
will be measured both as a gross figure 
and in relation to employee numbers and 
against revenue (excluding licence 
income). FY24 will be used as the 
baseline for this target. 
The initial focus for reduction in waste will 
be via process improvements by minimising 
quality failures and maximising yields. 
During FY25, the group will conduct 
further assessments of any waste being 
produced, including emissions to air, and 
look to implement a plan to minimise or 
mitigate these.
Nanoco's future 
management system 
will embed quality, 
environment and 
health and safety 
into everything we do."
2023
tonnes
2024
tonnes
2030 
target
tonnes
Gross waste
10.8
10.6
7.4
Waste per employee
0.28
0.23
0.16
Waste per £ million revenue
4.23
5.83
4.08
Greenhouse gas (“GHG”) emissions 
Mitigating climate change by understanding, 
managing and reducing direct and 
indirect GHG emissions in line with 
global ambitions.
Why it’s important: Risks will arise if Nanoco 
is unable to understand, manage and 
reduce direct and indirect GHG emissions 
in line with national/global ambitions, the 
rising expectations of stakeholders and 
increased regulation.
Where we are: Under the Companies Act 
2006 (Strategic and Directors’ Reports) 
Regulations 2013, the group is required 
to state the annual quantity of emissions 
in tonnes of carbon dioxide equivalent 
from activities for which the business is 
responsible, including the combustion 
of fuel and the operation of its facilities, 
and resulting from the purchase of electricity, 
heat, steam or cooling by the business 
for its own use. This data has been 
included in our Annual Report since 2016 
and forms the baseline for our carbon 
reduction targets.
As the group’s UK facility is in a 
multi‑occupancy site, we place reliance 
upon the landlord to provide the data 
needed to determine emissions. 
Our laboratories require continuous 
negative pressure environments and, 
consequently, it is challenging to set 
realistic reduction targets in the 
consumption of electricity.
Our gas consumption is used for heating 
the facility and site costs are shared 
between tenants on the basis of area of 
occupancy. In the absence of significant 
amounts of revenue from the sale of 
commercial products, the emissions 
of the business primarily arise from the 
activities of its research and administration 
facilities rather than from revenue related 
production operations.

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
042
Sustainability continued
Data notes
Reporting period
1 August 2023 to 31 July 2024
Boundary
Operational control
Reporting method 
The Greenhouse Gas (“GHG”) Protocol Corporate Accounting and Reporting Standard
Emissions factor source
Department for Energy Security and Net Zero 2024
Data changes and restatements
None
2024 tCO2e
2024 tCO2e
2023 tCO2e
Electricity
Natural gas
Total
2023 tCO2e
Change
Change
-81%
-100%
-48%
Scope 2
Scope 3
Whole portfolio carbon generation (energy use)
2024
2023
0.31
3
Change
-90%
Intensity (tCO2e/average number of employees)
2024
2023
Change
-83%
Energy consumption used to calculate emissions 
(MWh)
—
11
8
25
129
Air travel
-77%
46 
14
75
69
398
Future-forward chemistry 
continued
Greenhouse gas (“GHG”) emissions 
continued
Reported scope 3 emission currrently 
only include air travel; no other transport 
emissions are considered to be under 
operational control.
Our emissions, based on appropriate 
conversion factors published by the 
Department for Energy Security and Net 
Zero, for the current year are shown in the 
charts below.
What next: Due to Nanoco’s current 
reliance on both our landlord and the 
wider national electricity generation 
landscape to determine the GHG impact 
of our energy use, we have set our initial 
net zero target for 2050 in line with the 
UK national target from the Climate 
Change Act 2008. The group hopes to 
be more ambitious with its target in the 
future as it gains a more in-depth 
understanding of its GHG emissions and 
opportunities for improvement. The first 
step on Nanoco’s path to net zero is to 
conduct a detailed review of all sources 
of indirect emissions within its operations; 
relevant additional scope 3 categories 
will be included in the report next year. 
Once the full GHG emissions profile is 
understood, the group will be able to 
identify opportunities for reductions in 
emissions and create a full roadmap to 
achieve its net zero ambitions.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 043
Investing in people
Nanoco considers its employees to be 
one of the biggest assets of the group 
and the wellbeing of its employees is the 
most direct impact that the group has on 
the society in which it operates. As such 
investing in its people is a core pillar of 
the group’s ESG strategy.
Employee health and safety
Ensuring protection of employee health 
and safety through the use of strict 
protocols and standards to embed a 
culture of zero harm.
Why it’s important: Failing to manage 
these areas properly can lead to serious 
consequences for Nanoco, especially if 
regulations aren't followed or if the local 
community is negatively affected.
Where we are: Nanoco recognises that 
providing a safe, secure and healthy 
working environment is essential and 
contributes to productivity and improved 
performance. The health, safety and 
welfare of all of our employees, contractors 
and visitors are taken seriously across 
the entire organisation, with ultimate 
responsibility lying with the CEO. Health 
and safety performance is a standing 
item on each Board and Executive team 
agenda and is also discussed within 
departmental meetings. The group’s 
health and safety policy is reviewed 
annually. In addition, there is an 
Environmental, Health and Safety (“EHS”) 
Committee to oversee the implementation 
of policy and involve staff in generating 
improvement plans.
There are various improvement and 
reporting systems in place to monitor 
the performance of the group’s health 
and safety management system. 
These initiatives include:
i)	
reporting all incidents (including near 
misses) with appropriate ownership, 
root cause analysis and action 
tracking systems;
ii)	 communication of relevant topics 
and incidents via weekly toolbox 
talks to all departments;
iii)	 monthly and quarterly leadership 
safety and observation audits with 
the focus on immediate action 
resolution by the Executive or 
senior manager leading the audit;
iv)	 monthly departmental audits with 
assigned action tracking processes 
in place to address issues;
v)	 monthly health and safety reports 
issued across the organisation to 
communicate performance against 
annual metrics and progress on key 
improvement initiatives and projects;
vi)	 annual health checks for staff, 
including tests for chemical 
exposure where required; and
vii)	 annual occupational chemical 
exposure tests using fixed and 
personal monitors.
A risk assessment programme is in place 
to identify and mitigate the risks from our 
operations. These assessments include 
but are not limited to:
i)	
the storage, handling and processing 
of hazardous substances;
ii)	 fire safety and emergency evacuation;
iii)	 use of mechanical and electrical 
equipment; and
iv)	 other workplace operations involving 
manual handling and ergonomic 
risks, working at height and other 
hazards identified as part of the 
EHS improvement programme.
All risk assessments are documented 
and actions assigned and reviewed 
according to the defined frequency. 
All research and development functions 
are actively encouraged to, wherever 
possible, eliminate or reduce the levels 
of hazardous substances used in our 
products and processes. All relevant 
chemical legislation and regulatory 
frameworks are used to assess the 
suitability of a substance prior to use 
as part of the risk assessment process. 
Standard operating procedures are 
documented and regularly reviewed. 
The group’s robust EHS control environment 
is evidenced by there being no externally 
reportable incident in any category in 
the last five years. 
All controlled documents are reviewed 
and approved via the electronic document 
management system. A health and 
safety induction programme is in place 
for all new staff and visitors/contractors 
performing work on our premises. Staff 
are trained in standard operating 
procedures, hazard awareness, generic 
workplace health and safety risks and 
behavioural safety expectations applicable 
to their role within the group.
A cross-functional employee health and 
safety team meets on a monthly basis 
with representation from all areas of 
the group, including the Executive team. 
Effective inputs and outputs from the 
team are designed to facilitate a greater 
focus on health and safety and to 
actively encourage discussions within 
respective groups.
What next: Nanoco is committed to the 
continuous improvement of the health 
and safety management system. As part 
of this commitment, Nanoco is in the 
process of implementing ISO 45001 
Occupational Health and Safety 
Management Systems, which we are 
expecting to be certified during FY25.
Employee engagement
The relationship between management 
and employees, the strength of worker 
protections and their employee 
engagement efforts.
Why it’s important: Issues will arise if 
Nanoco is unable to keep employees 
satisfied in their roles and responsibilities 
due to lack of communication and 
engagement. We believe that building 
a positive partnership between strategic 
management and the wider workforce is 
crucial to Nanoco’s success. Our people 
are our best problem solvers and possess 
the insight into how we can make 
Nanoco a top organisation to work for. 
Where we are: Aligning the entire Nanoco 
organisation to ensure that we focus on 
what is important to achieve our goals is 
critical to our success. In order to help us 
navigate the exciting opportunities in 
front of us, it is crucial that as Nanoco 
employees and managers we make 
conscious, careful and informed choices 
about how we allocate our time and 
energy – as individuals and members 
of teams.
Nanoco is committed to a policy of 
engaging employees in the activities 
and growth of the group. Human 
resources and senior management 
review communication channels via the 
use of employee surveys and plan 
communication activities to ensure 
employees are fully informed of current 
business strategy and financial results 
or corporate news.
Corporate communication is key to the 
engagement of our workforce. We have 
focused on improving the look, feel and 
content of group-wide electronic 
communications in order to make 
these more engaging to employees. 

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
044
Sustainability continued
Gender diversity and gender pay gap
Scientific research is a sector challenged 
by a lack of gender diversity, but we feel 
that we have an opportunity to challenge 
this status quo. Nanoco believes in being 
an inclusive and diverse organisation 
where everyone is able to reach their full 
potential. The challenge in our organisation 
and across Great Britain is to eliminate 
any gender pay gap; we therefore 
voluntarily analysed gender pay gap 
data as at 31 July 2024. We can use 
these results to assess the levels of 
gender equality in our workplace and 
the balance of male and female 
employees at different levels.
At the snapshot date of 31 July 2024, 
Nanoco employed 47 employees (2023: 
43) in the UK, of whom 21% were female 
(2023: 26%). Employees work across a 
variety of roles in research and 
production environments. 
Overall, female representation across 
the quartile pay bands corresponds fairly 
closely to the percentage of female to 
male employees overall.
The median gender pay gap for all 
Nanoco employees excluding Directors is 
-24% (2023: 0%). This means that for every 
£1.00 the median man earns at Nanoco, 
the median woman earns £1.24. The 
national average pay gap in 2024 for all 
UK employees is 7.7% 1 in favour of men 
compared to Nanoco’s, which is in favour 
of women. In research and development, 
the national average gender pay gap is 
13.0%1 in favour of men, again compared 
to Nanoco’s parity.
1	 Source – Gender pay gap in the UK: 2023 
– Office for National Statistics.
Gender diversity at Nanoco (at 31 July 2024)
All 
employees
2%
21%
77%
Board of 
Directors
13%
88%
67%
Senior 
team
33%
Key
Female
Male
Non-binary
Female
Male
Key
36%
27%
18%
18%
64%
73%
82%
82%
Upper quartile
Lower middle quartile
Lower quartile
Upper middle quartile
Proportion of males and females 
in each income quartile
Gender pay gap
Mean hourly
earnings
Median hourly
earnings
£23.82
Total1
£22.66
Male1
£27.32
Female1
£22.66
Total1
£19.78
Male1
£24.47
Female1
1	 Excluding Directors.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 045
Investing in people continued
Employee engagement continued
Communication channels at Nanoco 
include all-company meetings, leadership 
meetings and senior team meetings, 
where managers are expected to 
cascade the information to their teams. 
Communication media used includes the 
group intranet, all-group email briefings 
and online meeting software. Our line 
managers hold regular team meetings, 
cross-functional working group meetings 
and management one-to-one updates 
with their team members.
In 2019, we established the Employee 
Voice Committee, which gives employee 
representatives a forum to raise concerns 
and communicate directly with Board 
members. During the year, the EVC has 
organised a number of work-based 
events, such as Cryptex challenge team 
building, a scavenger hunt at Chester 
Zoo, a group bake off and a picnic in 
the park.
A meaningful employee voice will support 
us as an organisation undergoing 
change and responding to industry 
changes. A direct link with the Board also 
enables our Board members to better 
understand the diverse nature of the 
group, allowing them to execute their 
roles more effectively. 
The effectiveness of our employee 
engagement was highlighted when 
Nanoco was included in the Sunday 
Times Best Places to Work list for 2024. 
This was a great achievement and 
highlights the positive relationship 
between the group and its employees. 
What next: Nanoco will maintain its 
overall position as one of the best 
places to work and ahead of the industry 
average. The ambition is to continuously 
improve employee engagement by 
working with staff and addressing 
feedback positively. This will be 
measured using the employee survey. 
Employees with disabilities
It is Nanoco’s policy that people with 
disabilities, including job applicants and 
employees, should be able to participate 
in all of Nanoco’s activities fully on an 
equal basis with people who are not 
disabled. Nanoco strives to promote an 
environment free from discrimination, 
harassment and victimisation.
Nanoco has a disability inclusion policy 
that states that Nanoco will not, on the 
grounds of a person’s disability, or for a 
reason relating to a person’s disability, 
treat that person less favourably than it 
treats, or would treat, others to whom 
the same reason does not or would not 
apply, unless genuinely justified.
At the point of appointment, Nanoco 
obtains occupational health advice as 
to reasonable adjustments. For disabled 
employees we put together a “Reasonable 
Adjustment Action Plan” to support 
employees with disabilities or health 
conditions by removing or minimising 
workplace barriers. These plans are 
reviewed collaboratively between 
managers and employees to ensure 
that they remain relevant. Culturally, 
we believe that it is important to offer 
adjustments in a proactive manner 
where appropriate rather than waiting 
for our employees to request these. 
Nanoco currently employs one person 
with a disability with a series of 
reasonable adjustments in place to 
support this important member of staff.
62%
Employee survey response 
rate (May 2024)
82%
Average engagement 
score
11%
Above "tech industry" 
average
-6
↑
Excellent!
Percentage point difference in average score between majority and minority groups
250,000 have taken the "Workplace Happiness Survey" in 26 industries 
(powered by WorkL Sunday Times) 70,000 organisations have participated
Employee survey data highlights
-100
-50
-20
20
50
100
Majority
Minority

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
046
Sustainability continued
Investing in people continued
Talent attraction, retention 
and development
Technology businesses and those that 
require specialist skills face competition 
and challenges in recruiting qualified 
employees, and compensation for such 
employees is a significant cost 
component for the industry.
Why it’s important: An inability to 
attract and retain talent can hinder the 
group’s competitive advantage and 
long-term growth.
Where we are: Recruiting technical 
specialists has always been key to 
Nanoco’s success. In a highly competitive 
market, this means that we strive to offer 
a competitive benefits package and an 
attractive workplace culture to ensure 
that we attract and retain the best of 
the best. The number of long-serving 
employees demonstrates Nanoco’s 
ability to retain top talent; out of 
44 employees at 31 July 2024 
(excluding Directors), 20% had over 
ten years’ length of service and a 
further 25% had between five and 
ten years’ service.
Nanoco is committed to diversity, equity 
and inclusion in all aspects of its business 
in order to access the best talent and 
allow all employees to perform at the 
best of their abilities. See page 44 
to read about the importance of the 
issue to the business and what we are 
doing to make continuous progress.
During the year, Nanoco is proud to 
have become a Living Wage Employer, 
ensuring that all our employees earn 
a wage which is enough to live on. 
In November 2023, Nanoco introduced 
a health insurance scheme open to all 
employees to enhance the ongoing 
wellbeing of our staff.
Nanoco, as part of its wellbeing strategy, 
puts particular focus on mental health. 
It does so through a variety of means 
including events such as Mental Health 
Awareness Week, mindfulness sessions 
and charity events to raise awareness of 
the support available to those that suffer 
from mental health issues. We encourage 
an open door policy where employees 
are able to disclose and receive support 
for any mental health issues they may 
face. Nanoco also has two employees 
who are trained in mental health first aid. 
The employee assistance programme, 
as part of the wellbeing policy, provides 
caring and compassionate support to 
help people cope and build resilience. 
Both telephone counselling and 
face‑to‑face counselling are available 
to all employees through the programme. 
This support aims to reduce absence 
and improve wellbeing by addressing 
issues head on and reducing their impact.
What next: Nanoco is committed 
to maintaining its accreditation as a 
Living Wage Employer and rewarding 
all its employees on a competitive basis. 
The group is also committed to the 
continual development of its employees 
and as such has a target of funding 
25% of its employees to undertake 
developmental training above and 
beyond what is required for the 
conduct of their existing roles.
Employees undertaking 
developmental training
56%
Diversity at Nanoco
The group’s employees are from many 
different backgrounds, including five 
different nationalities: British, German, 
Indian, Italian and Hungarian.
In addition, group employees come 
from a range of business backgrounds, 
not purely research and development. 
Indeed, of the Board members, 
previous roles and responsibilities 
include those in the supply of chemicals 
and the engineering, electronics, life 
sciences and fast‑moving consumer 
goods industries.
Nanoco will appoint, train, develop, 
reward and promote on the basis of 
merit and ability. Nanoco’s equal 
opportunities policy states that 
employees will not receive less 
favourable treatment or consideration 
on the grounds of age; disability; 
gender or gender reassignment; 
marriage and civil partnership status; 
pregnancy and maternity; race; 
religion or belief; sex; sexual orientation; 
or part-time status, nor will they be 
disadvantaged by any conditions of 
employment that cannot be justified 
as necessary on operational grounds 
relevant to the performance of the job.
The group’s equal opportunities policy 
is reviewed annually and is available 
to employees on the group intranet. 
A copy can be obtained upon request 
from the Company Secretary.
Nationalities represented 
by our employees
5
Employee 
length 
of service
20%
55%
25%
0-4 years
5-10 years
>10 years
Key

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 047
Nanoco believes that investing in people goes beyond its direct 
employees and is therefore proud to announce that Nanoco has 
now partnered with Emmaus Merseyside as its affiliate charity.
We will be working with them over the coming months to 
help raise awareness of the struggles of homelessness within 
our local community and they will be our primary fundraiser 
for the upcoming Three Peaks Challenge in October 2024. 
They have many volunteering opportunities at their 
superstore over in Seaforth as well as their community 
garden and home base.
They are completely self-sufficient thanks to their thriving 
superstore and all money generated from their social 
enterprise is re-invested to support formerly homeless people 
living within their community. There are 28 companions who 
are currently housed by Emmaus Merseyside who help out 
within their community building, garden, superstore or out on 
their delivery vans.
Innovation protection
IP protection
While intellectual property ("IP") protection 
is inherent to the business model of 
entities in the semiconductor industry, 
entities’ IP practices can be a contentious 
societal issue.
Why it’s important: IP protection, on 
the one hand, is an important driver of 
innovation; on the other hand, some 
entities may also acquire and enforce 
patents and other IP protection in efforts 
to restrict competition, particularly if they 
are dominant market players.
Where we are: All employees at Nanoco 
receive training on the importance and 
correct approach to all types of intellectual 
property to ensure its proper use and 
protection. During FY24, the group ran IP 
refresher training for all staff to promote 
good practice. Regular meetings are 
held between the IP team and the R&D 
teams to ensure all potential IP is identified, 
assessed and documented in line with 
the correct procedures.
What next: Following the creation of the 
device fab and new analytical testing 
lab, Nanoco is bringing a number of 
processes and analysis in house that 
was previously outsourced. This will build 
on our internal know-how and skills and 
allow the development of new internally 
generated IP which can then be protected. 
Further work will be conducted to ensure 
all IP is protected at the appropriate level 
according to its nature and value to 
the business. 
Privacy and data security
The protection and security of both 
personal information and confidential 
or proprietary information that aren’t 
covered by patents.
Why it’s important: Establishing strong 
frameworks is vital to prevent mishandling 
of this information, considering the 
significant fines for GDPR violations and 
the potential repercussions of divulging 
group secrets.
Where we are: Nanoco aims to demonstrate 
and promote high standards of honest 
and ethical conduct throughout the 
group. Formal policies and procedures 
are reviewed annually and the policies 
listed below are available on the group 
intranet or upon request from the 
Company Secretary. All group employees 
are required to adhere to specified codes 
of conduct, policies and procedures, 
including, but not limited to, the:
	
| anti-bribery and corruption policy;
	
| whistleblowing policy; and
	
| equal opportunities policy.
All Nanoco employees are required to 
complete annual training in the areas 
of cyber security, GDPR and information 
security to ensure they remain up to 
date and alert to the signs of fraud and 
unethical practices. IT security metrics 
are monitored on a monthly basis.
What next: Nanoco will maintain its data 
security via ongoing regular training of 
employees and monitoring of performance. 
The IT systems will be managed on the 
basis of continual improvement to ensure 
the group remains secure against 
evolving threats.
Summary
Nanoco is developing its strategic 
approach to ESG and is committed 
to continued progress.
On behalf of the Board
Dr Christopher Richards 
Chairman
21 November 2024

Strategic report
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
048
TCFD disclosure 2024
As a company listed on the main market 
of the London Stock Exchange, Nanoco 
is obliged to make climate-related 
financial disclosures consistent with the 
TCFD framework in line with UK Listing 
Rule 6.6.6R(8). Despite being a small 
organisation with only 47 employees 
at year end (excluding Non-Executive 
Directors) and turnover of c.£7.9 million, 
the business has made progress towards 
meeting its TCFD obligations, although 
more work is required for the group to 
be fully aligned with the TCFD 
recommendations at this time. 
Governance
The Board takes responsibility for the 
oversight of all strategic risks facing 
the business. ESG issues, including the 
risks associated with climate change, 
currently fall within the remit of the ESG 
steering committee. The ESG steering 
committee is a cross-functional group 
with representation at Board level from 
the CFO. The CFO ultimately takes 
responsibility for reporting any relevant 
environmental or climate-related risks 
to the Board and its Committees and 
keeps the Board abreast of developments 
in reporting and performance requirements. 
ESG matters are currently discussed ad 
hoc but will be included as a standing 
item on the Board agenda and reported 
to the Board every six months going forward.
Board members have relevant capabilities 
related to climate risks and opportunities, 
including significant experience navigating 
energy markets. The Board acknowledges 
it can improve upon its broader ESG skill 
set and knowledge base, which will be 
considered by the Nominations Committee 
as part of any future appointments. 
Training is also occurring at Board level 
on ESG matters to improve the existing 
skill set. Read more about the Board’s 
roles and responsibilities on pages 38 
to 49.
The leadership team is responsible for 
the day-to-day management of operational 
risks. To support oversight of operational 
risks, the leadership team maintains a risk 
register of identifiable risks to the business. 
Within this register, the potential impact 
of climate change is currently highlighted 
as a macroeconomic risk factor. However, 
no specific significant risks were identified 
relating to climate-related factors. If any 
risks are identified in the future, these will 
be added to the risk register. Read more 
about our approach to governing and 
managing risks on page 33. 
Strategy
Nanoco has developed a new ESG strategy 
during FY24 which incorporates the 
climate-related risks and opportunities 
for the group; see pages 38 to 47. As the 
strategy is new and is in the process of 
being fully implemented, the group has 
not yet conducted a review of the 
resilience of its strategy, taking into 
consideration different climate-related 
scenarios, including a 2°C or lower 
scenario, and is therefore not yet 
compliant with this disclosure of the 
TCFD requirements.
Risk management
Climate-related risks are reviewed under 
the environmental management system 
which has been accredited in the year as 
compliant with ISO 14001. Under the EMS, 
all environmental aspects and impacts 
of the group were reviewed, risks and 
opportunities associated with those 
aspects were identified and objectives 
were implemented to manage those 
risks. Environmental risks are reviewed 
on a regular basis by the ESG steering 
committee, including reviews of new or 
changing legislation and changes within 
the business, its markets or supply chains.
As part of the group risk management 
process, all potential risks are assessed 
according to the probability of the risk 
occurring and the potential impact should 
the risk be realised. These include risks 
related to current and emerging regulations. 
Nanoco incorporated potential ESG risks 
to the register, which included a robust 
assessment of the group’s exposure to 
climate-related risks. Read more about 
the group’s approach to risk management 
on page 33.
Metrics and targets
Nanoco monitors and reports environmental 
performance indicators including waste 
and energy efficiency metrics. The group’s 
greenhouse gas emissions, including its 
scope 3 emissions related to business 
travel, can be viewed on page 42.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 049
4 TCFD pillars
11 TCFD recommended disclosures
Description and reference
Governance
	
| Describe the Board’s oversight of climate-related risks 
and opportunities.
Key risks and responsibilities – 
page 48, Corporate governance 
– page 52. Summarised left
C
	
| Describe management’s role in assessing and managing 
climate-related risks and opportunities.
Key risks and responsibilities – 
Summarised left
C
Strategy
	
| Describe the climate-related risks and opportunities the 
organisation has identified over the short, medium, and 
long term.
Sustainability report above
C
	
| Describe the impact of climate-related risks and opportunities 
on the organisation’s business, strategy and financial planning.
Sustainability report above
C
	
| Describe the resilience of the organisation’s strategy, taking into 
consideration different climate-related scenarios, including a 
2°C or lower scenario.
To be further developed in 2025
Risk 
management
	
| Describe the organisation’s processes for identifying and 
assessing climate-related risks.
Key risks and responsibilities – 
Summarised left
C
	
| Describe the organisation’s processes for managing 
climate‑related risks.
Key risks and responsibilities – 
Summarised left
C
	
| Describe how processes for identifying, assessing and 
managing climate-related risks are integrated into the 
organisation’s overall risk management.
Key risks and responsibilities – 
Summarised left
C
Metrics and 
targets
	
| Disclose the metrics used by the organisation to assess 
climate‑related risks and opportunities in line with its strategy 
and risk management process.
Sustainability report above
C
	
| Disclose scope 1, scope 2 and, if appropriate, scope 3 
greenhouse gas ("GHG") emissions and the related risks.
Sustainability report above
C
	
| Describe the targets used by the organisation to manage 
climate-related risks and opportunities and performance 
against targets.
Sustainability report above
C
C  Compliant with TCFD recommendation
Strategic report approval
The Strategic report on pages 5 to 49 incorporates:
	
| Chairman’s statement
	
| Operational review
	
| Our business model
	
| Our strategy
	
| Our key performance indicators

Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024
	
| Principal risks and uncertainties
	
| Viability statement
	
| Sustainability report
	
| TCFD disclosure

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
050
Corporate governance
We have strengthened our Board 
of Directors during the year and post 
year end, with appointments of Directors 
with key industry knowledge
Board of Directors
Chris was appointed Chairman of 
Nanoco Group plc in May 2016, having 
joined the Board as a Non-Executive 
Director in November 2015. 
Skills and experience
Chris is the former Chief Executive 
Officer of Arysta LifeScience, a 
Japan-based agrochemical business 
which grew rapidly under his leadership, 
with sales growing above $1.6 billion. 
After stepping down as CEO in 2010, 
he became Arysta LifeScience’s 
Non-Executive Chairman until the 
sale of the business in 2015 to 
Platform Specialty Products.
After gaining his DPhil from the 
University of Oxford in Biological 
Science, Chris worked as a research 
scientist for four years. He began his 
executive career in 1983 in the Plant 
Protection division at Imperial 
Chemical Industries plc, which later 
became Syngenta. For 20 years, 
he has lived in various countries 
including Colombia and Japan 
and led international marketing 
and commercial functions.
Other roles 
Chris currently holds a number 
of non-executive roles at quoted 
and private businesses. He is the 
Non-Executive Chairman of Plant 
Health Care plc (AIM: PHC) and a 
Non-Executive Director of Origin 
Enterprises plc (AIM: OGN).
Liam was appointed to the Board in 
November 2021. He originally joined 
the group as Group Financial 
Controller in March 2019, before 
becoming Finance Director and 
then subsequently joining the Board. 
Skills and experience
Liam started his career at KPMG LLP, 
where he qualified as a Chartered 
Accountant working primarily in 
audit on both large and medium‑sized 
public and private companies. 
After six years at KPMG LLP, he 
moved to Renold plc (LSE: RNO), 
initially as Group Financial Controller 
before moving into the European 
division as Commercial Finance 
Manager. He holds an Accountancy 
degree from the University of Liverpool.
Other roles 
None.
Dmitry was appointed Chief 
Executive Officer in October 2024. 
Skills and experience
Dmitry has over 20 years of 
experience managing businesses in 
the electronics and biomedical 
fields, with technical expertise in 
metals and other advanced 
materials as well as significant 
exposure to semiconductors, flat 
panel displays (“FPD”), photovoltaic 
(“PV”), light emitting diode (“LED”), 
and medical device industries.
Most recently, Dmitry was the CEO 
of the CPS Group of companies 
(later part of Exyte) from 2020 to 
2024, which was focused on 
high-tech equipment for 
semiconductors and life science 
facilities. Under his leadership, the 
revenues of the business tripled and 
the profitability increased four-fold, 
before it was successfully sold to a 
strategic investor.
Dmitry started his career with 
management consultancy McKinsey 
and Company, where he advised 
clients in the pharmaceutical, 
chemical and telecommunications 
industries.
Dmitry holds a PhD in Materials 
Science and Engineering from 
Northwestern University and a BS/
MSE degree in Physics of Metals from 
the Moscow Institute of Steel and Alloys.
Other roles 
Dmitry is a board member of 
QuesTek Innovations LLC.
Nanoco’s technology team is led by 
Nigel, who is a Co-Founder of 
Nanoco and inventor of Nanoco’s key 
quantum dot scale up technology. In 
2000, he moved to Manchester 
where he co-founded Nanoco 
Technologies in 2001.
Skills and experience
Nigel has co-authored over 70 
academic papers and is an inventor 
on 150 patents and pending 
applications. He has a passion for, 
and experience in, taking research 
work from the academic bench 
through to full commercialisation. 
Nigel graduated from Newcastle 
University in 1991 and chose to 
remain at Newcastle to pursue 
a PhD in the field of main group 
organometallics. 
After graduation in 1994, he 
undertook a postdoctoral fellowship 
at St Andrews University, Scotland, in 
the field of precursor design for 
metalorganic vapour phase epitaxy 
(“MOVPE”) growth and synthesis of 
nanoparticles using chemical vapour 
deposition (“CVD”) techniques. In 
1996, he won a Japan Society for the 
Promotion of Science (“JSPS”) 
fellowship and spent the following 
year working at Tokyo University of 
Agriculture and Technology, Japan. In 
1998, he became a Research Fellow 
at Georgia Institute of Technology, 
US, working on the design and 
evaluation of precursors used in 
MOVPE.
Other roles 
None.
Dr Christopher Richards
Non-Executive Chairman
N  R
Liam Gray
Chief Financial Officer and 
Company Secretary
Dmitry Shashkov
Chief Executive Officer
Dr Nigel Pickett
Chief Technology Officer

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
051
A  Audit Committee
N  Nominations Committee
R  Remuneration Committee
 Chair
Key
Alison was appointed to the Board 
in April 2017.
Skills and experience
Alison is an experienced entrepreneur 
and Non-Executive Director, with 
significant expertise in strategy 
development and implementation 
for start-ups, AIM/Main Market‑listed 
and not-for-profit organisations. Her 
early career included Zeneca plc 
and McKinsey & Company. She 
co-founded Techtran Group, which 
was acquired by IP Group in 2005. 
Alison spent 13 years with IP Group 
plc as Chief Technology Officer, 
Chief Operating Officer and latterly 
Director of Strategy and IP Impact.
Alison holds an MBA from Manchester 
Business School, a PhD in Organic 
Chemistry and a first-class degree 
in Chemistry from the University of 
Glasgow and an MSc in Mindfulness 
from the University of Aberdeen. 
Other roles 
Alison is currently a Non-Executive 
Director of Maven Income and 
Growth VCT PLC and a Non‑Executive 
Director of Thomas Swan & Co. Limited.
Chris was appointed to the Board 
in April 2019.
Skills and experience
Chris has considerable financial and 
operational experience and became 
the Finance Director of Unipalm 
Group plc, from 1996 to 2001. He 
then went on to become CFO of 
Searchspace Group Limited from 
2001 until 2005. Chris then went on 
to hold a number of non-executive 
roles across a range of companies 
with a technology focus in many cases.
Chris holds a Natural Sciences 
degree from Cambridge University. 
He then qualified as a Chartered 
Accountant with Arthur Andersen 
LLP in 1979 where he spent his 
early career.
Other roles 
Chris is currently Chairman of Racing 
Digital Ltd and Send Technology Ltd, 
both of which are private companies.
Dieter was appointed to the Board 
in February 2024.
Skills and experience
Dieter was Chairman and CEO 
of Osram Opto Semiconductors 
GmbH, one of the world’s leading 
optoelectronic components 
companies, participating in 
electronics applications such as 
facial and iris recognition, health 
monitoring, vehicle navigation and 
virtual and augmented reality as 
well as uLED displays. As CEO, 
Dieter developed relationships with 
leading companies throughout the 
sector. His earlier career spanned 
Senior Vice President positions in 
semiconductor technologies 
(Infineon), and connected devices 
and digital consumer services in 
both mobile consumer products 
(Nokia) and automotive (BMW).
Other roles 
Dieter is currently a Non-Executive 
Director of Nordic Semiconductor ASA.
Jalal was appointed to the Board in 
April 2024.
Skills and experience
Jalal is Co-Chair of the UK 
Semiconductor Advisory Panel, 
representing the views of the UK 
semiconductor industry. He was the 
CEO of Dialog Semiconductor plc 
(“Dialog”) from 2005 until the 
successful sale of the company 
to Japan’s Renasas in 2021. Under 
Jalal’s leadership, Dialog became 
a world leader in mobile power 
management and connectivity 
products, selling to most of the 
major companies in the consumer 
electronics and mobile phone 
sector. His earlier career included 
roles as CEO of Alphamosaic and 
before that at Sony Semiconductor 
and Devices Europe as Vice President 
and Managing Director.
Other roles 
Jalal is currently a Director of a 
number of private businesses.
Dr Alison Fielding
Non-Executive Senior 
Independent Director
A  N  R  
Chris Batterham 
Non-Executive 
Director
A  N  R
Dieter May 
Non-Executive 
Director
N  R
Jalal Bagherli
Non-Executive 
Director
A  N  R

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
052
Corporate governance statement
The group strives for best 
practice to ensure it can be 
flexible and responsive to 
business change and 
additional challenges 
that arise
I am pleased to present the Corporate 
governance report for the year ended 
31 July 2024. This section of the Annual 
Report describes our corporate governance 
structures and processes and their 
application throughout the year ended 
31 July 2024.
The Board’s view on 
corporate governance
The UK Corporate Governance Code 
embodies core principles of accountability, 
transparency, probity and a focus on 
long-term success. The Board firmly 
believes that a company governed in 
accordance with these principles is 
more likely to be successful and that 
this is all the more important in times 
of significant uncertainty.
The Board and its Committees play a 
central role in the group’s governance by 
providing an external and independent 
perspective on matters material to Nanoco’s 
stakeholders, and by seeking to ensure 
that effective internal controls and risk 
management processes are in place.
The Board also promotes a culture of 
good governance throughout the group 
by creating an environment of openness, 
transparency and accountability.
The members of the Board bring a wide 
range of skills and experience to the 
group as set out on pages 50 and 51. 
The diverse skill set allows the Board to 
appropriately challenge and lead the 
group’s strategy. 
Board focus during the year
Agreeing strategic priorities with 
the Executive Directors
The Board has devoted considerable 
time to strategic discussion in the current 
year. The group continues to expand its 
commercial offering beyond cadmium-
free quantum dots (“CFQD®”) into a range 
of dot-based nanomaterials for sensing. 
Our customers continue to invest in these 
areas with Nanoco, and have reported 
pleasing results, with Nanoco’s materials 
being described as “world class”. The 
group continues to invest in 
improvements in existing products and 
expansion into other materials.
Board succession
Dmitry Shashkov was appointed on 22 
October 2024 as CEO, replacing Brian 
Tenner, who had previously announced 
his intention to stand down. 
The Board also announced during the 
year that it had appointed two new 
Non‑Executive Directors. 
In addition, Dr Christopher Richards, given 
he has nearly completed nine years as a 
Non‑Executive Director, will not be 
standing for re-election at the next AGM 
and resolutions will be proposed for Dr 
Jalal Bagherli to become Chairman.
Strong corporate governance
The Board is committed to ensuring that 
a strong governance framework operates 
throughout the group, recognising that 
good corporate governance is a vital 
component to support management in 
its delivery of our strategic objectives 
and to operate a sustainable business 
for the benefit of all stakeholders.
Monitor performance
The Board reviews performance of the 
business on a monthly basis through 
formal communications from the Executive 
Directors. The Board provides oversight 
and challenges to the Executive Directors 
to ensure robust decisions are made.
Learn and improve
The Board is committed to continual 
development. During the year, updates 
on corporate governance and legal 
developments were provided by corporate 
lawyers. The Board intends to carry out 
further training on accounting 
developments and ESG issues.
Overall management of risk and change 
within the group
The rapidly evolving challenges brought 
about by Brexit, the Ukraine crisis and the 
cost of living crisis, against a background 
of other macroeconomic factors, have 
required active real-time engagement 
between all members of the Board. 
These focus areas were in addition to 
the normal ongoing responsibilities for 
approving the annual operating and 
capital expenditure budgets and any 
material changes to them. 
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 053
Male
Female
1
7
Gender
2
6
White
Ethnic minority
Ethnicity
A typical Board agenda
Each full Board meeting is structured 
around a standard agenda of standing 
items that then includes a number of 
additional specific focus items for that 
month’s meeting. These focus items are 
either recurring items (such as risk 
management) or are in response to 
emerging issues in our markets, 
regulation or the business itself. An 
example of an agenda taken from the 
July 2024 meeting is shown below:
	
| minutes and matters arising from 
previous meetings (standing item);
	
| CEO report on business performance 
(standing item);
	
| CEO report on progress and customer 
deliverables (standing item);
	
| CFO report on financial performance 
and rolling forecasts (standing item);
	
| CTO report on technical and IP 
matters (standing item);
	
| Company Secretary report on 
governance issues and any material 
litigation (standing item);
	
| reports from Committee Chairs (Audit, 
Nominations, Remuneration and EHS) 
(standing item); and
	
| any other business (standing item).
Certain key senior management members 
are invited to give presentations at Board 
and Committee meetings where appropriate.
Other areas, including the review of the 
group risk register, the strategic plan, the 
annual budget, contentious matters and 
succession planning, etc. are reviewed by 
the Board during each year at intervals 
commensurate with their importance.
Executives
Non-Executives
5
3
Board 
composition
0-5
5-10
>10
2
5
1
Tenure
(years)
Attendance
Board
Audit 
Committee
Nominations
Committee
Remuneration
Committee
Number of meetings
10
5
3
4
Executive Directors
Brian Tenner 
                 
       
1
1
 
1
Dr Nigel Pickett
                 
—
—
Liam Gray
                 
       
1
—
Non-Executive Directors
Dr Christopher Richards
               
     
   
   
Dr Alison Fielding
                 
       
   
     
Chris Batterham
               
       
   
     
Dieter May
         
2
—
Dr Jalal Bagherli
 
3
 
The Non-Executive Directors met five times during the year 
without any Executive Directors present.
1	 Executive Directors attended these meetings by invitation and are not 
members of these Committees.
2 	 Dieter May was appointed to the Board on 1 February 2024.
3	 Jalal Bagherli was appointed to the Board on 5 April 2024.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
054
Corporate governance statement continued
My role as Chairman
The structure of the Board, its Committees 
and their respective responsibilities are 
summarised on pages 55 and 56. My key 
focus is to ensure that Nanoco has an 
effective Board which is collectively 
responsible for the long-term success 
of the group. One of my most important 
jobs is to ensure that the Board and its 
Committees have the right balance of 
skills, experience and knowledge suitable 
for Nanoco’s evolving strategy and 
growth aspirations as we progress 
through a new phase of our development.
Board and Committee evaluation
Regular and appropriate Board and 
Committee evaluation is vital to improving 
Board effectiveness. This year, given the 
changes to Board personnel which have 
been communicated, it was felt that an 
evaluation would be best conducted 
once all recruitment had been completed. 
Therefore, Board and Committee evaluations 
have been postponed until FY25.
Shareholder engagement activities
Engagement with shareholders remains 
an important activity for the Board. 
The group maintained its more formal 
calendar of engagement with shareholders 
and potential investors.
Longer-term viability statement
The Board utilised the forecast for the 
next four years to assess the group’s 
long-term viability. This reflects the 
strong financial underpinning of the 
group. Further details are provided on 
pages 36 and 37.
Statement of compliance 
with the Code
I am pleased to confirm that the 
Company adopts the 2018 UK Corporate 
Governance Code (the “Code”), and 
Board confirms, throughout the year 
ended 31 July 2024, the Company has 
applied the principles and complied with 
the provisions of the Code, except 
Provisions 21 and 22 on Board evaluation 
as discussed above.
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024
A typical Board agenda continued
Number 
of Board
members
Percentage 
of the Board
Number 
of senior
positions on
the Board
Number 
in executive
management
Percentage 
of executive
management
Men
7
88%
6
3
100%
Women
1
12%
1
0
0%
Number 
of Board
members
Percentage 
of the Board
Number 
of senior
positions on
the Board
Number 
in executive
management
Percentage 
of executive
management
White European
6
75%
6
2
67%
Other ethnic group
2
25%
2
1
33%
The data in this table is sourced directly from the individuals concerned and based on their self-identification.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 055
Leadership team
The leadership team currently represents the group’s most senior business and operational Executives. It is responsible 
for assisting the Chief Executive in the performance of his duties including:
	
| developing the annual operating plan;
	
| monitoring the performance of the different divisions 
of the group against the plan;
	
| carrying out a formal risk review process;
	
| reviewing the group’s policies and procedures;
	
| prioritisation and allocation of resources; and
	
| overseeing the day-to-day running of the Company.
Remuneration 
Committee
Responsible for determining 
the overall remuneration of the 
Executive Directors and the 
remuneration of senior 
managers within the broader 
institutional context of 
remuneration practice.
Nominations 
Committee
Responsible for considering the 
Board’s structure, size, composition 
and succession planning.
Audit 
Committee
Primary function is to assist the 
Board in fulfilling its financial and risk 
responsibilities. It also reviews 
financial reporting and the internal 
controls in place and the 
external audit process.
Chief Executive
Has responsibility for managing the business and overseeing the implementation 
of the strategy agreed by the Board.
Board Committees
Support the Board in its work with specific areas of review and oversight objectives 
and risk management. They ensure the right group structure is in place to deliver 
long-term value to shareholders and other stakeholders.
Board
The Board provides leadership 
and is responsible for the overall 
management of Nanoco, its strategy, 
governance, long-term objectives 
and risk management.
It ensures the right group structure 
is in place to deliver long-term 
value to shareholders and 
other stakeholders.
Governance framework
The different parts of the group’s 
governance framework are shown below, 
with a description of how they operate 
and the linkages between them.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
056
Board composition and division of responsibilities
Role profiles are in place for the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and other Directors, which clearly set out the duties of each role.
Role
Responsibilities
Chairman of the Board
(Dr Christopher Richards)
Is responsible for the running of the Board and promoting a culture of openness and debate. 
The Chairman, in conjunction with the CEO and other Board members, plans the agendas, 
which are issued with the supporting Board papers in advance of the Board meetings. These 
supporting papers provide appropriate information to enable the Board to discharge its duties 
which include monitoring, assessing and challenging the executive management of the group.
Chief Executive Officer
(Brian Tenner)
Together with the senior management team, is responsible for the day-to-day running of the 
group and regularly provides performance reports to the Board. The role of CEO is separate 
from that of the Chairman to ensure that no one individual has unfettered powers of decision 
making. The CEO works directly through the leadership team (CTO, CFO and Operations Director).
Chief Financial Officer
(Liam Gray)
Works closely with the CEO and CTO to support them in the delivery of their roles. Key objectives 
are to ensure the smooth running of many of the back office functions. Includes responsibility 
for all financial matters including costings and plant efficiencies as well as commercial margins. 
Chief Technical Officer 
(Dr Nigel Pickett)
Responsible for all research and development activities of the group. Includes stewardship of 
the group’s IP portfolio, new additions and maintenance. Takes leadership position on critical 
new research areas.
Senior Independent Director
(Dr Alison Fielding)
Provides a sounding board for the Chairman and serves as an intermediary for other Directors, 
employees and shareholders when necessary. The main responsibility is to be available to the 
shareholders should they have concerns that they have been unable to resolve through normal 
channels or when such channels would be inappropriate.
Other Non‑Executive Directors
(Chris Batterham, Dieter May, 
Dr Jalal Bagherli)
Maintain an ongoing dialogue with the Executive Directors which includes constructive 
challenge of performance and the group’s strategy.
Company Secretary
(Liam Gray)
Ensures good information flows within the Board and its Committees and between senior 
management and Non-Executive Directors. The Company Secretary is responsible for 
facilitating the induction of new Directors and assisting with their professional development 
as required. All Directors have access to the advice and services of the Company Secretary 
to enable them to discharge their duties as Directors. The Company Secretary is responsible 
for ensuring that Board procedures are complied with and for advising the Board through the 
Chairman on governance matters. The appointment and removal of the Company Secretary 
is a matter for the Board as a whole.
Experience of the Board
The members of the Board bring a wide range of skills and experience to the group. This diverse skill set allows the Board to 
appropriately challenge and lead the group’s strategy.
The chart below summarises its key areas of significant experience.
Name
Strategy 
development
Chemical
Human 
resources
Corporate 
governance
Financial 
management
M&A
ESG
Dr Christopher Richards
—
—
Dr Nigel Pickett
—
—
—
—
—
Brian Tenner
—
Liam Gray
—
—
Dr Alison Fielding
—
Chris Batterham
—
—
—
Dieter May
—
—
—
—
Dr Jalal Bagherli
—
—
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024
Corporate governance statement continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 057
Compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code 2018
The below provides a guide to the most relevant explanations for how the Company has complied with each principle.
Board leadership and Company purpose
Page reference
A.	 An effective and entrepreneurial Board promotes the long-term sustainable success of the 
Company, generating value for shareholders and contributing to wider society.
38-56
B.	 Purpose, values and strategy are set and align with culture, which is promoted by the Board.
50-56
C.	 Resources allow the Company to meet its objectives and measure performance. A framework 
of controls enables assessment and management of risk.
28-37
D.	 Engagement with shareholders and stakeholders is effective and encourages their participation.
21-23 and 38-56
E.	 Oversight of workforce policies and practices ensures consistency with values and supports 
long-term sustainable success. The workforce is able to raise matters of concern.
38-56
Division of responsibilities
Page reference
F.	 The Chair is objective and leads an effective Board with constructive relations.
50-61
G.	 The Board comprises an appropriate combination of Non-Executive and Executive Directors, 
with a clear division of responsibilities.
50-54
H.	 Non-Executive Directors commit appropriate time in line with their role.
50-88
I.	
The Company Secretary and the correct policies, processes, information, time and resources 
support Board functioning.
50-61
Composition, succession and evaluation
Page reference
J.	 There is a procedure for Board appointments and succession plans for Board and senior 
management which recognise merit and promote diversity.
62-64
K.	 There is a combination of skills, experience and knowledge across the Board and its 
Committees. Tenure and membership are regularly considered.
50-54
L.	 Annual evaluation of the Board and Directors considers overall composition, diversity, 
effectiveness and contribution.
54
Audit, risk and internal control
Page reference
M.	 Policies and procedures ensure the independence and effectiveness of internal and external 
audit functions. The Board satisfies itself of the integrity of financial and narrative statements.
65-69
N.	 A fair, balanced and understandable assessment of the Company’s position and prospects 
is presented.
5-37
O.	 Procedures manage and oversee risk, the internal control framework and the extent of 
principal risks the Company is willing to take to achieve its long-term strategic objectives.
33-35
Remuneration
Page reference
P.	 Remuneration policies and practices are designed to support strategy and promote long-term 
sustainable success, with Executive remuneration aligned to Company purpose, values and 
strategic delivery.
70-88
Q.	 A transparent and formal procedure is used to develop policy and agree Executive and senior 
management remuneration.
70-88
R.	 Independent judgement and discretion are exercised over remuneration outcomes taking 
account of the relevant wider context.
70-88
The Code is published by the Financial Reporting Council, a full copy of which can be viewed on its website, www.frc.org.uk.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
058
This section of the Corporate governance 
report contains the group’s other reporting 
disclosures on corporate governance 
required by the Companies Act 2006, the 
UK Corporate Governance Code 2018 
(the “Code”) and the UKLA’s Disclosure 
and Transparency Rule 7 including the 
required statement of compliance. A 
copy of the Code is publicly available 
at www.frc.org.uk.
Disclosure and Transparency Rule 7
This statement complies with sub‑sections 
2.1, 2.2(i), 2.3(i), 2.5, 2.7 and 2.10 of Rule 7 of 
the UK Listing Authority Disclosure Rules. 
The information required to be disclosed 
by sub-section 2.6 of Rule 7 is shown in 
the Statement of Directors’ responsibilities 
on page 92 and is incorporated in this 
section by reference.
The Board
The group is controlled through its Board 
of Directors. The Board’s main responsibilities 
and those of its various sub-Committees 
are set out on pages 55 and 56.
To enable it to discharge its key 
responsibilities as set out above, the 
Board receives appropriate and timely 
information prior to each meeting. 
A formal agenda is set by each Chair 
and Committee papers are distributed 
several days before meetings take place. 
Any Director may challenge group proposals, 
and decisions are taken democratically 
after discussion. Any Director who feels 
that any concern remains unresolved 
after discussion may ask for that concern 
to be noted in the minutes of the meeting. 
Specific actions arising from meetings 
are agreed by the Board and then 
appropriately followed up.
The terms of reference of the 
Committees are publicly available 
at www.nanocotechnologies.com. 
The same pages of the Annual Report 
show the key officers and the division 
of responsibilities and duties between 
each role holder.
The Directors
There is a formal, rigorous and transparent 
procedure for the appointment of new 
Directors to the Board, which is led by 
the Nominations Committee.
All Directors are then subject to election 
by the shareholders at the next general 
meeting following appointment to the 
Board. In accordance with best practice, 
they are then subject to annual re‑election 
thereafter. The contracts of all Directors are 
available for inspection by shareholders 
at the AGM.
The Chairman has sufficient time to 
devote to his duties as Chairman and 
this has been demonstrated by his active 
participation in the group’s activities.
The Non-Executive Directors constructively 
challenge and help develop proposals 
on strategy and bring strong, independent 
judgement, knowledge and experience 
to the Board’s deliberations.
The Directors are given access to 
independent professional advice at 
the group’s expense when the Directors 
deem it is necessary in order for them 
to carry out their responsibilities.
The Board composition is partially 
compliant with Listing Rules LR 6.6.6R(9) 
and LR 14.3.33R(1), namely that at least 
one of our senior Board positions is a 
woman (Dr Alison Fielding is our Senior 
Independent Director) and at least one 
member of the Board is from a minority 
ethnic background.
We are not currently compliant with the 
requirement to have at least 40% female 
representation at Board level. The Company 
operates a fair, equitable system for 
selecting members for the Board taking 
into consideration the skills and expertise 
needed for the role. There were limited 
female candidates with the requisite skills 
needed to fill the vacancies in the year. 
Nanoco remains committed to diversity 
on the Board, and will consider our 
commitment to diversity when making 
future appointments
The group maintains, for its Directors and 
officers, liability insurance for any claims 
against them in that capacity. 
Donations
During the year the group made no 
political or charitable donations.
Independence and conflicts 
of interest
The group has effective procedures in 
place to deal with potential conflicts of 
interest. The Board is aware of the other 
commitments of its Directors and changes 
to these commitments are reported to 
the Board. The Companies Act 2006 
requires Directors to avoid situations 
where they have, or could have, a direct 
or indirect interest that conflicts or 
potentially conflicts with the interests 
of the group.
Directors are required to declare in 
advance of a Board meeting whether 
any of the business to be discussed in 
that meeting gives rise to a conflict or 
potential conflict. That Director will then 
be excluded from the relevant discussions 
unless agreed otherwise by the Directors 
of the group in the limited circumstances 
specified in the Articles of Association. 
They will not be counted in the quorum or 
permitted to vote on any issue in which 
they have an interest.
The Board considers its independent 
Non-Executive Directors to be independent 
in character and judgement. No 
Non‑Executive Director has been an 
employee of the group; has had a material 
business relationship with the group; 
receives remuneration other than a 
Director’s fee; has close family ties with 
any of the group’s advisers, Directors or 
senior employees; or holds 
cross‑directorships.
Professional development
On appointment, each Director takes 
part in an induction programme in which 
they receive comprehensive information 
about the group; the role of the Board 
and the matters reserved for its decision; 
the terms of reference and membership 
of the Board and Committees and the 
powers delegated to those Committees; 
the group’s corporate governance 
practices and procedures, including the 
powers reserved to the group’s most 
senior Executives; and the group’s latest 
financial information. Throughout their 
period in office, the Directors are updated 
on the group’s business, the competitive 
environment in which it operates, corporate 
social responsibility matters and other 
changes affecting the group and the 
industry it operates in as a whole.
Corporate governance statement continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 059
The group acknowledges the importance 
of developing the skills of the Directors to 
run an effective Board. To assist in this, 
Directors are given the opportunity to 
attend relevant courses and seminars to 
acquire additional skills and experience 
to enhance their contribution to the 
ongoing progress of the group. All of the 
Directors are given briefings on trends 
and developments in corporate governance.
Performance evaluation
The Board has established a formal 
process for the annual evaluation of the 
performance of the Directors. This 
evaluation is based on a performance 
evaluation questionnaire completed by 
each Director. The Chairman’s performance 
is reviewed annually by the Non-Executive 
Directors and led by the Senior Independent 
Director, Dr Alison Fielding. The evaluation 
of the Chief Executive Officer is performed 
by the Chairman and the evaluation of 
the other Executive Directors is performed 
by the Chief Executive Officer.
Directors’ dealings in the 
group’s shares
The group has adopted a model code 
for Directors’ dealings in securities of 
the group which is appropriate for a 
company quoted on the Main Market of 
the London Stock Exchange. The Directors 
comply with the rules relating to Directors’ 
dealings and also take all reasonable 
steps to ensure compliance by the 
group’s “applicable employees” 
as defined in the rules. The Directors’ 
interests in the ordinary share capital 
and in options over such shares of the 
Company are shown in the Directors’ 
remuneration report on pages 73 to 88.
Investor communications
Nanoco recognises the importance of 
good and timely communication. Its 
primary communication channel is the 
internet. All press releases are published 
on the Company’s website shortly after 
they are issued via the regulatory news 
service in the United Kingdom. In addition, 
a broad range of other relevant information 
is available on the group’s website.
The group also endeavours to ensure 
that all published information is capable 
of being readily understood on a standalone 
basis without the need for a one-to-one 
meeting. This is an extension of the “fair, 
balanced and understandable” 
requirement inherent in the Annual 
Report and Accounts.
Investor engagement
Meetings with analysts and institutional 
shareholders are held following the interim 
and final results and on an ad hoc basis. 
These are usually attended by the Chief 
Executive Officer and Chief Financial 
Officer. There are times when other 
members of the Board, such as the 
Chairman or CTO, also attend these 
meetings. Following feedback from 
shareholders, the group plans for the 
CTO to attend more shareholder meetings 
going forward.
Engagement during the year
Number
One-to-one meetings
23
Conference calls
5
Investor conferences
4
The group takes care to ensure that 
meetings with shareholders or potential 
investors are structured around 
information that is already available to 
all shareholders on an equal footing.
Feedback from these meetings and 
regular market updates are prepared 
by the group’s broker and are shared 
with the Board.
The Chairman and other Non-Executive 
Directors are available to shareholders to 
discuss strategy and governance issues 
at a shareholder’s request, and attend 
general meetings to meet shareholders 
where possible.
The Chairman and 
other Non-Executive 
Directors are available 
to shareholders to 
discuss strategy and 
governance issues at 
a shareholder’s request.”

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
060
Shareholder analysis
Shareholders at 31 July 2024 are analysed as follows:
Territory
Shares
%
UK
 180,782,854 
89%
Europe (ex. UK)
 5,318,200 
3%
North America
 13,002,308 
6%
Asia
 3,435,494 
2%
Rest of World
 32,641 
0%
Total
 202,571,497 
100%
Type of holder
Shares
%
Retail investors
 160,589,835 
79%
Hedge funds
 11,480,406 
6%
Directors
 10,314,015 
5%
Corporate
 9,569,875 
5%
Pension funds
 7,382,586 
4%
Trading
 2,581,771 
1%
Other
 653,009 
0%
Total
 202,571,497 
100%
Investment style
Shares
%
Retail
 155,957,609 
77%
Hybrid
 11,679,891 
6%
Directors
 10,314,015 
5%
Hedge funds
 6,488,626 
3%
Value and growth
 5,111,088 
3%
Corporate
 9,569,875 
5%
Trading
 2,581,771 
1%
GARP
 710,422 
0%
Pending
 148,000 
0%
Growth
 10,200 
0%
Total
 202,571,497 
100%
89%
11%
UK shares
(%)
79%
21%
Retail
 shares
(%)
95%
5%
Directors’ 
shares
(%)
Corporate governance statement continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
061
Annual General Meeting (“AGM”)
At the AGM, separate resolutions will 
be proposed for each substantially 
different issue. The outcome of the 
voting on AGM resolutions is disclosed 
by means of an announcement on the 
London Stock Exchange.
All shareholders are encouraged to attend 
the AGM and talk to the Directors there. 
All Directors, including the Chairs of the 
Audit, Remuneration and Nominations 
Committees, are available at the meeting 
to answer questions.
Shareholders not attending the AGM 
can contact the group via email at 
info@nanocotechnologies.com.
The table below shows the different 
resolutions proposed at the 2023 AGM, 
the proportions of possible votes that 
were cast and the proportions in 
favour of and against each resolution 
(resolutions 1 to 11 were passed as 
ordinary resolutions and resolutions 12 
to 15 were passed as special resolutions).
The Board takes steps to ensure that the 
views of major shareholders are considered 
through regular contact. As appropriate, 
the Board takes due note of their views 
insofar as these are relevant to the 
group’s overall approach to corporate 
governance. This is achieved, as noted 
previously, through feedback from 
meetings with significant shareholders 
and feedback from the group’s brokers. 
Votes for
Votes against
Votes withheld
No. Resolution
Votes
% of total
votes cast
% of total
voting rights 2
Votes
% of total
votes cast
% of total
voting rights 2
Votes
% of total
voting rights 2
1
To receive the Annual Report 
and Accounts
97,927,988
99.5%
30.2%  
453,803
0.5%
0.1%  
331,345
0.1%
2
To appoint the auditors
95,764,079
99.1%
29.5%  
893,662
0.9%
0.3%  2,055,395
0.6%
3
Authority to agree the auditors’ fee
97,033,029
98.6%
29.9%  
1,337,299
1.4%
0.4%  
342,808
0.1%
4
To re-elect Dr Christopher Richards
94,253,617
95.8%
29.1%  
4,116,832
4.2%
1.3%  
342,687
0.1%
5
To re-elect Brian Tenner
96,737,252
98.3%
29.8%  
1,633,197
1.7%
0.5%  
342,687
0.1%
6
To re-elect Dr Nigel Pickett
97,854,060
99.5%
30.2%  
517,804
0.5%
0.2%  
341,272
0.1%
7
To re-elect Dr Alison Fielding
97,803,916
99.4%
30.1%  
560,948
0.6%
0.2%  
348,272
0.1%
8
To re-elect Christopher Batterham
95,234,371
96.8%
29.4%  
3,130,493
3.2%
1.0%  
348,272
0.1%
9
To re-elect Liam Gray
95,218,406
96.8%
29.4%  3,152,043
3.2%
1.0%  
342,687
0.1%
10 Approval of Directors’ 
remuneration report
94,761,337
96.3%
29.2%  3,663,316
3.7%
1.1%  
288,483
0.1%
11
Authority to issue and allot new 
ordinary shares
97,635,430
99.2%
30.1%  
753,227
0.8%
0.2%  
324,479
0.1%
121 Disapplication of pre-emption rights 93,300,081
97.4%
28.8%  
2,516,415
2.6%
0.8%  2,896,640
0.9%
131 Disapplication of pre-emption rights 
on acquisition or investment
93,334,933
97.4%
28.8%  
2,511,769
2.6%
0.8%  2,866,434
0.9%
141 Authority to make purchases of 
own shares
97,720,811
99.3%
30.1%
704,731
0.7%
0.2%
287,594
0.1%
151 Reduced notice of general meetings
97,777,004
99.4%
30.1%
607,637
0.6%
0.2%
328,495
0.1%
1	 Proposed as special resolutions.
2	 Excluding treasury shares.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
062
Nominations Committee report
We are pleased to have 
bolstered the skills and 
experience of the Board 
in the past financial year
The Board has a wide variety of skills 
and experience that has served us well 
in recent years. As mentioned in the prior 
year, we were looking to add industry 
experience to the Board, and are pleased 
to have achieved this with the appointments 
of Dieter and Jalal in the financial year. 
Following the announcement that Brian 
Tenner intended to step down as CEO, 
we appointed Dmitry Shashkov on 22 
October 2024. Dmitry brings a wealth of 
industry experience to the position.
And finally, after nearly nine years with 
Nanoco, I will step down from my position 
at the upcoming AGM, and it will be 
proposed that Dr Jalal Bagherli replace 
me as Chairman.
Roles and responsibilities
The Committee is primarily responsible 
for assisting the Board in ensuring the 
appropriate composition of the Board 
and any Committees of the Board to 
match Nanoco’s stage of evolution. This 
includes considering new appointments 
and potential succession plans. The 
Committee evaluates the balance of 
skills, knowledge and experience and 
the size, structure and composition of 
the Board and Committees of the Board. 
This extends to reviewing appointments 
of additional and replacement Directors 
and Committee members by making 
appropriate recommendations to the 
Board on such matters by reference to 
the parameters set out below:
Board mix 
of skills and 
experience
Recruitment 
to Board and 
Committees
Diverse Board 
and employees
Strong 
governance
Supporting 
value creation
Members
	
| Dr Christopher Richards (Chair)
	
| Dr Alison Fielding
	
| Chris Batterham
	
| Dieter May
	
| Dr Jalal Bagherli
Estimated allocation of time in FY24
Performance evaluation
Succession planning
Recruitment
Governance
10%
10%
20%
60%
Estimated 
allocation of 
time in FY24
Dr Christopher Richards
Nominations Committee Chair

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 063
Governance
The responsibilities of the Committee 
were expanded a number of years ago 
to include a focus on continuous 
improvement in governance. The 
Committee’s terms of reference 
therefore include:
	
| reviewing and considering the 
Company’s procedures and controls 
for ensuring compliance with:
	
| the UK Corporate Governance Code;
	
| the FCA Disclosure Guidance and 
Transparency Rules, the Market 
Abuse Regulation, and any other 
applicable rules and regulations 
that apply to the group; and
	
| the timely and accurate disclosure 
of all information that is required to 
be disclosed in order to satisfy the 
Company’s legal and regulatory 
obligations under the Corporate 
Governance Requirements;
	
| recommending any proposed 
changes in the management of 
corporate governance to the Board;
	
| reporting on such compliance to 
the Board;
	
| reviewing potential conflicts of interest 
involving Directors and determining 
whether such Director or Directors 
may vote on any issue as to which 
there may be a conflict; and
	
| reviewing any related party 
transactions, with appropriate input 
from advisers, determining whether 
such transactions are appropriate 
for the Company to undertake and 
advising the Board accordingly.
Committee membership
In accordance with the UK Corporate 
Governance Code, the Nominations 
Committee consists only of Non‑Executive 
Directors. I have chaired the Committee 
since my appointment as a Non‑Executive 
Director in November 2015 and thereafter 
having been made Chairman of the Board 
in May 2016. The Board considers it is 
appropriate for me to chair the Nominations 
Committee in order to achieve a balance 
with the Audit and Remuneration 
Committees, which are each chaired by 
other Non-Executive Directors.
The Committee’s other members are 
Dr Alison Fielding, Chris Batterham, Dieter 
May and Dr Jalal Bagherli. All members 
of the Committee are considered to have 
experience and competence relevant 
to the duties and responsibilities of 
the Committee.
Summary biographies of all members of 
the Committee are detailed on pages 50 
and 51.
Meeting frequency 
and attendance
The terms of reference of the Committee 
require at least two meetings per year. 
When specific issues or changes need to 
be addressed, such as the appointment 
of a new Board member, the Committee 
meets on additional occasions. The 
Committee met three times during the 
financial year and was attended as 
shown in the table below:
Committee member
Meetings/
attended
Dr Christopher Richards 
(Chair)
3/3
Chris Batterham
3/3
Dr Alison Fielding
3/3
Dieter May
1/3
Dr Jalal Bagherli
1/3
As well as the members of the Committee, 
the Chief Executive Officer may be invited 
to attend, where there are no perceived 
conflicts of interest. On matters of 
remuneration of new appointees, 
the Chair works closely with the 
Remuneration Committee.
Meetings of the Nominations Committee 
are either scheduled around existing 
Board meetings or on an ad hoc basis, 
for example during a recruitment process. 
The Committee Chair provides the Board 
with a full briefing on all relevant matters.
The Chairman would not chair this 
Committee should it be considering the 
appointment of a new Chairman. The 
Senior Independent Director would chair 
the Committee in this situation.
Board structure and activities during 
the year
We were successful in attracting two 
Non-Executive Directors to join Nanoco, 
both of whom have long and deep 
industry knowledge and experience.
As was announced towards the end of 
the year, Brian Tenner, CEO, announced 
his intention to resign from Nanoco. On 22 
October 2024, Nanoco announced that 
it had appointed Dmitry Shashkov as 
CEO. 
Succession planning
The Chairman will have been with the 
Company for nine years in November 
2024. In line with good corporate 
governance, the decision has been taken 
for Dr Christopher Richards to step down 
from the Nanoco Board of Directors, and 
a resolution will be proposed for Dr Jalal 
Bagherli to become Chairman.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
064
Meeting frequency and 
attendance continued
Employee engagement
The Employee Voice Committee (“EVC”) 
was established in 2020 as an employee 
representative body which would aim to 
formally meet with a designated member 
of the Board at least twice a year. Liam 
Gray, CFO, took responsibility for formal 
engagement with the EVC, and took 
part in two of its meetings during the 
year. The EVC gave valuable feedback 
on employee concerns and issues, which 
has supported management initiatives 
to improve morale and employee 
engagement. Examples included holding 
“all-Company meetings”, giving more 
attention to mental health awareness, 
and considering alternative forms of 
reward and recognition.
Diversity
The group has always aimed to employ 
the right person for the right job, irrespective 
of sex, gender, race or disability. When 
recruiting at Board level, the Nominations 
Committee requires that any executive 
search firms used by the group have signed 
up to its industry’s voluntary code of 
conduct (prepared in response to the 
Davies Review of Women on Boards). 
The group follows a policy of appointing 
talented people on merit at every level 
and does not have a specific target for 
numbers of female Directors or 
employees. This reflects a market for 
industry skills that unfortunately still 
attracts more male candidates than 
female. The Board will also ensure that 
its own development in this area is 
consistent with its strategic objectives 
and enhances Board effectiveness. 
Other aspects of diversity in the group 
are commented on in the sustainability 
section on pages 38 to 47.
Review of the Nominations 
Committee’s effectiveness
Given the changes in Board and 
Committee composition, the decision 
was made to move a formal Committee 
evaluation into FY25. However, I am 
satisfied that the degree of rigour and 
challenge applied in performing the 
Committee’s responsibilities is 
appropriate and effective and continues 
to improve.
Dr Christopher Richards
Nominations Committee Chair
21 November 2024
Nominations Committee report continued
The Committee is 
primarily responsible for 
assisting the Board in 
ensuring the appropriate 
composition of the Board 
and any Committees 
of the Board to match 
Nanoco’s stage 
of evolution.”

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 065
Audit Committee report
Overview
The Audit Committee provides oversight 
of the group’s financial and narrative 
reporting statements, monitors the 
effectiveness of systems of internal 
control and risk management processes, 
and monitors the integrity of the group’s 
external audit processes. 
The Audit Committee monitors internal 
and external risk factors on behalf of 
the Board. These are maintained in the 
group’s risk register. The status and 
assessment of matters in the risk register 
also inform the drafting of the Viability 
statement. The Committee does not just 
respond to external factors but also 
supports and challenges management 
to anticipate future risks and opportunities.
Committee membership
The composition of the Committee 
currently comprises me, Chris Batterham 
(Chair), Dr Alison Fielding and Dr Jalal 
Bagherli. In accordance with the provisions 
of the Code, the Committee is made up 
of independent Non-Executive Directors. 
The Board considers that I have recent 
and relevant financial experience to act 
as Chair of the Committee, by virtue of 
being a qualified Chartered Accountant 
with extensive relevant experience as a 
former CFO and finance director of a 
number of private and public companies. 
All members of the Committee are 
considered to have experience and 
competence relevant to the material 
science sector.
Summary biographies of all members of 
the Committee are detailed on pages 50 
and 51.
Meeting frequency 
and attendance
The terms of reference of the Committee 
require at least four meetings per year. 
The Committee met five times during the 
financial year. As well as the members of 
the Committee, the meetings are usually 
attended on an invitational basis by the 
Chairman, the Chief Executive Officer 
and the Chief Financial Officer. The 
external auditors attend each meeting 
unless the business of the meeting does 
not need them to be present. The 
Committee also has meetings with the 
external auditors without the Executive 
Directors being present. Attendance of 
each member is set out below:
Committee member
Meetings/
attended
Chris Batterham (Chair)
5/5
Dr Alison Fielding
5/5
Dr Jalal Bagherli
2/5
Meetings of the Audit Committee are 
scheduled to occur in the run up to key 
events in the group’s reporting calendar. 
Each meeting precedes a Board meeting 
to allow the Committee Chair to fully 
brief the Board on all relevant matters.
The Committee has a pre-determined 
series of subjects and issues to be 
reviewed each year. These are then 
supplemented by additional review 
of emerging issues or changes in the 
financial reporting or governance 
regimes. In this way, the Committee 
ensures that key recurring themes 
are regularly reviewed while 
Chris Batterham
Audit Committee Chair
To provide oversight of 
financial reporting and 
disclosures and to ensure 
an appropriate risk 
management framework 
is in place as the group 
develops and grows
Members
	
| Chris Batterham (Chair)
	
| Dr Alison Fielding
	
| Dr Jalal Bagherli
Estimated allocation of time in FY24
5%
20%
50%
Succession planning
Accounting matters
Risk management
Internal controls
Financial reporting
10%
15%
Estimated 
allocation 
of time in 
FY24
maintaining the flexibility to adapt 
to changing circumstances.
In addition to the scheduled Committee 
meetings, the members of the Committee 
meet and discuss emerging issues for the 
business with the CEO and CFO to ensure 
that the work of the Committee remains 
appropriately focused on the risks and 
needs of the business.
Continuous improvements in the quality, 
relevance and timeliness of information 
being provided to the Committee and 
the Board as a whole ensure that similar 
gains are also made in the quality review, 
challenge and scrutiny by the Committee.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
066
Audit Committee 
responsibilities
The key areas of focus for the 
Audit Committee are set out below. 
This includes specific duties of 
the Committee in each area, how 
it operates and any changes and 
improvements made over time. 
The subjects referred to are a mix 
of annually recurring areas and also 
specific issues that have arisen or 
been reviewed during the last year.
Financial reporting
The primary objective is to ensure that 
internal and external financial information 
is robust, relevant, reliable and a firm 
basis for decision making by management 
and external stakeholders alike. These 
activities are typically carried on 
throughout the year. They lend themselves 
to a “continuous improvement” mindset 
that means we are always looking to 
do better.
Our responsibilities in this area include: 
	
| reviewing and monitoring the 
integrity of the group’s annual 
and interim financial statements;
	
| ensuring the appropriateness of 
accounting policies;
	
| reviewing and challenging the critical 
judgements and estimates used in 
financial reporting. This includes 
assessing any potential impact of 
accounting judgements and estimates 
on Executive remuneration;
	
| ensuring that the financial 
information being provided internally 
to the Board and to management is 
as robust as that reported externally 
and evolves to meet the changing 
needs of the business;
	
| ensuring the group remains up to 
date with developments in accounting 
and reporting requirements; and
	
| advising the Board on whether or 
not the financial statements, when 
taken as a whole, are fair, balanced 
and understandable. In simple terms, 
this means that shareholders receive 
adequate information to assess the 
group’s strategy, business model, 
risks and performance.
External audit
The primary objective in this area is to 
ensure that the group is subject to an 
appropriately robust, risk-focused 
external audit from a qualified and 
independent firm of auditors. 
Further responsibilities in this area include:
	
| advising the Board on the appointment 
of the external auditors;
	
| reviewing and monitoring the 
performance of the external 
auditors, which includes the 
planning and effective execution 
of the external audit process itself; 
	
| setting the audit and non-audit fees 
of the auditors to avoid any potential 
conflicts of interest with executive 
management (non-audit fees are 
set out in note 6 to the financial 
statements); and
	
| controlling the award of non-audit 
work to the external auditors to ensure 
that there is no actual or perceived 
threat to their independence.
Internal control and 
risk management
Our internal control and risk management 
processes are a fundamental part of 
the overarching framework used to 
safeguard the assets of the business 
and to ensure that investments represent 
an appropriate balance of risk and 
return. We work to ensure that these 
are as good as they can be for our 
business scale.
Our responsibilities in this area include:
	
| continual monitoring of the 
appropriateness and effectiveness 
of internal controls (including whether 
an internal audit function is required);
	
| review of lessons learnt and 
management remediation plans for 
any shortcomings or improvement 
plans to internal control processes;
	
| review of progress and commitment 
to addressing control improvement 
opportunities identified by the 
external auditors;
	
| review and challenge of the models 
and assumptions underlying the 
going concern and viability statements;
	
| continual focus on cash and 
cash forecasting;
	
| oversight of whistleblowing and 
fraud detection and prevention 
mechanisms; and
	
| ongoing review of the group’s 
risk management processes 
and systems, including a 
substantive review and challenge 
of management’s assessment 
of key risks.
The Audit Committee also assists the 
Board in ensuring the overall corporate 
governance framework is appropriate 
by giving due consideration to laws 
and regulations, the provisions of the 
UK Corporate Governance Code and 
the requirements of the Listing Rules.
Audit Committee report continued
Audit
Committee
Internal control 
and risk 
management
External
audit
Financial 
reporting

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 067
Financial reporting
Our approach to materiality
The financial statements must present 
a true and fair view of the performance 
and financial position of the group. They 
must also present a fair, balanced and 
understandable view. These are both 
aimed at ensuring that a user of the 
accounts can gain an accurate picture 
of the underlying performance and 
position of the business. To achieve this, 
all material matters need to be addressed. 
Material matters are those that are 
considered by the Directors to be 
sufficiently specific and have a large 
enough real or potential impact that 
they would be likely to influence the 
decisions of a reader of the accounts.
The Directors take a range of quantitative 
and qualitative matters into account in 
assessing whether or not a matter is 
deemed to be material. These include 
the absolute size of a potential adjustment 
by reference to the overall income 
statement or the financial position 
statement and also by reference to an 
individual component of the financial 
statements. Qualitative judgements 
include whether an issue would reverse 
or materially alter a trend (such as 
turning a profit into a loss, or growth 
into a decline).
In this way, the Directors aim to make 
sure as wide a range of issues as possible 
are considered without over-burdening 
the reader of the financial statements 
with insignificant or immaterial matters.
The Committee discharged its obligations 
in response to the financial year as follows:
Significant issues considered during the 
year in respect of the financial statements
The Committee assessed the following 
matters in respect of financial reporting 
and in the preparation of the Interim Report 
and the Annual Report and Accounts:
	
| continuing appropriateness of the 
group’s accounting policies;
	
| continuous development in the quality 
and transparency of the group’s 
external reporting;
	
| a review of key judgements and 
estimates made by management 
(see table below); and
	
| considering if the financial statements, 
when taken as a whole, are fair, 
balanced and understandable.
Significant accounting matters 
and areas of significant 
management judgement
The Committee, together with the 
Board, considered what the significant 
accounting matters and areas of 
management judgement in relation 
to the financial statements were and 
how these would be addressed. 
Each item is considered in further 
detail below.
Revenue recognition and deferred 
income (recurring item) 
The Committee reviewed the revenue 
recognition policies and management 
judgements made in the preparation of 
the financial statements. Where revenue 
relates to the sale of products, revenue is 
recognised on the transfer of risks and 
rewards of ownership. For services to 
customers, revenue is recognised on 
a time and material basis for delivery 
of services.
A major two-year work package that 
was signed in January 2024 with ST 
Microelectronics was the most material 
source of revenue in the year from 
services and material sales, and was 
ongoing at year end. Deliverables were 
all accounted for on the basis noted 
above regarding sales of materials or 
service revenue in line with the 
requirements of IFRS 15. 
A further two-year work package was 
signed in November 2023 with its Asian 
chemical customer and was ongoing at 
year end. Deliverables were all accounted 
for on the basis noted above regarding 
sales of materials or service revenue in 
line with the requirements of IFRS 15.
Other new sources of revenue earned in 
the year were derived from the sale of 
goods or the performance of short-term 
professional services work. A low level of 
judgement was required in assessing 
these contracts under IFRS 15.
The Committee concluded that the 
judgements and estimates made by 
management in respect of revenue 
recognition and, if relevant, the treatment 
of deferred income and contract liabilities 
were reasonable and appropriately 
disclosed in the financial statements.
Share buy-back
The Board committed to returning 
capital to shareholders upon receipt of 
the second tranche of cash from Samsung. 
This was achieved via a £30 million 
tender offer and a subsequent £3 million 
broker managed on-market buy-back 
which was on going at 31 July 2024. 90% 
of shares purchased in the tender offer 
and 100% of shares purchased in the 
buy-back have been cancelled and the 
remainder are held in the Employee 
Benefit Trust.
Key item
Judgement or estimate?
Materiality
Uncertainty
Revenue recognition
Judgement
High
Medium
Impairment assessment of the valuation of 
investments
Estimate
High (Parent Company 
only)
High
Going concern
Judgement and estimate
Medium
Low
Share buy-back
Judgement
Low
Low

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
068
Significant accounting matters 
and areas of significant 
management judgement continued
Going concern (recurring item)
The Committee considered the use of 
the going concern basis for preparing 
the financial statements. This is currently 
an annual recurring activity given the 
ongoing losses incurred by the business 
in advance of generating full scale 
production levels of commercial revenues.
Taking into account the group’s cash 
resources and the projected cash cost 
base, and the assessment by management 
and the Committee of the material 
potential risks identified in the group’s risk 
register and any mitigating actions and 
controls as shown on pages 33 to 35, the 
Committee concluded that the group 
has adequate financial resources to 
adopt the going concern basis for the 
preparation of the financial statements. 
Given the nature of the risks that the 
group faces while its activities are at a 
pre-commercial stage, the Committee 
continues to recommend that the Annual 
Report and Accounts maintains a relatively 
high level of disclosure of these matters 
in the financial statements – as set out in 
the sections on risk, viability and going 
concern on pages 36 to 37.
Impairment assessment of the valuation 
of investments
Having identified potential impairment 
indicators per IAS 36, the Committee 
considered the potential impairment of 
the investment in the main trading 
subsidiary, Nanoco Technologies Limited. 
As part of this process, Grant Thornton 
LLP were commissioned to produce a 
valuation which was largely focused on 
the potential outcome of litigation as a 
result of infringement of our IP. After 
reviewing their underlying assumptions, 
the Committee agreed that a reversal of 
the previous impairment would be 
proposed.
Cost of sales
As the group moved into a pre‑production 
and then full production phase, the 
accounting policies for cost of sales were 
reviewed to ensure they are appropriate 
for a manufacturing as well as an R&D 
service company.
Treasury
Due to the significantly higher cash 
balances in the group this year, the 
treasury policy was reviewed. This led to 
a £1.8 million gain from safeguarding the 
Samsung receivable via use of an FX 
hedge. The group also engaged a 
second banking partner to ensure the 
cash deposits are as risk free as possible 
while also securing a good return, resulting 
in £0.8 million interest income in the year.
Financial reporting on a fair, 
balanced and understandable 
(“FBU”) basis
The Committee reviewed the Interim and 
Annual Report and Accounts. As part of 
that review process, the members of the 
Committee were provided with a draft of 
the full Annual Report, enabling them to 
ensure that the performance reported 
therein was consistent with the Committee’s 
knowledge gained from regular reviews 
of the monthly management accounts 
and Board discussions of issues arising 
and business performance throughout 
the year.
The Committee also assessed whether 
the narrative description of the group’s 
activities and performance was consistent 
with its own understanding obtained 
through Board and Audit Committee 
meetings and other interactions it had 
with management. 
The CFO advised the Committee of the 
findings of independent readers of the 
draft Annual Report and Accounts. 
These reviews are carried out by Nanoco 
senior managers who have not been 
closely involved in drafting the Annual 
Report. Their knowledge of the business 
allows them to form an opinion if the 
document conveys a fair, balanced 
and understandable view of business 
performance in the current year. The 
Committee members themselves also 
perform this function by reference to 
the matters discussed at the regular 
Board meetings.
Drawing on this knowledge of the group’s 
activities and its own industry knowledge 
and experience, supplemented by advice 
received from external advisers during 
the drafting process, the Committee 
determined that the Annual Report 
and Accounts is fair, balanced and 
understandable and this finding was 
confirmed by the Board.
External audit
External audit plan
The Committee reviewed the proposed 
audit plan. The Committee was satisfied 
that the areas of audit risk highlighted by 
Forvis Mazars were appropriate and 
included all material matters. The 
Committee subsequently reviewed the 
actual audit report by Forvis Mazars to 
ensure that it aligned closely with those 
risks and the planned audit work.
Safeguarding auditors’ independence
The independence of the external 
auditors is essential to the provision of 
an objective opinion on the true and fair 
view presented in the financial statements. 
The Committee reviews the policies and 
status of the independence of the 
external auditors consistent with the 
ethical standards published by the 
Auditing Practices Board.
Auditors’ independence and objectivity 
are also safeguarded by limiting the 
nature and value of non-audit services 
performed by the external auditors (see 
later section). The group has a policy of 
not recruiting senior employees of the 
external auditors who have worked on 
the audit in the past two years. The 
group works with the external auditors 
to achieve the rotation of the lead 
engagement partner at least every 
five years. 
The current external audit firm and the 
current lead engagement partner are in 
their third year of providing external 
audit services to the group.
The external auditors are also required 
periodically to assess whether, in their 
professional opinion, they are independent 
and those views are shared with the 
Audit Committee. The Committee has 
authority to take independent advice as 
it deems appropriate in order to resolve 
issues on auditors’ independence. No 
such advice has to date been required. 
For the current year, the Committee has 
concluded that the external auditors 
remain independent and objective for 
the purposes of their role.
Audit Committee report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 069
Non-audit services provided 
by the external auditors
The Audit Committee will only approve 
the provision of non-audit services by the 
external auditors where they are permissible 
and do not represent a threat (by their 
nature or scale) to this requirement for 
independence. The aim is to ensure that 
no material risk is taken of the auditors 
both advising on and auditing the same 
information in the financial statements.
The Audit Committee’s approval is 
required for any fees for non-audit work 
paid to the auditors in excess of £10,000 
in any financial year. However, the group 
recognises that it can receive particular 
benefit from certain non-audit services 
provided by the external auditors due 
to their technical skills and detailed 
understanding of the group’s business 
and hence some non-audit work is allowed.
Non-audit fees of £100,000 were paid to 
the external auditors for the working 
capital report, required in connection 
with the tender offer which was 
completed in April 2024.
Separate external firms are engaged for 
taxation and Directors’ remuneration advice.
Internal controls and 
risk management
The Board has overall responsibility for 
the group’s system of internal controls as 
one critical part of the overall corporate 
governance framework. This includes 
reviewing the effectiveness of these 
controls and the processes in place for 
risk management. In accordance with 
the 2018 UK Corporate Governance 
Code issued by the Financial Reporting 
Council, there is an ongoing process for 
identifying, evaluating and managing 
the significant risks faced by the group. 
This process was introduced during 2015 
and is summarised on pages 33 to 35.
The role of the Executive Directors is to 
implement the Board’s policies on risk 
and control and to provide assurance 
on compliance with these policies. 
The processes and procedures in place 
are designed to manage rather than 
eliminate risk and operate within the 
Board’s defined risk appetite. They 
therefore can only provide a reasonable 
and not absolute assurance against 
material misstatement or loss.
Executive Directors have a close involvement 
with all day-to-day operations. They also 
meet with staff on a regular basis to 
identify and review business risks, the 
controls needed to minimise those risks 
and the effectiveness of controls in 
place. Business risks are monitored and 
discussed on a regular basis at meetings 
of the leadership and senior management 
teams. The principal risks faced by the 
group and other aspects of how they are 
individually assessed and managed are 
set out below and on pages 33 to 35.
Internal controls
Key features of the internal control 
system are summarised below:
(i)	 annual budgets and rolling 
forecasts are reviewed and 
approved by the Board;
(ii)	 monthly management accounts 
are reviewed and challenged by 
comparison to the budget;
(iii)	 written operational, accounting and 
employment policies are in place;
(iv)	 the Board actively identifies and 
evaluates the risks inherent in the 
business and ensures that appropriate 
controls and procedures are in place 
to manage these risks;
(v)	 expenditure approval limits and 
approval processes are in place 
to cover all major commitments;
(vi)	 quality assurance processes are 
overseen and audited by the internal 
quality assurance department, with 
a particular focus on non-financial 
processes and procedures which 
drive financial performance; and
(vii)	compliance with control procedures 
is monitored by the Audit Committee 
through its internal reviews and external 
audit findings and its reviews 
of exceptions.
The Committee considers that the need 
for an internal audit function is not currently 
warranted due to the size and complexity 
of the business but will reconsider this 
need not less than annually.
Due to the small size of the business 
there is minimal impact on the work of 
external auditors.
Whistleblowing and confidential 
reporting procedures
The group operates a confidential 
reporting and whistleblowing procedure. 
The policy aims to support the stewardship 
of the group’s assets and the integrity of 
the financial statements as well as 
The Board has overall 
responsibility for the 
group’s system of internal 
controls as one critical 
part of the overall 
corporate governance 
framework.”
protecting staff welfare. The procedure 
is reviewed annually by the Committee to 
ensure that it remains fit for purpose. No 
reports of whistleblowing were received 
during the year. Staff are regularly 
reminded of the whistleblowing process 
as part of ongoing engagement with 
staff on compliance issues such as 
anti-bribery training.
Internal accountability
The Board has overall responsibility for 
the group’s system of risk management 
and internal control. The Audit Committee 
reviews the effectiveness of the system 
at least annually on behalf of the Board 
and, having carried out this review, the 
Committee continues to believe that the 
system is effective in safeguarding 
shareholders’ interests and the group’s 
assets. There are some improvement 
areas, such as more regular reviews of 
internal controls, in addition to reviewing 
policies and procedures, and these will 
be implemented in FY24. The Board 
agreed with this conclusion. 
Review of the Audit 
Committee’s effectiveness
Given the changes in Board and 
Committee composition in the year and 
post year end, the review of the 
Committee’s effectiveness will take place 
in FY25. However, I am satisfied that the 
degree of rigour and challenge applied 
in performing the Committee’s 
responsibilities is appropriate and 
effective and continues to improve.
Chris Batterham
Audit Committee Chair
21 November 2024

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
070
Members
	
| Dr Alison Fielding (Chair)
	
| Chris Batterham
	
| Dr Christopher Richards
	
| Dieter May
	
| Dr Jalal Bagherli
Estimated allocation of time in 2024
Remuneration Committee report
Dear shareholder
I am pleased to present our Directors’ 
remuneration report for the year ended 
31 July 2024. The Committee’s report 
seeks to deliver an appropriate balance 
between the required regulatory disclosures, 
commercial sensitivities and the context 
for our approach and decisions.
This report is presented in three parts:
(1)	 Chair’s introduction setting out an 
overview of FY24 and prospective 
matters for FY25;
(2)	 the Directors’ remuneration policy for 
which approval will be sought at the 
2024 AGM; and
(3)	 the Annual report on remuneration, 
which sets out the actual 
remuneration earned by Directors 
over the year ended 31 July 2024.
This Directors’ remuneration report for 
the year ended 31 July 2024 complies 
with the requirements of the Listing 
Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority, 
Schedule 8 of the Large and Medium-
sized Companies and Groups (Accounts 
and Reports) Regulations 2008 and the 
provisions of the UK Corporate Governance 
Code (July 2018). The Regulations require 
the auditors to report to the Company’s 
members on certain parts of the Directors’ 
remuneration report and to state whether, 
in their opinion, those parts of the report 
have been properly prepared in accordance 
with the accounting regulations. Items 
that are audited throughout this report 
are clearly marked as audited in the 
heading of the section.
Remuneration and its 
strategic context
Our remuneration policy seeks to ensure 
a clear link between Executive Directors’ 
pay, the delivery of the group’s strategy 
to be a sustainable production company 
and enhancement of shareholder value. 
The Remuneration Committee seeks to 
ensure that the Directors’ remuneration 
arrangements continue to be aligned 
to the calibre of individuals, to the 
strategic direction of the group and 
to our stakeholder philosophy.
The Committee has always shown 
leadership in restraint of Executive and 
Board remuneration, reflecting the stage 
of development of the business. Nanoco 
Executives have relatively low base salaries 
compared to benchmarks and minimal 
benefits in kind. Short-term incentives 
reflect challenging annual targets and 
have typically preserved Nanoco’s cash 
by being paid in Deferred Bonus Plan 
options that create further clear alignment 
with shareholders’ interests. Long-term 
incentives are linked directly to shareholder 
value in the form of options with stretching 
share price and revenue targets.
Board changes
Post year end, on 22 October 2024, 
Brian Tenner stepped down from his 
position as CEO and from the Board, 
and was replaced by Dmitry Shashkov. 
The payments associated with his 
ceasing to hold office are disclosed 
in the relevant section of this report. 
15%
Performance evaluation
Employee engagement
Diversity
Governance
Reward and targets
15%
10%
5%
55%
Dr Alison Fielding
Remuneration Committee Chair
Ensuring our Executives 
are paid fairly and 
incentivised to 
deliver success
Estimated 
allocation 
of time in 
FY24

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
071
The Committee agreed a remuneration 
package to recruit Dmitry which reflected 
his calibre and experiences. A summary 
of his remuneration arrangements is set 
out below:
Base salary: £310,000
Pension: 7.5% of base salary
Bonus: Up to 125% of salary
LTIP: Participation in the shareholder 
approved LTIP scheme, as further 
described in this report
During the year, Dr Jalal Bagherli and 
Mr Dieter May were appointed as 
independent Non-Executive Directors, 
adding significant relevant industry 
experience and networks that the Board 
can draw upon. Non-Executive Director 
fees were increased as a result of the 
recruitment process during the year to 
£50,000 to reflect external market rates. 
However, there is no cost of living 
increase. The second increase in the 
Chairman’s underlying fees that was 
agreed in 2019 to reflect comparative 
rates of pay will remain on hold.
On 3 October 2024, the group 
announced the results of its strategic 
review undertaken by the Board following 
the European customer’s decision to 
change its strategic focus away from QD 
enabled infra-red sensors. In addition to 
steps already being taken to rationalise 
the Company’s cost base, it committed 
to reducing the size of the Board during 
FY25 without compromising appropriate 
corporate governance standards. 
Furthermore, immediately following the 
release of the Company’s FY24 preliminary 
results, each of the Non-Executive 
Directors will enter into agreements with 
the Company under which they will agree 
to defer payment of at least 50% of their 
Director fees until the earlier of the end 
of the financial year (31 July 2025), their 
cessation as Directors, or a potential sale 
of the trading business, with the accrued 
liability being satisfied at such time by 
ordinary shares of 10.0 pence each.
2024 incentive outcomes
Annual bonus 
Considering the performance delivered 
in 2024 and reflecting that 80% of the 
bonus is based on financial KPIs, the 
Committee determined that no bonus 
was due to be paid. A detailed description 
of performance against the targets is set 
out on page 82. 
Long Term Incentive Plan: 2021 outcome 
The long-term options, granted to the 
Executive team in 2021, lapsed as at 
31 July 2024 with nil value.
In assessing whether the outcomes 
generated by the annual bonus and LTIP 
scorecards were fair in the context of 
broader performance, the Committee 
took into account the commercial 
progress, the underlying financial 
performance of the group and the 
wider stakeholder experience (including, 
but not limited to, the shareholder 
experience). After due consideration, 
the Committee felt that the formulaic 
outcome was an appropriate reflection 
of performance delivered. It has, therefore, 
not exercised discretion in relation to 
incentive outcomes during the year.
Wider workforce
Nanoco’s workforce is critical to its success. 
As a responsible business, our aim is to 
pay our staff at the median level for 
comparable national roles, and we perform 
benchmarking exercises to review this. 
We are also a Living Wage Employer.
We have recognised the challenges 
faced by our employees with rising cost 
of living and have increased base salaries 
by 3%.
All staff participate in the Company 
bonus scheme, which resulted in payments 
of up to £3,000 per employee, pro-rated 
for start of employment, part-time hours 
and the achievement of various health 
and safety and cost saving targets.
Remuneration commencing 
1 August 2024
Our Directors’ remuneration policy was 
last approved at the 2021 AGM. In line 
with the usual timetable, approval for 
a new policy will be sought at the 2024 
AGM. Given the changes in Board previously 
communicated and the conclusion of the 
strategic review, the new policy is broadly 
rolled forward from the version approved 
at the 2021 AGM with minor changes to 
the text to aid its operation and reflect 
the passage of time. Our current intention 
is that the policy will be further reviewed 
in FY25, with a new policy presented for 
shareholder approval at the AGM in 2025. 
Our approach to the implementation of 
the policy for FY25 is detailed in the table 
on the following page. Linked to the 
roll-forward of the policy, we will also 
be asking shareholders to approve the 
extension for ten years of the Long Term 
Our remuneration 
packages aim to 
reflect the calibre of 
our Executives, maintain 
close alignment to 
shareholder value and 
support the commitment 
to our strategic priorities.“
Incentive Plan and Deferred Bonus Plan 
at the 2024 AGM – originally approved at 
the 2015 AGM and due to expire in 2025.
Brian Tenner stepped down from the 
Board on 22 October 2024. Details of 
changes in Mr Tenner’s remuneration 
arrangements have been included in the 
statement on the Company’s website, 
and further information will be included in 
the FY25 Directors’ Remuneration Report 
as required.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
072
Remuneration at a glance
Purpose and link to strategy
Key features
Planned for FY25
Actual in FY24
Salary
Basis to recruit and retain 
talent necessary to deliver 
the business strategy.
Reviewed annually.
Considers the role, responsibility 
and experience of the individual, 
corporate and individual 
performance and market 
comparators by size and 
complexity, and other 
Nanoco salary increases.
Dmitry Shashkov was 
appointed on a salary 
of £310,000.
Each other Executive Director 
will receive 2.5% cost of living 
increase. The rest of the 
workforce will receive 3%.
The three Executives received 
a cost of living increase of 3% 
versus 5% for the wider workforce.
Benefits and 
pensions
Provide a market-competitive 
benefits and pensions 
package and promote the 
wellbeing of employees.
Pension contributions equal to 
those for all staff.
Unchanged.
7.5% of salary.
Life assurance.
Unchanged.
Eight times salary for Executives, 
four times salary for other staff.
Workplace health programme.
Unchanged.
Implemented. Same as all staff.
Annual bonus
Incentivises delivery of 
annual key financial and 
strategic goals that support 
the enhancement of 
shareholder value.
Target opportunity is 75% of salary 
and maximum is 125% of salary.
Performance measures are a mix 
of challenging financial and 
personal strategic targets.
Up to 100% of earned bonus can be 
paid in Deferred Bonus Plan options.
Subject to malus and 
clawback provisions.
Maximum opportunity remains 
125% of salary for CEO, CTO 
and CFO. Brian Tenner will not 
be eligible for a bonus for FY25.
Financial targets 80% of 
maximum and personal 
strategic targets 20% 
of maximum.
No bonus earned.
LTIP
To reflect stakeholder 
philosophy, provide a 
long-term retention 
mechanism and align 
with shareholders.
Awards of up to 150% of salary, 
or up to 250% of salary in 
exceptional circumstances 
such as on recruitment.
Three-year performance period.
Performance measures 
reviewed annually.
Subject to malus and 
clawback provisions.
Awards of up to 150% of salary 
for the CTO and CFO and, 
having regard to his 
recruitment, an award of up to 
250% of salary in the case of 
the CEO. For all Executive 
Directors, the final quantum 
will be determined at grant 
having regard to the relevant 
circumstances at that time. 
Performance measures for 
the three-year period ending 
31 July 2027 will be set when 
the awards are granted, with 
further information included in 
the regulatory announcement 
at that time.
25% of the award will vest at 
threshold, increasing on a 
straight-line basis to 60% for 
target and then to 100% for 
stretch. There is nil vesting 
below the threshold level.
LTIP awards made in 2021 
lapsed with nil value as share 
price targets were not achieved.
Shareholding 
requirement
To align Directors to 
shareholder interests.
Minimum shareholding 
requirement for all Executives 
200% of salary.
Unchanged.
Unchanged.
Post employment
To further align Directors to 
shareholder interests.
To retain up to 200% of salary in 
shareholdings for one year post 
employment. Reduces to 100% 
of salary in second year.
Unchanged.
Unchanged.
Recovery 
provisions
To ensure recovery of 
Deferred Bonus Plan awards 
if required.
Possible in the event of material 
misstatement, material misconduct 
or a material corporate failure.
Unchanged.
Unchanged.
As a Committee, we believe that ongoing dialogue with our major shareholders is of key importance. Should you have any 
queries or feedback in relation to the Directors’ remuneration report, please contact me through the Company Secretary. 
Dr Alison Fielding
Remuneration Committee Chair
21 November 2024
Remuneration Committee report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 073
Directors’ remuneration report
Directors’ remuneration policy
This part of the report sets out the group’s forward-looking Directors’ remuneration policy that will be presented for approval by 
shareholders at the 2024 AGM and, if approved, will apply to payments made after that date. Given the previously communicated 
changes to the Board, the new Policy is broadly rolled forward from the version approved at the 2021 AGM with minor changes 
to the text to aid its operation and reflect the passage of time. Our current intention is that the Policy will be further reviewed in 
FY25, with a new Policy presented for shareholder approval at the AGM in 2025. The Directors’ remuneration policy is not audited.
Element and purpose
Operation
Maximum opportunity
Performance measures
Base salary
Core element of fixed remuneration 
that provides the basis to recruit 
and retain talent necessary to 
deliver the business strategy.
Normally reviewed annually and applied 
from 1 August (or at other times if 
required).
Consideration is given to the following:
	
| the role, responsibility and 
experience of the individual;
	
| corporate and individual performance;
	
| market comparators by size and 
complexity; and
	
| other Nanoco salary increases.
No maximum. Annual increase normally 
in line with the wider workforce. Potential 
further increases:
	
| on promotion or changes in scope or 
responsibility;
	
| taking into account an individual’s 
performance in a role;
	
| where there has been a change in 
market practice; or
	
| if there is a change in the size and/or 
complexity of the business.
N/A
Benefits
Provide a market-competitive 
benefits package and promote 
the wellbeing of employees.
The group provides life assurance of 
eight times salary, for all Executives and 
a workplace health programme in which 
all employees can participate.
Directors are reimbursed for out‑of‑pocket 
expenses incurred wholly and necessarily 
on group business.
Benefits are reviewed periodically, 
taking individual circumstances into 
consideration. Benefits provided may 
include, for example, medical insurance, 
relocation expenses, expatriate 
allowances and travel expenses.
No absolute maximum. The value 
of benefits is set at a level which the 
Committee considers to be appropriately 
positioned, taking into account relevant 
market factors based on the nature and 
location of the role, the level of benefits 
provided to other employees in the 
group and individual circumstances.
N/A
Retirement benefits
Provide market-competitive 
post-employment benefits to 
recruit and retain Directors of the 
calibre required for the business.
The group currently operates a salary 
sacrifice pension arrangement under 
which employees may elect to sacrifice 
salary and the group pays an amount 
equal to the amount of the salary 
sacrifice, together with the employer 
National Insurance saved, into a private 
pension scheme.
Executive Directors are also eligible 
to participate in the group’s defined 
contribution scheme (or other appropriate 
pension plan). In appropriate circumstances, 
Executive Directors are permitted to 
take an equal cash supplement (not 
counted towards bonus or LTIP opportunity) 
in respect of some or all of the pension 
contributions otherwise payable.
Executive pension contributions are set 
at the same percentage of salary as all 
other staff (currently 7.5% of salary). 
An overall contribution limit of up to 
10% of base salary (in addition to the 
amount of any salary sacrifice and 
employer NIC saved) may be applied.
N/A

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
074
Directors’ remuneration report continued
Element and purpose
Operation
Maximum opportunity
Performance measures
Annual bonus
Rewards and incentivises the 
achievement of annual objectives 
which are aligned with key financial 
and strategic goals that support the 
enhancement of shareholder value.
Performance targets are set annually 
and pay-out levels are determined after 
the year end following the Committee’s 
assessment of actual performance 
against set targets.
Up to 100% of any bonus earned can be 
paid in deferred shares or options under 
the Deferred Bonus Plan (“DBP”) that will 
vest after two years.
Deferred share option awards may 
incorporate the right to receive (in cash 
or shares) the value of the dividends 
that would have been paid on vested 
shares; this may assume the reinvestment 
of dividends into shares on such terms 
as the Committee determines.
Personal bonus element is ordinarily only 
payable if at least one financial target 
is achieved. 
Maximum annual bonus opportunity 
is 125% of salary. The percentage of 
maximum bonus payable for the 
different levels of performance 
would be no greater than: 
Below threshold	
0%
Threshold	 	
25%
On target	 	
60%
Maximum	 	
100%
On-target performance pays out at 
60% (and not 50%) as the Committee 
includes an element of stretch when 
setting targets.
Stretching performance 
targets are set each year, 
reflecting the group strategy.
Ordinarily, at least 80% will 
be subject to achievement 
of financial and/or corporate 
measures and the balance 
will be based on challenging 
personal objectives. 
The Committee retains 
discretion to apply different 
weightings in relevant 
circumstances and to 
override formulaic outturns 
where circumstances require.
Long Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”) 
To reflect stakeholder philosophy, 
provide a longer-term retention 
mechanism and provide alignment 
with shareholders.
Under the LTIP, awards of conditional 
shares, restricted stock or nil-cost 
options (or similar cash equivalent) can 
be made with vesting, dependent on 
the achievement of performance 
conditions, normally over a three-year 
performance period.
There will be no retesting of performance 
after the end of the performance period.
Vested awards are normally subject 
to a two-year holding period following 
the end of the performance period.
LTIP awards may incorporate the right 
to receive (in cash or shares) the value 
of the dividends that would have been 
paid on the shares that vest; this may 
assume the reinvestment of dividends 
into shares on such terms as the 
Committee determines.
The maximum value of shares over 
which an individual can be granted an 
award in respect of a financial year is 
normally 150% of base salary, although 
this limit may be increased to 250% of 
base salary in exceptional circumstances. 
The percentage of maximum awards for 
the different levels of performance 
would be no greater than:
Below threshold	
0%
Threshold	 	
25%
On target	 	
60%
Maximum	 	
100%
On-target performance pays out at 
60% (and not 50%) as the Committee 
includes an element of stretch when 
setting targets.
Vesting of LTIP awards 
is subject to meeting 
performance targets set 
by the Committee.
Performance targets are 
reviewed regularly to ensure 
relevance. Targets are based 
on financial measures which 
link to creating shareholder 
value (such as share price, 
revenue and EPS) and/or 
the achievement of 
strategic milestones.
The targets and their 
weightings may vary each 
year based on group 
strategic priorities. The 
Committee retains discretion 
to override formulaic outturns 
where circumstances require.
Shareholding requirement
To align Directors to 
shareholder interests.
In service requirement
Shareholding of at least 200% of base 
salary. 50% of vested shares under the 
DBP or LTIP (post tax) are to be retained 
until the shareholding requirement has 
been met.
Post employment shareholding 
requirement
Executive Directors, upon ceasing 
employment with the Company, are 
required to retain their shareholdings, 
up to 200% of salary, for one year post 
employment. This reduces to 100% of 
salary in the second year post employment. 
Shares will be subject to this requirement 
only if they are acquired from employee 
share plan awards granted on or after 
1 August 2021.
The Remuneration Committee may vary 
or disapply the in-service and/or the 
post-employment requirement in 
appropriate circumstances.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Directors’ remuneration policy continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 075
Directors’ remuneration policy continued
Notes to the policy table 
Application of clawback and malus to 
variable remuneration
Under the Deferred Bonus Plan (“DBP”), 
during the two-year deferral period, the 
Committee has the right to reduce any 
deferred bonus awards which have not 
yet been released in the event of a 
material misstatement of the group’s 
financial results, material misconduct on 
the part of the participant, a material 
corporate failure as determined by the 
Board, a material failure of risk management 
by the group, or in the event of serious 
reputational damage (i.e. a malus provision). 
For up to two years following the payment 
of a cash bonus award, the Committee 
may also require the repayment of some 
or all of the award in these circumstances 
(i.e. a clawback provision). Awards under 
the 2015 LTIP may be reduced, cancelled 
or have additional conditions imposed 
on them at any time prior to the end of 
the holding period in the same 
circumstances as outlined above in 
relation to the bonus.
Explanation of performance 
measures chosen
Selected performance measures for the 
annual bonus and LTIP awards reflect the 
group’s strategy. Stretching performance 
targets are set each year by the Committee 
taking into account a number of 
different factors.
Annual bonus
Ordinarily, at least 80% of the potential 
maximum annual bonus will be subject 
to achievement of a combination of 
financial and corporate measures, with 
the remainder based on challenging 
personal objectives. The Committee will 
disclose the metrics and performance 
against these on a retrospective basis 
to the extent that these are not commercially 
sensitive. The personal bonus element is 
ordinarily only payable if at least one 
financial target is achieved.
LTIP
The Committee intends to review each 
year the performance metrics for future 
awards taking into account the business 
priorities and strategy at that time. 
Targets will be based on financial 
measures which link to creating 
shareholder value (such as share price, 
revenue and EPS) and/or the 
achievement of strategic milestones.
The Committee also retains the 
discretion to adjust or set different 
performance measures or targets where 
it considers it appropriate to do so (for 
example, to reflect a change in strategy, 
a material acquisition and/or a 
divestment of a group business or a 
change in prevailing market conditions) 
and to assess performance on a fair and 
consistent basis from year to year.
Operation of the LTIP and DBP
The LTIP and DBP are operated by the 
Committee in accordance with their 
respective rules. These include the ability 
to adjust the number of shares subject 
to awards in the event of a variation of 
share capital, demerger, delisting, 
special dividend, rights issue or other 
event which may, in the opinion of the 
Company, affect the current or future 
value of shares. The “market value” of a 
share for the purposes of determining 
the number of shares subject to the LTIP 
or DBP award will be the average share 
price over the three dealing days 
following the announcement of results 
preceding the grant date. The Committee 
can determine that an alternative basis 
should apply but this would still be by 
reference to market prices such as the 
average price over the three-day period 
leading up to an award at a different 
date. All members of staff are eligible 
to participate in both schemes.
Early vesting of awards
As described on pages 78 and 79, 
awards under the DBP and LTIP may 
vest earlier than anticipated in “good 
leaver” circumstances.
On a change of control of the Company 
or other relevant corporate event (such 
as a demerger, delisting, special dividend 
or other event which may affect the value 
of an award), the extent to which unvested 
awards will vest will be determined in 
accordance with the rules of the 
relevant plan.
Awards under the DBP will vest in full in 
the event of a takeover, merger or other 
relevant corporate event.
Awards under the LTIP may vest early 
on a takeover, merger or other relevant 
corporate event. The Committee will 
determine the level of vesting, taking 
into account the extent to which the 
performance conditions are satisfied and 
the perceived value created as a result 
of such an event. Such vesting would 
ordinarily be on a time pro-rata basis, 
although the Committee has discretion 
not to apply time pro-rating.
How the Executive Directors’ 
remuneration policy relates 
to the group
The remuneration policy summarised 
previously provides an overview of the 
structure that operates for the Executive 
Directors. The same broad structure also 
operates for the members of the senior 
management team and all other members 
of staff with varying levels of participation 
in the LTIP depending on seniority. Staff 
other than Executives can choose to take 
some or all of their annual bonus as a 
participation in the DBP with a 50% 
uplift in the number of options on the 
value deferred. 

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
076
Directors’ remuneration policy continued
Remuneration outcomes in different performance scenarios
The charts below set out an illustration of the remuneration policy for FY25. The charts provide an illustration of the proportion 
of total remuneration made up of each component of the remuneration policy and the potential value of each component.
Five scenarios have been illustrated for each of Dmitry Shashkov, Dr Nigel Pickett and Liam Gray. In the case of Dmitry Shashkov, 
in each scenario his fixed remuneration and annual bonus is pro-rated to reflect the date on which he joined the company.
Below threshold 
performance
Fixed remuneration
No annual bonus pay-out
No vesting under the LTIP
Threshold performance 
Fixed remuneration
25% annual bonus pay-out (31.25% of salary)
25% vesting under the LTIP (62.5% of salary in the case of Dmitry Shashkov, 37.50% of salary in the 
case of each other Executive Director)
Target performance
Fixed remuneration
60% annual bonus pay-out (75% of salary)
60% vesting under the LTIP (150% of salary in the case of Dmitry Shashkov, 90% of salary in the case 
of each other Executive Director)
Maximum performance
Fixed remuneration
100% annual bonus pay-out (125% of salary)
100% vesting under the LTIP (250% of salary in the case of Dmitry Shashkov, 150% of salary in the case 
of each other Executive Director)
Maximum + 50% share 
price increase
Fixed remuneration
100% annual bonus pay-out (125% of salary)
100% vesting under the LTIP (250% of salary in the case of Dmitry Shashkov, 150% of salary in the case 
of each other Executive Director) plus an assumed 50% increase in share price from grant date
800k
600k
400k
200k
0
Dr Nigel Pickett £
Dmitry Shashkov £
Liam Gray £
Below threshold 
performance
Threshold 
performance
Target 
performance
Maximum 
performance
Maximum + 50% 
share price increase
1,200k
900k
600k
300k
0
1,800k
1,350k
900k
450k
0
Below threshold 
performance
Below threshold 
performance
Threshold 
performance
Threshold 
performance
Target 
performance
Target 
performance
Maximum 
performance
Maximum 
performance
Maximum + 50% 
share price increase
Maximum + 50% 
share price increase
Key: 
 Fixed pay 
 Pension 
 Annual bonus 
 LTIP
£838,323
£1,334,967 
£236,054
£258,910
£386,621
£527,924 
£597,415
£904,544 
£1,002,578
£1,722,467 
£168,786
£276,499
£427,297
£599,637
£717,142
93%
93%
93%
57%
37%
26%
22%
57%
46%
37%
27%
26%
18%
22%
14%
7%
7%
7%
4%
3%
2%
2%
33%
27%
49%
39%
18%
27%
33%
21%
4%
3%
18%
14%
27%
20%
33%
51%
21%
37%
3%
2%
2%
1%
33%
23%
39%
58%
49%
67%
27%
17%
2%
1%
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
077
Directors’ remuneration policy continued
Remuneration outcomes in different performance scenarios continued
Fixed pay currently comprises the following elements from 1 August 2024:
Current
base salary
Benefits 1
Pension 2
Total
Chief Executive Officer – Dmitry Shashkov3
£310,000
£621
£23,250
£333,871
Chief Technical Officer – Dr Nigel Pickett
£219,007
£621
£16,426
£236,054
Chief Financial Officer – Liam Gray
£156,673
£362
£11,751
£168,786
1	 No benefits are currently provided to the Executive Directors other than the group health wellbeing programme that was implemented in FY24, the value 
of which is included above, and under the group life assurance scheme, the value of which in the case of the Executive Directors cannot be identified. For 
illustrative purposes, Dmitry Shashkov’s benefits figure is assumed to be the same as Dr Nigel Pickett’s.
2	 Based on 7.5% employer pension contribution/cash supplement in lieu of pension which applies for the year ended 31 July 2024 (2023: 7.5%).
3	 In the case of Dmitry Shaskov, the full-year values in the table above are pro-rated for the purposes of the remuneration outcome charts to reflect the 
date on which he joined the company.
With the exception of the final scenario (which assumes a 50% increase in share price from grant date of LTIPs), the values 
illustrated assume a constant share price from the time of grant of LTIPs and do not take into account share price fluctuation or 
dividend equivalents that may be received under the share plans. The ultimate amounts received by the Directors may be higher 
or lower than the amounts illustrated above.
Remuneration policy for Non-Executive Directors
Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Other items
To enable the group to 
attract and retain Non-
Executive Directors of the 
required calibre by offering 
market-competitive rates.
The Chairman’s fee is determined by the 
Committee and those of other Non-Executive 
Directors by the Board.
Fees take into account several factors, including the 
size and complexity of the business, fees paid at 
companies of a similar size and complexity, and the 
expected time commitment and contribution for the 
role. Additional fees may be paid for additional time 
commitments and/or responsibilities. 
Overall fees paid to Non-Executive Directors will 
remain within the limits set by the Company’s 
Articles of Association from time to time or as 
otherwise approved by shareholder.
Non-Executive Directors are provided 
with Directors’ and officers’ insurance 
and indemnity protection and are eligible 
to be reimbursed for any reasonable 
hotel and travelling expenses and other 
reasonable expenses incurred in the 
performance of their duties.
The Non-Executive Directors do not 
participate in the group’s annual bonus, 
share plans or pension schemes.
Remuneration policy on recruitment
When hiring a new Executive Director, the Committee will seek to align the remuneration package with the above policy. When 
determining appropriate remuneration arrangements, the Committee may include other elements of pay which it considers are 
appropriate and necessary in the circumstances. However, this discretion is capped and is subject to the limits referred to below:
	
| base salary will be set at a level appropriate to the role and the experience of the appointee. We may agree future increases 
up to a market rate, in line with increased experience and/or responsibilities, subject to good performance;
	
| benefits and pension contributions will only be provided in line with the above policy;
	
| the Committee will not offer non-performance related incentive payments (for example a “guaranteed sign-on bonus”);
	
| other elements may be included in the following circumstances:
	
| an interim appointment being made to fill an Executive Director role on a short-term basis;
	
| if exceptional circumstances require the Chairman or a Non-Executive Director to take on a short-term Executive function;
	
| if an Executive Director is recruited at a time in the year when it would be inappropriate to provide a bonus or long-term 
incentive award for that year as there would not be sufficient time to assess performance. Subject to the limit on variable 
remuneration set out below, the quantum in respect of the months employed during the year may be transferred to the 
subsequent year so that reward is provided on a fair and appropriate basis; and
	
| if the Director will be required to relocate in order to take up the position, it is the group’s policy to allow reasonable 
relocation, travel and subsistence payments. Any such payments will be at the discretion of the Committee;

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
078
Directors’ remuneration policy continued
Remuneration policy on recruitment continued
	
| the Committee may also alter the performance measures, performance period and vesting period of the annual bonus or LTIP 
if the Committee determines that the circumstances of the recruitment merit such alteration. The rationale for any such 
alterations will be clearly explained in the next Directors’ remuneration report; and
	
| the maximum level of variable remuneration which may be granted (excluding “buyout” awards as referred to below) is 375% 
of salary, in line with the policy set out on pages 73 and 74.
The Committee may make payments or awards in respect of hiring an employee to “buy out” remuneration arrangements forfeited 
on leaving a previous employment or engagement. In doing so, the Committee will take account of relevant factors, including 
any performance conditions attached to the forfeited arrangements and the time over which they would have vested or been 
paid. The Committee will generally seek to structure buyout awards or payments on a comparable basis to the remuneration 
arrangements forfeited. Any such payments or awards are excluded from the maximum level of variable remuneration referred to 
previously. “Buyout” awards will ordinarily be granted on the basis that they are subject to forfeiture or “clawback” in the event of 
departure within twelve months of joining the group, although the Committee will retain discretion not to apply forfeiture or 
clawback in appropriate circumstances.
Any share awards referred to in this section will be granted as far as possible under the group’s existing share plans. If necessary, 
and subject to the limits referred to above, recruitment awards may be granted outside of these plans.
Where a position is filled internally, any ongoing remuneration obligations or outstanding variable pay elements shall be allowed 
to continue in accordance with their terms.
Fees payable to a newly appointed Chairman or Non-Executive Director will be in line with the policy in place at the time of 
appointment and based on current market rates of pay for equivalent roles.
External appointments
The group recognises that Executive Directors may be invited to become Non-Executive Directors of other companies and 
that this can help broaden the skills and experience of a Director. Subject to the approval of the Board, Executive Directors are 
normally permitted to accept external appointments and may retain fees for such appointments where no significant actual or 
potential conflict of interest arises and provided that the Director is able to maintain his time commitment to the group. There are 
currently no such appointments.
Payment for loss of office
The group’s policy is that Executive Directors’ service contracts should be capable of termination on not more than six months’ 
notice. This policy was implemented during FY21 with notice periods being shortened by agreement with the continuing Executives. 
The duration of Directors’ service contracts is disclosed on page 88. The principles on which the determination of payments for 
loss of office will be approached are set out below:
Element
Policy
Payment in lieu 
of notice
The group has discretion to make a payment in lieu of notice which would include base salary and benefits 
for the unexpired period of notice, up to a maximum of six months’ notice.
Annual bonus
At the Committee’s discretion, on an individual basis, any annual bonus award will be dependent on a 
number of factors, such as the circumstances of departure and their contribution to the business during 
the period. Any bonus will normally be pro-rated for time and will be paid at the usual time (although the 
Committee retains discretion to pay the annual bonus award earlier in appropriate circumstances). Any such 
bonus can, at the discretion of the Committee, be paid wholly in cash.
DBP
Determined in accordance with the rules of the DBP.
Unvested awards will normally lapse on cessation of employment. However, at the Committee’s discretion, 
if a participant is deemed to be a “good leaver” (such as leaving due to death, ill health, injury, disability, 
redundancy or the sale of his employer), the Committee shall determine whether any unvested award will 
vest at cessation or at the normal vesting date. In either case, the extent of vesting will be determined by 
the Committee, taking into account, unless the Committee determines otherwise, the period of time elapsed 
from the date of grant to the date of cessation relative to the deferral period. Awards may then be exercised 
during such period as the Committee determines.
Awards (in the form of nil-cost options) which have vested but remain unexercised at the date of cessation 
may be exercised if a participant is a good leaver at the discretion of the Committee. Awards may then be 
exercised for such period as the Committee determines.
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 079
Element
Policy
LTIP
Determined in accordance with the rules of the shareholder-approved LTIP.
Unvested awards will normally lapse on cessation of employment. However, if a participant is deemed to be a 
good leaver, the Committee shall determine whether the award is released on the normal release date or the 
date of cessation (or on some other date). The extent of vesting will be determined by the Committee taking 
into account the extent to which the performance condition is satisfied and, unless the Committee 
determines otherwise, the period of time elapsed from the date of grant to the date of cessation relative 
to the performance period. Awards may then be exercised during such period as the Committee determines.
If a participant leaves for any reason (other than summary dismissal) after an award has vested but before it 
has been released (i.e. during the holding period), his award will ordinarily continue to the normal release date 
when it will be released to the extent it vested. The Committee retains discretion to release awards when the 
participant leaves. If the participant is summarily dismissed, their award will lapse. Awards (in the form of 
nil-cost options) which have vested and been released but remain unexercised at the date of cessation may 
be exercised if a participant is deemed to be a good leaver. Awards may then be exercised for such period 
as the Committee determines.
Mitigation
The Committee’s practice is that if an Executive Director’s employment is terminated, any compensation 
payment will be calculated in accordance with normal legal principles including the application of mitigation 
to the extent appropriate to the circumstances of the termination.
Other payments
In appropriate circumstances, payments may also be made in respect of accrued holiday, outplacement 
and legal fees.
Where a buyout award has been made, the leaver provisions would be determined at the time of the award.
The Committee reserves the right to make additional exit payments where such payments are made in good faith in discharge 
of an existing legal obligation (or by way of damages for breach of such an obligation) or by way of settlement or compromise 
of any claim arising in connection with the termination of a Director’s office or employment.
Where the Committee retains discretion, it will be used to provide flexibility in certain situations, taking into account the particular 
circumstances of the Director’s departure and performance.
There is no entitlement to any compensation in the event of Non-Executive Directors’ fixed-term agreements not being renewed 
or the agreement terminating earlier.
Consideration of employees’ pay
The Committee generally considers pay and employment conditions elsewhere in the group when considering the Directors’ 
remuneration. When considering base salary increases, the Committee reviews overall levels of base pay increases offered to 
other employees. Employees are not actively consulted on Directors’ remuneration. Employee share ownership is fundamental 
to the group’s culture and is reflected in the universal participation in both of our share incentive plans.
Existing contractual arrangements
The Committee retains discretion to make any remuneration payment and/or payment for loss of office outside the policy in this report:
	
| where the terms of the payment were agreed before the policy came into effect, provided that they are in line with the 
Directors’ remuneration policy approved at the 2021 AGM;
	
| where the terms of the payment were agreed at a time when the relevant individual was not a Director of the Company and, in 
the opinion of the Committee, the payment was not in consideration of the individual becoming a Director of the Company; and
	
| to satisfy contractual commitments under legacy remuneration arrangements.
For these purposes, “payments” includes the satisfaction of awards of variable remuneration and, in relation to an award over 
shares, the terms of the payment are agreed at the time the award is granted.
Consultation with shareholders
The Committee considers shareholder feedback received on remuneration matters, as well as any additional comments received 
during any other meetings with shareholders. The Committee consulted with major shareholders in respect of the changes to the 
remuneration policy that was approved at the 2021 AGM.
Directors’ remuneration policy continued
Payment for loss of office continued

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
080
Annual report on remuneration
This report sets out details of the amounts earned by Directors during FY24 and provides details as to how the Committee intends 
to implement the policy during FY25. This part of the report will be subject to an advisory shareholder vote at the 2024 AGM. 
This report contains unaudited information except where stated that it is audited.
Remuneration Committee
The Committee comprises Dr Alison Fielding, who is Chair of the Committee, Chris Batterham, Dr Christopher Richards, Dieter May 
(from 1 February 2024) and Dr Jalal Bagherli (from 5 April 2024), each of whom is considered to be independent. The Committee 
may invite anyone it deems appropriate to attend and advise at meetings, including the Chief Executive Officer, the Chief Financial 
Officer and the Chief Technology Officer, although no Director is present when their own remuneration is being discussed. The 
Committee is responsible for establishing a formal and transparent procedure for developing policy on Executive remuneration 
and for setting the remuneration of the Directors and certain senior management, as well as reviewing the performance of the 
Executive Directors of the Company. The terms of reference of the Remuneration Committee can be found in the Investors section 
of the group’s website.
The Committee met four times during the year; its meetings are minuted and its recommendations are presented to the Board.
Advisers to the Committee
The Chief Executive Officer is consulted on the remuneration of those who report directly to him and also of other senior 
Executives. No Executive Director or employee is present or takes part in discussions in respect of matters relating directly 
to their own remuneration. During the year, the Committee was assisted in its work by the following external consultants:
Adviser
Details of appointment
Services provided by the adviser
Fees paid for remuneration advice
Other services in FY24
Deloitte LLP 
(“Deloitte”)
Appointed by the 
Remuneration 
Committee in 
June 2015.
Various advice on 
Executive remuneration.
The fees for advice provided to 
the Committee during the 
financial year were £8,875 
(2023: £4,600).
Charged on a time/cost basis or 
fixed fee depending on project.
Advice to management in 
relation to the Directors’ 
remuneration report and 
the Company’s employee 
share schemes.
Deloitte is a member of the Remuneration Consultants Group and, as such, voluntarily operates under its Code of Conduct in 
relation to Executive remuneration consulting in the UK. The Remuneration Committee took into account the Code of Conduct 
when reviewing the appointment of Deloitte. The Committee is satisfied that the remuneration advice provided by Deloitte is 
objective and independent.
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
081
Annual report on remuneration continued
Single total figure of remuneration for 2024 (audited information)
The remuneration of the Directors who served on the Board of Nanoco Group plc during the year to 31 July 2024 is as follows 
(footnotes for both tables are below the second table):
Base salary
and fees 1
£’000
Benefits
in kind 2
£’000
Annual bonus
in cash
£’000
Annual bonus
in shares
£’000
Long-term
incentives
£’000
Pension 3
£’000
Total 2024
£’000
Total fixed
remuneration
£’000
Total variable
remuneration
£’000
Executive Directors
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brian Tenner
300
1
—
—
—
22
323
323
—
Dr Nigel Pickett
214
1
—
—
—
17
232
232
—
Liam Gray
153
1
—
—
—
13
167
167
—
Total Executive Directors
667
3
—
—
—
52
722
722
—
Non-Executive Directors
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dr Christopher Richards
100
—
—
—
—
—
100
100
—
Dr Alison Fielding4
50
—
—
—
—
—
50
50
—
Chris Batterham4
50
—
—
—
—
—
50
50
—
Dieter May5
25
—
—
—
—
—
25
25
—
Dr Jalal Bagherli6
16
—
—
—
—
—
16
16
—
Total Non-Executive 
Directors
241
—
—
—
—
—
241
241
—
Total 
908
3
—
—
—
52
963
963
—
The remuneration of the Directors who served on the Board of Nanoco Group plc during the year to 31 July 2023 was as follows:
Base salary
and fees
£’000
Benefits
in kind
£’000
Annual bonus
in cash
£’000
Annual bonus
in shares
£’000
Long-term
incentives
£’000
Pension
£’000
Total 2023
£’000
Total fixed
remuneration
£’000
Total variable
remuneration
£’000
Executive Directors
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brian Tenner
292
—
228
118
—
22
660
314
346
Dr Nigel Pickett
207
—
168
87
—
16
478
223
255
Liam Gray
148
—
117
60
—
11
336
159
177
Total Executive Directors
647
—
513
265
—
49
1,474
696
778
Non-Executive Directors
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dr Christopher Richards
100
—
—
—
—
—
100
100
—
Dr Alison Fielding
46
—
—
—
—
—
46
46
—
Chris Batterham
46
—
—
—
—
—
46
46
—
Henry Turcan7
8
—
—
—
—
—
8
8
—
Total Non-Executive 
Directors
200
—
—
—
—
—
200
200
—
Total 
847
—
513
265
—
49
1,674
896
778
1	 If less than a year was served, salary or fees are from the date of appointment or to the date of retirement. The Executive Directors’ salaries are shown 
before any salary sacrifice pension contributions.
2	 The benefits provided to the Executive Directors are individual memberships of the employee private healthcare scheme. Executive Directors also receive 
life cover which is contained within a policy covering all employees such that it is not possible to identify the proportion of the premium in respect of 
Directors either individually or as a whole.
3	 The pension figure represents the cash value of Company pension contributions and/or cash in lieu of pension contributions. This does not include the 
amount of the salary sacrifice paid as a pension but does include the employer National Insurance saved that is paid into a private pension scheme.
4	 Dr Alison Fielding and Chris Batterham received a fee increase from 1 February 2024 to £55,000.
5	 Dieter May was appointed to the Board on 1 February 2024 on an annualised fee of £50,000. The figure above in FY24 discloses his fee between the date 
of his appointment and 31 July 2024.
6	 Dr Jalal Bagherli was appointed to the Board on 5 April 2024 on an annualised fee of £50,000. The figure above in FY24 discloses his fee between the 
date of his appointment and 31 July 2024.
7	 Henry Turcan was a representative of the shareholder Lombard Odier Asset Management, and Nanoco paid £nil (2023: £8,000) for these services direct 
to Lombard Odier Asset Management. Henry Turcan resigned from the Board on 12 September 2022.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
082
Annual report on remuneration continued
Individual elements of remuneration for the year ended 31 July 2024
Base salary
Executive Directors’ base salaries for FY24 were set as disclosed in the FY23 Directors’ remuneration report taking into account 
in the case of each Executive Director the 3% inflationary increase. Accordingly, the salaries were set as: Brian Tenner, £300,245 
(2023: £291,500); Dr Nigel Pickett, £213,665 (2023: £207,442); and Liam Gray, £152,852 (2023: £148,400).
Annual bonus
For the year ended 31 July 2024, the maximum bonus for Dr Nigel Pickett, Brian Tenner and Liam Gray was 125% of salary. The 
annual bonuses comprise two elements: financial corporate objectives (80% of award or 100% of salary) and personal objectives 
(20% of award or 25% of salary). Bonuses for personal objectives are only payable if at least one financial corporate objective 
is achieved. 
Threshold financial target performance was not achieved during the year on either financial metric and hence no bonuses were 
due. Performance against financial and personal targets is shown in the tables below with the financial and corporate measures 
and their weighting as a percentage of maximum award for the year ended 31 July 2024:
Measure and weighting as a 
percentage of maximum award
Threshold performance level
Maximum performance level
Performance achieved
Bonus earned as a
percentage of maximum award
Revenue and other operating 
income (60%)
£8.6m
£9.6m
£7.9m
0%
Adjusted EBITDA (20%)
£2.3m
£2.9m
£1.2m 
0%
The Committee concluded that for the assessment of the financial metrics, the performance achieved should be taken from the 
statutory accounts.
The personal objectives and amounts payable in respect of Brian Tenner, Dr Nigel Pickett and Liam Gray are set out in the table 
below. Specific bonus targets have not been disclosed by the Committee where they are considered to be commercially 
sensitive. The current stage of the group’s development means certain retrospective information could still give competitors 
insight into the strategic plans of the business, which is not in the interest of shareholders.
Director
Measure
Weighting
(% of maximum
bonus opportunity)
Achievement
(% of maximum 
bonus opportunity)
Brian Tenner
Financial and corporate measures
80
—
Personal objectives
20
—
Create in-house device capability
Achieved
Commercial production
 
Partial
New long-term JDA contracts with existing customers
 
Achieved
Win additional Tier 1 JDA
 
None
Dr Nigel Pickett
Financial and corporate measures
80
—
Personal objectives
20
—
Deliver additional grant funding
None
Focused expansion of IP portfolio
 
Partial
Win additional Tier 1 JDA
 
None
Deliver all JDA milestones
 
Achieved
Liam Gray
Financial and corporate measures
80
—
Personal objectives
20
—
Develop and implement a comprehensive ESG strategy
 
Partial
Lead and deliver tax efficient return of capital project
Achieved
Develop and implement a comprehensive HR strategy
 
None
Outperform budgeted costs and cash forecast
 
Partial
Notwithstanding the achievements in respect of personal objectives, no bonuses are payable because the threshold level of 
financial performance was not achieved.
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 083
Annual report on remuneration continued
Individual elements of remuneration for the year ended 31 July 2024 continued
Annual bonus continued
DBPs granted in respect of the FY21 annual bonus plan vested in full during the year. No long-term incentives vested during the 
year ended 31 July 2024. The threshold level of performance for the LTIP awards granted in November and December 2021 and 
which vested by reference to performance to the end of FY24 was not achieved, and the awards have lapsed.
LTIP awards granted in FY24
Awards to the Executive Directors made on 23 January 2024 were as follows:
Director
Type of award
Percentage 
of salary1 
%
Number of options
Face value at 
grant date1 
£’000
Face value at grant 
less exercise price 
£’000
Performance period 
Years
Brian Tenner
Share award
150%
2,255,220
450
450
3
Dr Nigel Pickett Share award
150%
1,604,897
320
320
3
Liam Gray
Share award
150%
1,148,112
229
229
3
LTIP granted 23 January 2024
Threshold target
Maximum target
Share price (average for three months to 31 July 2026)
£0.28
£0.36
Revenue2
Confidential
Confidential
Vesting ratio
25%
100%
1	 The face value of the awards is calculated based on a share price of £0.1997, being the share price used to determine the number of shares under award, 
as described in the announcement of 23 January 2024. 
2	 Given the group is entering a new stage in its development, the Directors consider that the revenue targets are commercially sensitive and hence are not 
being disclosed at this time. However, in order to maintain transparency, the targets will be disclosed at the same time as the actual outcome is 
assessed following the end of the performance period.
Payments made to former Directors and payments for loss of office during the year (audited information)
No payments for loss of office were made during the year. 
During the year, Brian Tenner notified the Company of his intention to step down as CEO. Details of his remuneration 
arrangements, in line with section 430(2B) of the Companies Act 2006 are available to view on the Company’s website.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
084
Annual report on remuneration continued
Statement of Directors’ shareholding and share interests (audited information)
Directors’ interests in share options to acquire ordinary shares of ten pence in the Company, including options held under the 
Deferred Bonus Plan, were as follows:
Share options
Date granted
Exercise
price
At
1 August 2023
Exercised
during
the year
Lapsed
Granted
during
the year 
At
31 July
2024
Dr Nigel Pickett
9 Nov 2021 3
Nil
399,929
(399,929)
—
—
—
9 Nov 2021 2
Nil
927,488
—
(927,488)
—
—
1 Dec 2021 2
Nil
463,744
—
(463,744)
—
—
27 Oct 2022 2
Nil
848,780
—
—
—
848,780
27 Oct 2022 3
Nil
501,421
—
—
—
501,421
23 Jan 2024 2
Nil
—
—
—
1,604,897
1,604,897
23 Jan 2024 3
Nil
—
—
—
424,667
424,667
Brian Tenner
9 Nov 2021 3 
Nil
452,555
(452,555)
—
—
—
9 Nov 2021 2
Nil
1,184,834
—
(1,184,834)
—
—
1 Dec 2021 2
Nil
592,417
—
(592,417)
—
—
27 Oct 2022 2,4
Nil
1,192,716
—
—
—
1,192,716
27 Oct 2022 3
Nil
649,072
—
—
—
649,072
23 Jan 2024 2,4
Nil
—
—
—
2,255,220
2,255,220
23 Jan 2024 3
Nil
—
—
—
577,736
577,736
Liam Gray
9 Nov 2021 3
Nil
35,157
(35,157)
—
—
—
9 Nov 2021 2
Nil
533,175
—
(533,175)
—
—
1 Dec 2021 2
Nil
266,588
—
(266,588)
—
—
27 Oct 2022 2
Nil
607,201
—
—
—
607,201
27 Oct 2022 3
Nil
253,161
—
—
—
253,161
23 Jan 2024 2
Nil
—
—
—
1,148,112
1,148,112
23 Jan 2024 3
Nil
—
—
—
294,894
294,894
2	 Unvested share options still subject to performance conditions.
3	 Deferred Bonus Plan awards.
4	 197,156 options issued on 27 October 2022 and 1,124,452 options issued on 23 January 2024 will lapse on Brian’s departure from the business as 
announced on 25 July 2024.
Director shareholdings
In order to align the interests of Executive Directors with those of shareholders and to demonstrate the Executive Directors’ 
ongoing personal financial commitment to the business, Executive Directors are expected to build up a shareholding equivalent 
to 200% of annual salary for all Executive Directors. Executive Directors are required to retain at least 50% of any post-tax shares 
that vest under any share incentive plans until this shareholding is reached.
Dr Nigel Pickett holds shares substantially in excess of the shareholding guideline (c.594% of salary using the three-month 
average closing share price to the end of July 2024). Brian Tenner has a holding of 79% of salary (or 111% assuming 50% of Deferred 
Bonus Plan awards are retained until the minimum shareholding is achieved). Liam Gray, having joined the Board in November 
2021, is building up a holding which currently stands at 16% of salary (47% assuming 50% of all Deferred Bonus Plan awards are 
retained until the minimum shareholding is achieved). Non-Executive Directors are not subject to the shareholding requirement.
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 085
Annual report on remuneration continued
Director shareholdings continued
Directors’ interests in the shares of the Company, including family and beneficial interests, at 31 July 2024 were:
Ordinary shares of 10p each
31 July
2024
Number
31 July
2024
%
31 July
2023
Number
31 July
2023
%
Current Directors
 
 
 
 
Dr Christopher Richards
941,751
0.46
841,996
0.26
Dr Nigel Pickett 
7,450,694
3.68
11,770,911
3.63
Brian Tenner
1,482,583
0.73
1,157,834
0.36
Liam Gray
142,001
0.07
48,931
0.02
Dr Alison Fielding
172,015
0.08
279,697
0.09
Chris Batterham
124,971
0.06
194,111
0.06
Dieter May
—
—
—
—
Dr Jalal Bagherli
—
—
—
—
Total for current Directors
10,314,015
5.09
14,293,480
4.42
None of the Directors in office as at 31 July 2024 had any interests at that date in shares of any other group company.
There were no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between 31 July 2024 and the publishing date of these accounts.
The market price for Nanoco shares as at 31 July 2024 was 14.9 pence per share; the highest and lowest prices during the year 
were 24.0 pence and 13.1 pence respectively.
Details of share options are set out in note 24 to the financial statements.
Unaudited information
Historical comparative TSR performance graph
The performance graph below shows the Company’s total shareholder return (“TSR”) against the FTSE SmallCap over the period 
from 1 August 2014 to 31 July 2024. In the opinion of the Board, the FTSE SmallCap is the most appropriate index against which 
the TSR of the Company should be measured because it represents a broad equity market index.
Total shareholder return
The graph shows the percentage return of an investment in the Company’s shares on 1 August 2014 compared with 
the percentage return of an investment notionally invested in the FTSE SmallCap index. 
01/08/2014
01/08/2015
01/08/2016
250%
200%
150%
100%
50%
0%
 Nanoco 
 FTSE SmallCap
01/08/2017
01/08/2018
01/08/2019
01/08/2020
01/08/2022
01/08/2024
01/08/2023
01/08/2021

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
086
Annual report on remuneration continued
Unaudited information continued
Ten-year view of CEO remuneration
CEO remuneration
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
Total remuneration 
(£’000)1
635
406
327
312
505
323
298 2
503
660
323
Annual bonus 
(% of max vesting)
56
40
—
—
52
—
43
75
95
—
LTIP (% of max vesting)
100
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1	 The previous CEO’s (Dr Michael Edelman) remuneration was paid in US Dollars but reported in Sterling in this table for the years 2015 to 2020. The 
exchange rate used for this purpose varied during the year.
2	 Brian Tenner was appointed CEO on 1 September 2020, having previously been CFO and COO. There was no change in Brian Tenner’s remuneration at 
that time to reflect the change in position with the proposed increase being made in two deferred tranches on 1 August 2021 and 1 August 2022. Having 
regard to the proportion of 2021 for which Brian Tenner was CEO, his remuneration as a Director for the full year is included for that year, and the 
remuneration of Dr Michael Edelman for the part of the year when he was CEO is not included.
Percentage change in the remuneration of the Board
The table below shows the percentage change in each Director’s salary, benefits and annual bonus between the current and 
previous financial year, and the average percentage change in the same remuneration over the same period in respect of the 
employees of the Company on a full-time equivalent basis. The average employee change has been calculated by reference 
to the mean of employee pay, excluding new starters in the year. 
Average
employee
Brian
Tenner 
Dr Nigel
Pickett
Liam 
Gray 2
Dr Christopher
Richards
Dr Alison
Fielding
Chris
Batterham
Salary/fees1
FY24
5%
3%
3%
3%
0%
9%
9%
FY23
9%
17%
6%
70%
0%
0%
0%
FY22
4%
31%
16%
N/A
30%
30%
30%
FY21
7%
(8%)
(9%)
N/A
(13%)
(13%)
(13%)
FY20
1%
1%
(2%)
N/A
(2%)
(1%)
(1%)
Taxable benefits3
FY24
100%
100%
100%
100%
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY23
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY22
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY21
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY20
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Annual bonus
FY24
(29%)
(100%)
(100%)
(100%)
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY23
27% 
48%
38%
108%
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY22
0%
100%
100%
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY21
100%
0%
0%
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
FY20
0%
(100%)
(100%)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1	 The Non-Executive Directors’ fees were reduced by 35% between 1 April 2020 and 31 March 2021, and deferred by 35% with effect from 1 April 2021. 
This deferral was repaid in July 2022.
2	 The increases in salary and bonus for Liam Gray for FY23 are calculated by reference to the increase between the values included in the single total 
figure of remuneration for FY22 and FY23. Therefore, those increases reflect that for FY22 the relevant values related to a part-year only.
3	 An employee healthcare plan was implemented in FY24 and is available to all staff including Executive Directors.
The data above is distorted by a number of factors including joining dates, changes in roles and salary and by pay cuts taken 
by Directors as part of Company actions to manage the Covid-19 pandemic. From April 2020, some but not all staff had 20% pay 
cuts for six months. Executive Directors and other members of the leadership team had 20% pay cuts for a full twelve months. 
The increases in Executive pay in FY22 are therefore primarily or wholly the result of the end of the temporary Covid-19 pandemic 
pay cut.
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 087
Annual report on remuneration continued
Unaudited information continued
Relative importance of spend on pay
The following table sets out the percentage change in returns to shareholders and the overall expenditure on pay 
(across the whole group).
Year ended
31 July 2024
£’000
Year ended
31 July 2023
£’000
% change
Return to shareholders
32,000
—
100%
Overall expenditure on pay
3,396
3,225
5%
Average headcount
50
42
19%
Implementation of policy for the year commencing 1 August 2024
Base salary
Base salaries are reviewed annually with effect from 1 August. For the year commencing 1 August 2024, the workforce had an 
increase of 3%. Each of the Executive Directors in office as at 1 August 2024 had an increase of 2.5%.
2024
2023
% change
Chief Executive Officer - Dmitry Shashkov (appointed 22 October 2024)
£310,000
—
N/A
Former Chief Executive Officer – Brian Tenner
£307,751
£300,245
2.5%
Chief Technical Officer – Dr Nigel Pickett
£219,007
£213,665
2.5%
Chief Financial Officer – Liam Gray
£156,673
£152,852
2.5%
Changes to Non-Executive Directors’ fees
Non-Executive Directors’ base fees were increased during the year to £50,000 (2023: £41,000).
2024
2023
Chairman fee
£100,000 £100,000
NED base fee
£50,000
£41,000
Chair of Committee fee
£5,000
£5,000
Pension
The Company operates a salary sacrifice pension arrangement. For the year commencing 1 August 2024, employer pension 
contributions above the amount of any salary sacrifice (and the associated employer National Insurance contribution savings) 
have remained at 7.5% of salary for the whole workforce, including the Executive Directors.
Annual bonus
For FY25, the maximum annual bonus potential will remain at 125% of base salary for Executive Directors. Brian Tenner will not be 
eligible for a bonus in FY25. Up to the full amount of any such bonus earned can be paid as deferred shares under the DBP 
vesting after two years with any balance paid in cash. This reflects our stakeholder philosophy, provides a longer-term retention 
mechanism and provides alignment with shareholders. 
Consistent with the FY23 annual bonus, performance will be assessed on the basis of a balanced scorecard approach in respect 
of performance measures. The balance between corporate financial objectives (80%) and personal objectives (20%) will be 
unchanged. The corporate financial measures for FY24 will include annual revenue and adjusted EBITDA weighted 60%:20% 
respectively. Any personal bonus is only payable if at least one of the financial targets is achieved. The Committee will disclose 
the metrics and performance against these on a retrospective basis to the extent that these are not commercially sensitive.
Clawback will apply to any cash bonus paid and malus provisions to any unvested deferred bonus award.
LTIP
The Committee intends to make awards of up to 150% of salary to the CTO and CFO after the announcement of the group’s 
full-year results for the year ended 31 July 2024 (subject to market conditions at the time of award). No award will be made to the 
former CEO. Dmitry Shashkov will be granted an exceptional award of up to 250% of salary. The Committee will agree targets if 
and when any LTIP awards are made during FY25. All awards will continue to be in line with the approved remuneration policy. 
This will include a two-year post-vesting holding period.

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
088
Annual report on remuneration continued
Unaudited information continued
Statement of voting
The group is committed to ongoing dialogue with its shareholders and takes an active interest in trying to ensure that as many 
shareholders as possible submit their votes in time for any shareholder meetings. The following table sets out the actual voting 
in respect of the resolutions to approve the Directors’ remuneration policy at the Company’s Annual General Meeting held on 
30 November 2021 and to approve the Directors’ remuneration report at the Company’s Annual General Meeting held on 
7 December 2023.
Resolution
Votes 
for
% for
Votes 
against
% against
Votes 
withheld
To approve the Directors’ remuneration policy
138,307,164
99.0%
1,451,931
1.0%
178,488
Resolution
Votes 
for
% for
Votes 
against
% against
Votes 
withheld
To approve the Directors’ remuneration report
94,761,337
96.3%
3,663,316
3.7%
288,483
Directors’ contracts
It is the group’s policy that Executive Directors should have contracts with an indefinite term, providing for six months’ notice.
Date of contract
Date of appointment
 Notice from the Company
 Notice from Director
Brian Tenner
20 August 2018
20 August 2018
6 months
 6 months
Dr Nigel Pickett
27 June 2006
27 June 2006
6 months
 6 months
Liam Gray
8 November 2021
8 November 2021
6 months
 6 months
All Directors will offer themselves for re-election at each AGM in accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code. Service 
contracts are available for inspection at the registered office of the Company.
 Date of letter of appointment
 Date of appointment
Unexpired term of contract on 31 July 2024
Dr Christopher Richards (Chairman)
 28 October 2015
 11 November 2015 
 ~4 months
Dr Alison Fielding
20 March 2017
 20 April 2017
~9 months
Chris Batterham
12 March 2019
1 April 2019
~8 months
Dieter May
21 December 2023
1 February 2024
1 February 2027
Dr Jalal Bagherli
21 December 2023
5 April 2024
5 April 2027
Non-Executive Directors
All Non-Executive Directors are appointed for an initial three-year term and then on a rolling annual term. 
Non‑Executive Directors’ appointments may be terminated on not less than three months’ notice from either party.
On behalf of the Board
Dr Alison Fielding
Remuneration Committee Chair
21 November 2024
Directors’ remuneration report continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 089
Directors’ report
The Directors present their report and 
the audited financial statements for the 
group and Parent Company for the year 
ended 31 July 2024.
Financial instruments
Details of the group’s financial risk 
management objectives and policies 
are disclosed in notes 3 and 27 to the 
financial statements.
Research and development
The principal activity of the group is 
research and development with the goal 
to transition to a commercial production 
company, a review of which is included in 
the Chairman’s statement and 
Operational review on pages 5 to 7 and 9 
to 14 respectively.
Total research and development 
spend was £1.6 million (2023: £1.8 million). 
No development expenditure was 
capitalised in the year (2023: £nil) for 
the reasons provided in note 3(h) to 
the accounts.
Dividends
The Directors do not recommend 
payment of an ordinary dividend 
(2023: £nil).
Disclosures reported elsewhere in the Annual Report
The strategic review of the business of the Company and its subsidiaries is given on 
pages 5 to 49. Certain information required for disclosure in this report is provided in 
other appropriate sections of this Annual Report. These are set out in the table below:
Disclosure requirement
Pages
Financial results and dividends
30-32
Board and Committee meetings and Directors’ attendance
53
Directors’ biographical details and date of appointment
50-51
Corporate governance
52-54
Approach to risk management and principal risks
33-35
Research and development activities
29
Directors’ remuneration
73-88
Greenhouse gas emissions, employee engagement, disability, gender and human rights
38-47
Statement on disclosure to the external auditors
92
Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
92
Future developments
7 and 14
Going concern statement
37
Disclosures on financial instruments (note 27 to the consolidated financial statements)
126-129
The disclosures are, accordingly, incorporated into this report by reference.
Requirements of the Listing Rules
The following table provides references to where the information required 
by the Listing Rule 6.6.1R is disclosed:
Listing Rule requirement
Location
Information required in relation to the publication 
of unaudited financial information
Not applicable
Details of any long-term incentive schemes
Remuneration report
Directors who held office during the year and their 
interests in shares and share options in the group
Remuneration report
Arrangements where a Director has waived historical 
or future emoluments from the Company
Remuneration report on 
Chairman’s fees
Details of business relationships with suppliers, 
customers and others
Strategic report
Details of any non-pre-emptive issues of equity 
for cash
Not applicable
Details of any non-pre-emptive issues of equity 
for cash by any unlisted major subsidiary
No such share allotments
Details of UK Parent participation in a placing 
by a listed subsidiary
No such share participations
Details of any contract of significance in which 
a Director is or was materially interested
No such contracts
Details of rules regarding the appointment 
and replacement of Directors
Remuneration report
Contracts of significance between the Company 
(or a subsidiary) and a controlling shareholder
No such contracts
Details of a waiver of dividends by a shareholder
No such waivers
Board statement in respect of relationship 
agreement with the controlling shareholder
No such agreements

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
090
Acquisition of the Company’s 
own shares
In April 2024 the company completed 
a tender offer at 24 pence, to return 
£30.0 million to shareholders. Of the 125 
million shares acquired by the company 
via the tender offer, 90% were 
subsequently cancelled with the 
remainder being held by the Employee 
Benefit Trust
Immediately following the tender offer, 
the company commenced a broker 
managed on-market buy-back to return 
a further £3.0 million to shareholders. As 
at 31 July 2024 £2.0 million had been 
returned via this mechanism which led 
to the purchase and subsequent 
cancellation of a further 10.9 million 
shares. The remainder of the buy-back 
was completed post year end. 
Share capital and funding
As at 31 July 2024, share capital comprised 
202.6 million ordinary shares of 10 pence 
each (2023: 324.4 million). There is only 
one class of share and all shares are fully 
paid. Full details of the group’s and 
Company’s share capital movements 
during the year are given in note 22 to 
the financial statements.
Pursuant to the general provisions of 
the Articles of Association and prevailing 
legislation, there are no specific restrictions 
on the size of a holding. The Directors are 
not aware of any restrictions on the transfer 
of ordinary shares in the Company other 
than certain restrictions which may from 
time to time be imposed by law and 
regulations, e.g. insider trading laws, 
and pursuant to the Listing Rules of the 
Financial Conduct Authority whereby 
certain employees of the Company 
require prior approval from the Company 
to deal in the Company’s securities.
The Company is not aware of any 
agreements between shareholders that 
may result in restrictions on voting rights 
and the transfer of securities.
Details of shares under option are provided 
in note 24 to the financial statements.
Foreign branches
The group has just one foreign location, 
a subsidiary in the US, which provides 
management services to the 
UK business.
Directors’ report continued
Directors and their interests
The Directors who held office throughout the year and their interests are shown in 
the Remuneration report. As at 31 July 2024, none of the Directors had any interests 
in shares of any other group company.
No Director had an interest in any contract that was significant in relation to the 
group’s business at any time during the year.
Directors are formally subject to re-election at intervals of not more than three years 
but voluntarily submit themselves for re-election each year.
In the case of each Director in office at the date the Directors’ report is approved:
	
| so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the 
group and Company’s auditors are unaware; and
	
| they have taken all the steps that they ought to have taken as a Director in order 
to make themselves aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that 
the group and Company’s auditors are aware of that information.
Directors’ indemnity insurance
The group has maintained insurance in the form of a qualifying third party indemnity 
provision throughout the year for its Directors and Officers against the consequences 
of actions brought against them in relation to their duties for the group. This provision 
was in force through the financial year and remains in force as at the date of 
approval of the financial statements.
Substantial shareholders
The Company is aware that the following had an interest in 3% or more of the issued 
ordinary share capital of the Company at 31 July 2024:
Substantial shareholders
Number
of ordinary
shares at
31 July 2024
% of
issued
share
capital
Hargreaves Lansdown Asset Management
47,996,367
23.69
Interactive Investor
23,535,981
11.62
Employee Benefit Trust (“EBT”)
13,762,222
6.79
Lombard Odier Investment Managers
11,679,891
5.77
Barclays Smart Investor
10,438,496
5.15
HSDL, stockbrokers
9,008,668
4.45
Dr Nigel Pickett
7,450,694
3.68
AJ Bell, stockbrokers
7,197,466
3.55
Cable Car Capital
6,488,626
3.20
Post year end, on 24th September 2024, Nanoco were notified that Milkwood Capital 
Limited had increased their shareholding to 16,000,000 ordinary shares (8.2% of 
issued share capital). There were no other notifiable changes.
Donations
No political donations were made in the year (2023: £nil). Charitable donations of 
£100 were made in the year (2023: £nil).
Compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code 
The statements of compliance with the principles of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code published by the FRC in 2018 are set out on page 57.

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 091
Additional information for 
shareholders
With regard to the appointment and 
replacement of Directors, the Company 
is governed by its Articles of Association, 
the UK Corporate Governance Code 
2018, the Companies Act 2006 and 
related legislation.
The Articles themselves may be 
amended by special resolution of the 
shareholders. The Articles provide that 
Directors may be appointed by an 
ordinary resolution of the Company’s 
members or by a resolution of the 
Directors, provided that, in the latter 
instance, a Director appointed in this 
way retires and stands for election at 
the first Annual General Meeting 
following his appointment.
The Articles also provide that at every 
Annual General Meeting at least one‑third 
of the Directors retire by rotation and set 
out the circumstances in which and how 
they may be re-elected. All Directors 
retire annually and are proposed for 
re-election at the AGM. The Company’s 
members may remove a Director by 
passing an ordinary resolution of which 
special notice has been given. The office 
of a Director shall be vacated in any of 
the following events: (a) if (but in the case 
of a Director holding any executive office 
subject to the terms of any contract of 
service between him and the Company) 
notification in writing, signed by the 
Director or otherwise authenticated in 
such manner as the other Directors may 
accept, is received by the Company 
from the Director that he is resigning or 
retiring from office as a Director, and 
such resignation or retirement has taken 
effect in accordance with its terms, or if 
he shall in writing offer to resign or retire 
and the Directors shall resolve to accept 
such offer; (b) if he becomes bankrupt or 
has a receiving order made against him 
or makes any arrangement or composition 
with his creditors generally in satisfaction 
of his debts or shall apply to the court for 
an interim order under section 253 of the 
Insolvency Act 1986; (c) if a registered 
medical practitioner who is treating the 
Director gives a written opinion to the 
Company stating that he has become 
physically or mentally incapable of acting 
as a Director and may remain so for more 
than three months; (d) if he is absent from 
meetings of the Directors for six successive 
months without leave, and his alternate 
Director (if any) shall not during such 
period have attended in his stead, and 
the Directors resolve that his office be 
vacated; (e) if he shall be removed from 
office by notice in writing served upon 
him signed by all his co-Directors, but 
so that if he holds an appointment to 
an executive office which automatically 
determines, as a result, such removal 
shall be deemed an act of the Company 
and shall have effect without prejudice 
to any claim for damages for breach of 
any contract of service between him and 
the Company; or (f) if he ceases to be a 
Director by virtue of any provision of the 
Companies Act or becomes prohibited 
by law from being a Director.
The powers of the Directors are determined 
by applicable legislation and the Company’s 
Articles of Association. As provided in 
those Articles, the Directors may exercise 
all the Company’s powers provided that 
the Articles or applicable legislation do 
not stipulate that any such powers must 
be exercised by the Company’s members. 
The Directors have been authorised to 
issue and allot ordinary shares, pursuant 
to the Articles, and have authority to 
make market purchases of shares. These 
powers are referred to shareholders at 
each Annual General Meeting for renewal. 
Any shares purchased may be cancelled 
or held as treasury shares.
Employment policies
The group is committed to ensuring the 
health and safety of its employees in the 
workplace. This includes the provision 
of regular medical checks.
The group supports the employment 
of disabled people where possible 
through recruitment, by retention of those 
who become disabled and generally 
through training, career development 
and promotion. 
The group is committed to keeping 
employees as fully informed as possible 
with regard to the group’s performance 
and prospects and seeks their views, 
wherever possible, on matters which 
affect them as employees.
Independent auditors
Forvis Mazars LLP were appointed in 2022 
following an external tender process. 
Forvis Mazars LLP have indicated their 
willingness to continue in office.
Ordinary resolutions to re-appoint 
Mazars LLP as auditors and to authorise 
the Directors to agree their audit fee will 
be proposed at the forthcoming Annual 
General Meeting.
Annual General Meeting notice
The Annual General Meeting of the 
Company will be held on 21 January 
2025, at the Company’s headquarters at 
The Conference Centre, The Heath 
Business and Technical Park, Runcorn 
WA7 4QX. Shareholders will have the 
option to attend in person or through 
teleconference, with the teleconference 
details to be provided. The notice 
convening the AGM, together with an 
explanation of the resolutions to be 
proposed at the meeting, will be sent 
to shareholders separately from 
this document.
Post-balance sheet events
Post year end, the Group completed the 
£3 million share buyback.
On 22 October 2024, the Group 
appointed Dmitry Shashkov as CEO, 
replacing Brian Tenner.
The Group also received a requisition for 
a general meeting from Milkwood Capital 
Limited, requesting that two of their 
representatives are appointed to the 
Board. Nanoco does not believe this is in 
the best interests of all shareholders.
On behalf of the Board
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024

Corporate governance
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
092
Statement of Directors’ responsibilities in respect of the financial statements
The Directors are responsible for 
preparing the Annual Report and 
Accounts 2024 and the financial 
statements in accordance with 
applicable law and regulation.
Company law requires the Directors 
to prepare financial statements for 
each financial year. Under that law 
the Directors have prepared the group 
and the Company financial statements 
in accordance with International 
Accounting Standards in conformity 
with the requirements of the Companies 
Act 2006. Additionally, the Financial 
Conduct Authority’s Disclosure Guidance 
and Transparency Rules require the 
Directors to prepare the group financial 
statements in accordance with UK 
adopted International Financial 
Reporting Standards.
The Company has also prepared 
financial statements in accordance 
with UK adopted International Financial 
Reporting Standards.
Under company law, Directors must not 
approve the financial statements unless 
they are satisfied that they give a true 
and fair view of the state of affairs of 
the group and Company and of the 
profit or loss of the group for that period. 
In preparing the financial statements, 
the Directors are required to:
	
| select suitable accounting policies 
and then apply them consistently;
	
| state whether applicable International 
Accounting Standards in conformity 
with the requirements of the Companies 
Act 2006 and UK adopted International 
Financial Reporting Standards have 
been followed, subject to any material 
departures disclosed and explained in 
the financial statements;
	
| make judgements and accounting 
estimates that are reasonable and 
prudent; and
	
| prepare the financial statements on 
the going concern basis unless it is 
inappropriate to presume that the 
group and Company will continue 
in business.
The Directors are responsible for 
safeguarding the assets of the group 
and Company and hence for taking 
reasonable steps for the prevention and 
detection of fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors are also responsible for 
keeping adequate accounting records 
that are sufficient to show and explain the 
group’s and Company’s transactions and 
disclose with reasonable accuracy at any 
time the financial position of the group 
and Company and enable them to ensure 
that the financial statements and the 
Directors’ remuneration report comply 
with the Companies Act 2006.
Directors’ confirmations
The Directors consider that the Annual 
Report and Accounts 2024, taken as a 
whole, is fair, balanced and 
understandable and provides the 
information necessary for shareholders 
to assess the group’s and Company’s 
position and performance, business 
model and strategy.
Each of the Directors, whose names 
and functions are listed in the Corporate 
governance report, confirm that, to the 
best of their knowledge:
	
| the group and Company financial 
statements, which have been 
prepared in accordance with 
International Accounting Standards 
in conformity with the requirements 
of the Companies Act 2006 and 
UK adopted International Financial 
Reporting Standards, give a true 
and fair view of the assets, liabilities 
and financial position of the group 
and Company, and of the profit of 
the group; and
	
| the Directors’ report includes a fair 
review of the development and 
performance of the business and the 
position of the group and Company, 
together with a description of the 
principal risks and uncertainties that 
they face.
By order of the Board
Dr Christopher Richards
Chairman
21 November 2024

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 093
Financial statements
Opinion
We have audited the financial 
statements of Nanoco Group Plc (the 
‘Parent Company’) and its subsidiaries 
(the ‘group’) for the year ended 31 July 2024 
which comprise of the Consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income, 
Consolidated statement of changes in 
equity, Company statement of changes 
in equity, Group and Company statements 
of financial position, Group and Company 
cash flow statements, and notes to the 
financial statements, including material 
accounting policy information. 
The financial reporting framework that 
has been applied in their preparation 
is applicable law and UK-adopted 
international accounting standards and, 
as regards the parent company financial 
statements, as applied in accordance 
with the provisions of the Companies 
Act 2006. 
In our opinion, the financial statements:
	
| give a true and fair view of the 
state of the group’s and of the parent 
company’s affairs as at 31 July 2024 
and of the group’s loss for the year 
then ended;
	
| have been properly prepared 
in accordance with UK-adopted 
international accounting standards 
and, as regards the parent company 
financial statements, as applied in 
accordance with the provisions of 
the Companies Act 2006; and
	
| have been prepared in accordance 
with the requirements of the 
Companies Act 2006.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance 
with International Standards on Auditing 
(UK) (ISAs (UK)) and applicable law. Our 
responsibilities under those standards 
are further described in the “Auditor’s 
responsibilities for the audit of the 
financial statements” section of our 
report. We are independent of the group 
and the parent company in accordance 
with the ethical requirements that are 
relevant to our audit of the financial 
statements in the UK, including the FRC’s 
Ethical Standard as applied to listed 
entities and public interest entities and 
we have fulfilled our other ethical 
responsibilities in accordance with these 
requirements. We believe that the audit 
evidence we have obtained is sufficient 
and appropriate to provide a basis for 
our opinion.
Conclusions relating to going 
concern 
In auditing the financial statements, 
we have concluded that the directors’ 
use of the going concern basis of 
accounting in the preparation of the 
financial statements is appropriate. 
Our audit procedures to evaluate 
the directors’ assessment of the group’s 
and the parent company’s ability to 
continue to adopt the going concern 
basis of accounting included but were 
not limited to:
	
| Undertaking an initial assessment 
at the planning stage of the audit to 
identify events or conditions that may 
cast significant doubt on the group’s 
and the parent company’s ability to 
continue as a going concern;
	
| Obtaining an understanding of 
the relevant controls relating to the 
directors’ going concern assessment; 
	
| Making enquiries of the directors to 
understand the period of assessment 
considered by them, the assumptions 
they considered and the implication 
of those when assessing the group’s 
and the parent company’s future 
financial performance
	
| Challenging the appropriateness of 
the directors’ key assumptions in their 
cash flow forecasts, as described in 
note 2c, by reviewing supporting and 
contradictory evidence in relation to 
these key assumptions and assessing 
the directors’ consideration of severe 
but plausible scenarios. This included 
assessing the viability of mitigating 
actions within the directors’ control; 
	
| Testing the accuracy and functionality 
of the model used to prepare the 
directors’ forecasts; 
	
| Assessing the historical accuracy of 
forecasts prepared by the directors; 
	
| Considering the consistency of the 
directors’ forecasts with other areas 
of the financial statements and 
our audit; 
	
| Considering events that have 
occurred post the balance sheet date 
and its impact on the key assumptions 
and forecasts used in assessing going 
concern; and
	
| Evaluating the appropriateness of the 
directors’ disclosures in the financial 
statements on going concern 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Nanoco Group plc
Based on the work we have performed, 
we have not identified any material 
uncertainties relating to events or 
conditions that, individually or 
collectively, may cast significant doubt 
on the group’s and the parent company’s 
ability to continue as a going concern for 
a period of at least twelve months from 
when the financial statements are 
authorised for issue.
Our responsibilities and the 
responsibilities of the directors with 
respect to going concern are described 
in the relevant sections of this report.
In relation to Nanoco Group Plc’s 
reporting on how it has applied the UK 
Corporate Governance Code, we have 
nothing material to add or draw 
attention to in relation to the directors’ 
statement in the financial statements 
about whether the director’s considered 
it appropriate to adopt the going 
concern basis of accounting.
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters 
that, in our professional judgement, 
were of most significance in our audit 
of the financial statements of the current 
period and include the most significant 
assessed risks of material misstatement 
(whether or not due to fraud) we 
identified, including those which had 
the greatest effect on: the overall audit 
strategy; the allocation of resources in 
the audit; and directing the efforts of the 
engagement team. These matters were 
addressed in the context of our audit of 
the financial statements as a whole, and 
in forming our opinion thereon, and we 
do not provide a separate opinion on 
these matters.
We summarise below the key audit 
matters in forming our opinion above, 
together with an overview of the principal 
audit procedures performed to address 
each matter and our key observations 
arising from those procedures. 
These matters, together with our findings, 
were communicated to those charged 
with governance through our Audit 
Completion Report and follow up letter 
to the Audit Committee.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
094
Key audit matters continued
Key Audit Matter
How our scope addressed this matter
Impairment of Investment in subsidiaries 
(parent company)
Refer to page 104 (key sources of estimation 
uncertainty) and page 108 (accounting policy) 
and pages 108 and 119 of the financial 
disclosures.
The accounting for Investment in subsidiaries is 
a Key Audit Matter as the determination of the 
recoverable value for the impairment 
assessment of the investment in subsidiaries 
involves significant management judgement 
and estimation. 
The Investments in subsidiaries as at 31 July 
2024 is £46.5m (2023: £41.6m) which is significant 
to the financial statement of the parent 
company. This asset represents 66% of the 
parent company’s total assets at 31 July 2024 
(2023: 44%). 
The valuation of the Investments in subsidiaries 
is based on the value-in-use calculation which 
represents the recoverable amount being 
higher than the fair value less cost to sell. 
Management’s assessment was performed with 
the assistance of a third-party valuation’s 
expert. Based on the value-in-use calculated of 
£46.5m, a reversal of previously recognised 
impairment charge of £3.8m was recognised. 
The value-in-use calculation is subjective due 
to the inherent uncertainty involved in 
estimating and discounting future cashflows. 
The key assumptions used in the calculation 
included the forecasted cashflows, the strategic 
operating period and the discount rate of 18.5% 
(2023: 19.7%). Estimation uncertainty relating to 
the valuation of the investment in subsidiaries 
has increased due to historical impairment 
recognised and the loss in the year which 
constitutes an indicator of impairment. 
The financial statements (note 2), disclose the 
relevant information regarding the method 
adopted by management in calculating the 
value-in-use and the key assumptions relevant 
to this calculation. 
Our audit procedures included, but were not limited to:
	
| Obtaining an understanding of the parent company’s processes and 
controls to address the risk associated with impairment of investment in 
subsidiaries and assessing the design and implementation of the 
relevant controls;
	
| Performing the following procedures over management value‑in‑use calculation:
	
| Assessing the Company’s process regarding impairment assessment by 
engaging our internal valuation experts to assist in assessing and 
challenging the appropriateness of the discounted cashflow models 
including the independent assessment of the underlying assumptions 
relating to the:
- discount rate
- strategic operating period
- other entity specific factors incorporated into the valuations;
	
| Assessing the appropriateness of the discounted cashflow models based 
on the applicable accounting standards: IAS 36 Impairment of assets;
	
| Assessing the competency and objectivity of management’s expert used 
in the calculation of the recoverable amount by performing procedures 
such as the review of the engagement terms stipulated between the 
engagement letter with the expert;
	
| Confirming the mathematical accuracy of the impairment models and 
agreeing the relevant data with the latest budgets, actual past results 
and other supporting documents;
	
| Assessing the appropriateness of sensitivity analysis and evaluated 
whether any reasonably foreseeable change in assumptions could lead 
to impairment or material change in the valuation of the investments;
	
| Ensuring that the carrying amount of the Investment in the subsidiaries 
has been accurately compared to its value-in-use calculation to 
determine the necessary impairment reversal;
	
| Performing a stand back review by considering relevant internal and external 
factors including disconfirming information in our assessment of the 
appropriateness of the methodology used in management’s calculation;
	
| Evaluating the adequacy of the disclosures made in the financial statements 
and ensuring they comply with the disclosure requirements of IAS 36 
Impairment of Assets. 
Our observations
Based on our audit procedures, we are satisfied that the carrying value of the 
investment in subsidiaries and the disclosures within the financial statement 
are appropriate.
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Nanoco Group plc continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 095
Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit
The scope of our audit was influenced by our application of materiality. We set certain quantitative thresholds for materiality. 
These, together with qualitative considerations, helped us to determine the scope of our audit and the nature, timing and extent 
of our audit procedures on the individual financial statement line items and disclosures and in evaluating the effect of misstatements, 
both individually and on the financial statements as a whole. Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality 
for the financial statements as a whole as follows:
Group materiality
Parent company materiality
Overall materiality
£306,000
£300,000
How we determined it
We determined overall materiality for the 
group using a benchmark of approximately 
1% total assets.
This was determined at 1% of total assets capped at 
an amount lower than the group materiality. 
Rationale for 
benchmark applied
We have considered total assets to be the key 
metric for determining materiality given the group’s 
focus on continued growth through its intangible 
asset portfolio. Therefore, this is considered most 
relevant measure of the underlying position of both 
the group. 
Nanoco Group Plc is a holding entity and therefore not 
profit or revenue focused. Total assets is deemed to be 
the most appropriate benchmark for the users of the 
financial statements. 
Performance 
materiality
Performance materiality is set to reduce to an 
appropriately low level the probability that the 
aggregate of uncorrected and undetected 
misstatements in the financial statements 
exceeds materiality for the financial statements 
as a whole.
We set performance materiality at £214,000, 
which represents 70% of overall materiality.
Performance materiality is set to reduce to an 
appropriately low level the probability that the 
aggregate of uncorrected and undetected 
misstatements in the financial statements exceeds 
materiality for the financial statements as a whole.
Based on our risk assessments, together with our 
assessment of the company’s overall control 
environment, we set performance materiality at 
£210,000, which represents 70% of overall materiality.
Reporting threshold
We agreed with the directors that we would report 
to them misstatements identified during our audit 
above £9,000 as well as misstatements below that 
amount that, in our view, warranted reporting for 
qualitative reasons.
We agreed with the directors that we would report 
to them misstatements identified during our audit 
above £9,000 as well as misstatements below that 
amount that, in our view, warranted reporting for 
qualitative reasons.
As part of designing our audit, we assessed the risk of material misstatement in the financial statements, whether due to fraud or 
error, and then designed and performed audit procedures responsive to those risks. In particular, we looked at where the 
directors made subjective judgements, such as assumptions on significant accounting estimates.
We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed sufficient work to be able to give an opinion on the financial 
statements as a whole. We used the outputs of our risk assessment, our understanding of the group and the parent company, 
their environment, controls, and critical business processes, to consider qualitative factors to ensure that we obtained sufficient 
coverage across all financial statement line items.
Our group audit scope included an audit of the group and the parent company financial statements. Based on our risk 
assessment, Nanoco Group Plc, Nanoco Technologies Limited and Nanoco 2D materials Limited were subject to full scope audit 
performed by the group audit team. Nanoco Employee Trust was subject to audit procedures over account balances and/or 
disclosures as the component was not deemed individually financially significant enough to require a full scope audit for group 
reporting purposes. The remaining two components, Nanoco Tech Limited and Nanoco Life Services limited were subject to 
analytical procedures and review of financial information at group level. The audit of the component financial information was 
performed by the same group engagement team under the group engagement partner’s direct supervision.
At the parent company level, the group audit team also tested the consolidation process and carried out analytical procedures 
to confirm our conclusion that there were no significant risks of material misstatement of the aggregated financial information.
Other information
The other information comprises the information included in the annual report other than the financial statements and our 
auditor’s report thereon. The directors are responsible for the other information. Our opinion on the financial statements does not 
cover the other information and, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in our report, we do not express any form of 
assurance conclusion thereon.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
096
Other information continued
Our responsibility is to read the other 
information and, in doing so, consider 
whether the other information is 
materially inconsistent with the financial 
statements or our knowledge obtained in 
the course of audit or otherwise appears 
to be materially misstated. If we identify 
such material inconsistencies or 
apparent material misstatements, we are 
required to determine whether this gives 
rise to a material misstatement in the 
financial statements themselves. If, 
based on the work we have performed, 
we conclude that there is a material 
misstatement of this other information, 
we are required to report that fact.
We have nothing to report in this regard.
Opinions on other matters 
prescribed by the Companies Act 
2006
In our opinion, the part of the directors’ 
remuneration report to be audited has 
been properly prepared in accordance 
with the Companies Act 2006.
In our opinion, based on the work 
undertaken in the course of the audit:
	
| the information given in the strategic 
report and the directors’ report for the 
financial year for which the financial 
statements are prepared is consistent 
with the financial statements and 
those reports have been prepared 
in accordance with applicable 
legal requirements;
	
| the information about internal control 
and risk management systems in 
relation to financial reporting 
processes and about share capital 
structures, given in compliance with 
rules 7.2.5 and 7.2.6 in the Disclosure 
Guidance and Transparency Rules 
sourcebook made by the Financial 
Conduct Authority (the FCA Rules), 
is consistent with the financial 
statements and has been prepared 
in accordance with applicable legal 
requirements; and
	
| information about the parent 
company’s corporate governance 
code and practices and about its 
administrative, management and 
supervisory bodies and their 
committees complies with rules 7.2.2, 
7.2.3 and 7.2.7 of the FCA Rules.
Matters on which we are required 
to report by exception
In light of the knowledge and 
understanding of the group and the 
parent company and their environment 
obtained in the course of the audit, we 
have not identified material 
misstatements in the:
	
| strategic report or the directors’ 
report; or 
	
| information about internal control and 
risk management systems in relation 
to financial reporting processes and 
about share capital structures, given 
in compliance with rules 7.2.5 and 7.2.6 
of the FCA Rules.
We have nothing to report in respect of 
the following matters in relation to which 
the Companies Act 2006 requires us to 
report to you if, in our opinion:
	
| adequate accounting records have 
not been kept by the parent company, 
or returns adequate for our audit have 
not been received from branches not 
visited by us; or
	
| the parent company financial 
statements and the part of the 
directors’ remuneration report to be 
audited are not in agreement with the 
accounting records and returns; or
	
| certain disclosures of directors’ 
remuneration specified by law are not 
made; or
	
| we have not received all the 
information and explanations we 
require for our audit; or
	
| a corporate governance statement 
has not been prepared by the parent 
company.
Corporate governance statement
The Listing Rules require us to review the 
directors’ statement in relation to going 
concern, longer-term viability and that 
part of the Corporate Governance 
Statement relating to Nanoco Group 
Plc’s compliance with the provisions 
of the UK Corporate Governance 
Statement specified for our review.
Based on the work undertaken as part 
of our audit, we have concluded that 
each of the following elements of the 
Corporate Governance Statement is 
materially consistent with the financial 
statements or our knowledge obtained 
during the audit:
	
| Directors’ statement with regards 
the appropriateness of adopting the 
going concern basis of accounting 
and any material uncertainties 
identified, set out on page 37;
	
| Directors’ explanation as to its 
assessment of the entity’s prospects, 
the period this assessment covers and 
why they period is appropriate, set out 
on page 37;
	
| Directors’ statement on fair, balanced 
and understandable, set out on pages 5 
to 37;
	
| Board’s confirmation that it has 
carried out a robust assessment of the 
e-merging and principal risks, set out 
on page 33;
	
| The section of the annual report that 
describes the review of effectiveness 
of risk management and internal 
control systems, set out on pages 33 to 
35; and;
	
| The section describing the work of the 
audit committee, set out on page 65.
Responsibilities of Directors
As explained more fully in the directors’ 
responsibilities statement set out on 
page 92, the directors are responsible 
for the preparation of the financial 
statements and for being satisfied that 
they give a true and fair view, and for 
such internal control as the directors 
determine is necessary to enable the 
preparation of financial statements that 
are free from material misstatement, 
whether due to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial statements, 
the directors are responsible for assessing 
the group’s and the parent company’s 
ability to continue as a going concern, 
disclosing, as applicable, matters related 
to going concern and using the going 
concern basis of accounting unless the 
directors either intend to liquidate the 
group or the parent company or to 
cease operations, or have no realistic 
alternative but to do so.
Auditor’s responsibilities for the 
audit of the financial statements 
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable 
assurance about whether the financial 
statements as a whole are free from 
material misstatement, whether due to 
fraud or error, and to issue an auditor’s 
report that includes our opinion. 
Reasonable assurance is a high level 
of assurance but is not a guarantee that 
an audit conducted in accordance with 
ISAs (UK) will always detect a material 
misstatement when it exists. Misstatements 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Nanoco Group plc continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 097
can arise from fraud or error and are 
considered material if, individually or in 
the aggregate, they could reasonably 
be expected to influence the economic 
decisions of users taken on the basis of 
these financial statements.
The extent to which our procedures 
are capable of detecting irregularities, 
including fraud is detailed below.
Irregularities, including fraud, are 
instances of non-compliance with laws 
and regulations. We design procedures 
in line with our responsibilities, outlined 
above, to detect material misstatements 
in respect of irregularities, including fraud.
Based on our understanding of the 
group and the parent company and 
their industry, we considered that 
non-compliance with the following laws 
and regulations might have a material 
effect on the financial statements: 
employment regulations, health and 
safety regulations, anti-money 
laundering regulations, compliance 
with the Data Protection Act, Patent 
regulations and compliance with 
London Stock Exchange rules for 
premium listed companies.
To help us identify instances of 
non‑compliance with these laws 
and regulations, and in identifying 
and assessing the risks of material 
misstatement in respect to non-
compliance, our procedures included, 
but were not limited to:
	
| Gaining an understanding of the legal 
and regulatory framework applicable 
to the group and the parent company, 
the industry in which they operate, 
and the structure of the group, and 
considering the risk of acts by the 
group and the parent company which 
were contrary to the applicable laws 
and regulations, including fraud; 
	
| Inquiring of the directors, 
management and, where appropriate, 
those charged with governance, as to 
whether the group and the parent 
company is in compliance with laws 
and regulations, and discussing their 
policies and procedures regarding 
compliance with laws and regulations;
	
| Inspecting correspondence with 
relevant licensing or regulatory 
authorities including Patent 
regulations within countries in which 
the group operates;
	
| Reviewing minutes of directors’ 
meetings in the year; and
	
| Discussing amongst the engagement 
team the laws and regulations listed 
above, and remaining alert to any 
indications of non-compliance.
We also considered those laws and 
regulations that have a direct effect 
on the preparation of the financial 
statements, such as tax legislation, 
pension legislation, the Companies 
Act 2006 and listing rules. 
In addition, we evaluated the directors’ 
and management’s incentives and 
opportunities for fraudulent manipulation 
of the financial statements, including the 
risk of management override of controls, 
and determined that the principal risks 
related to posting manual journal entries 
to manipulate financial performance, 
management bias through judgements 
and assumptions in significant accounting 
estimates, in particular in relation to the 
estimate of the recoverable amount of 
the investment in subsidiaries held in the 
parent company, revenue recognition 
(which we pinpointed to the occurrence 
of service revenue and significant 
one-off or unusual transactions). 
Our procedures in relation to fraud 
included but were not limited to:
	
| Making enquiries of the directors and 
management on whether they had 
knowledge of any actual, suspected 
or alleged fraud;
	
| Gaining an understanding of the 
internal controls established to 
mitigate risks related to fraud;
	
| Discussing amongst the engagement 
team the risks of fraud; 
	
| Addressing the risks of fraud through 
management override of controls by 
performing journal entry testing; and
	
| Seeking disconfirming evidence by 
obtaining external records to assess 
management assumptions against;
	
| Incorporating an element of 
unpredictability in the selection of the 
nature timing, and extent of audit 
procedures performed. 
The primary responsibility for the prevention 
and detection of irregularities, including 
fraud, rests with both those charged with 
governance and management. As with 
any audit, there remained a risk of 
non-detection of irregularities, as these 
may involve collusion, forgery, intentional 
omissions, misrepresentations or the 
override of internal controls.
The risks of material misstatement that 
had the greatest effect on our audit are 
discussed in the “Key audit matters” 
section of this report. 
A further description of our 
responsibilities is available on the 
Financial Reporting Council’s website 
at www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. 
This description forms part of our 
auditor’s report.
Other matters which we are 
required to address
Following the recommendation of the 
audit committee, we were appointed by 
The Board of Directors on 21 June 2022 
to audit the financial statements for the 
year ending 31 July 2022 and subsequent 
financial periods. The period of total 
uninterrupted engagement is 3 years, 
covering the years ending 31 July 2022 
to 31 July 2024.
The non-audit services prohibited by 
the FRC’s Ethical Standard were not 
provided to the group or the parent 
company and we remain independent 
of the group and the parent company 
in conducting our audit.
Our audit opinion is consistent with our 
additional report to the audit committee.
Use of the audit report
This report is made solely to the 
company’s members as a body in 
accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of 
the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work 
has been undertaken so that we might 
state to the company’s members those 
matters we are required to state to them 
in an auditor’s report and for no other 
purpose. To the fullest extent permitted 
by law, we do not accept or assume 
responsibility to anyone other than the 
company and the company’s members 
as a body for our audit work, for this report, 
or for the opinions we have formed.
As required by the Financial Conduct 
Authority Disclosure Guidance and 
Transparency Rules, these financial 
statements will form part of the 
electronic reporting format prepared 
annual financial report filed on the 
National Storage Mechanism of the 
Financial Conduct Authority. This 
auditor’s report provides no assurance 
over whether the annual financial report 
will be prepared using the correct 
electronic reporting format. 
Valerie Levi (Senior Statutory Auditor) 
for and on behalf of Forvis Mazars LLP
Chartered Accountants and Statutory 
Auditor 
1 St Peter’s Square Manchester M2 3DE
21 November 2024

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
098
Notes
2024
£’000
2023
£’000
Revenue
4
7,874
5,618
Cost of sales
(1,211)
(847)
Gross profit
6,663
4,771
Other operating income
Government grants
5
142
230
Profit on sale of IP
6
—
68,687
Gain on derivative financial instrument
6
1,814
—
Operating expenses
Research and development expenses
6
(853)
(1,295)
Administrative expenses
(6,059)
(57,401)
Operating profit
6
1,707
14,992
– Before share-based payments and non-recurring items
850
(2,915)
– Share-based payments
24
(957)
(953)
– Profit on sale of IP
6
—
68,687
– Gain on derivative financial instrument
1,814
—
– Litigation costs
6
—
(49,337)
– EGM requisition
—
(490)
Finance income
8
835
38
Finance expense
8
(677)
(5,457)
Profit before taxation
1,865
9,573
Taxation
9
(3,118)
1,512
(Loss)/profit after taxation
(1,253)
11,085
Other comprehensive income
—
—
Total comprehensive (loss)/profit for the year
(1,253)
11,085
(Loss)/profit per share
Basic (loss)/profit per share for the year
10
(0.43p)
3.44p
Diluted (loss)/profit per share for the year
10
(0.43p)
3.32p
The loss for the current year and profit for the prior year arise from the group’s continuing operations and are attributable to the 
equity holders of the Parent.
The notes on pages 102 to 131 form an integral part of these financial statements.
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
for the year ended 31 July 2024

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024 099
Group
Notes
Share
capital
£’000
Share
premium
£’000
Capital 
redemption 
reserve
£’000
Reverse
acquisition
reserve
£’000
Share-
based
payment
reserve
£’000
Merger
reserve
£’000
Shares 
held 
by EBT
£’000
(Accumulated
losses)/
retained 
earnings
£’000
Total
£’000
At 1 August 2022
32,244
121,145
—
(77,868)
4,916
(1,242)
—
(74,715)
4,480
Profit for the year
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
11,085
11,085
Other comprehensive income
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Total comprehensive profit
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
11,085
11,085
Capital reduction
22
—
(121,145)
—
—
—
—
—
121,145
—
Issue of capital to EBT 
on option exercise
199
—
—
—
(259)
—
(105)
60
(105)
Share-based payments
24
—
—
—
—
953
—
—
—
953
At 31 July 2023
32,443
—
—
(77,868)
5,610
(1,242)
(105)
57,575
16,413
Loss for the year
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
(1,253)
(1,253)
Other comprehensive income
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Total comprehensive loss
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
(1,253)
(1,253)
Share buy-back
22, 26
(12,186)
—
12,186
—
—
—
(3,348)
(29,683)
(33,031)
Issue of capital to EBT 
on option exercise
—
—
—
—
(207)
—
105
5
(97)
Transfer of expired options
24
—
—
—
—
(4,788)
—
—
4,788
—
Share-based payments
24
—
—
—
—
957
—
—
—
957
At 31 July 2024
20,257
—
12,186
(77,868)
1,572
(1,242)
(3,348)
31,432
(17,011)
Company statement of changes in equity
for the year ended 31 July 2024
Company
Notes
Share
capital
£’000
Share
premium
£’000
Share-
based
payment
reserve
£’000
Capital
redemption
reserve
£’000
Treasury 
shares
£’000
(Accumulated
losses)/ 
retained
earnings
£’000
Total
£’000
At 1 August 2022
32,244
121,145
4,916
4,402
(20)
(120,298)
42,389
Profit for the year and total comprehensive profit 
for the year
—
—
—
—
—
46,182
46,182
Capital reduction
—
(121,145)
—
(4,402)
—
125,547
—
Issue of capital to EBT on option exercise
24
199
—
(259)
—
—
60
—
Share-based payments
24
—
—
953
—
—
—
953
At 31 July 2023
32,443
—
5,610
—
(20)
51,491
89,524
Profit for the year and total comprehensive income 
for the year
—
—
—
—
—
8,807
8,807
Share buy-back
22, 26
(12,186)
—
—
12,186
(8)
(29,703)
(29,711)
Issue of capital to EBT on option exercise
24, 26
—
—
(207)
—
—
7
(200)
Transfer of expired options
24
—
—
(4,788)
—
—
4,788
—
Share-based payments
24
—
—
957
—
—
—
957
At 31 July 2024
20,257
—
1,572
12,186
(28)
35,390
69,377
Consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the year ended 31 July 2024

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
100
Notes
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Assets
Non-current assets
Tangible fixed assets
11
1,651
—
304
—
Right of use assets
12
2,188
—
2,075
—
Intangible assets
13 
745
—
966
—
Deferred tax assets
9
2,350
—
2,573
—
Foreign withholding tax receivable
9
1,664
—
1,756
—
Investment in subsidiaries
14
—
46,473
—
41,700
8,598
46,473
7,674
41,700
Current assets
Inventories
15
305
—
308
—
Trade and other receivables
16
1,083
3,518
33,986
52,876
Foreign withholding tax receivable
9
149
—
592
—
Income tax receivable
9
235
—
—
—
Cash and cash equivalents
17
20,293
20,164
8,207
105
22,065
23,682
43,093
52,981
Total assets
30,663
70,155
50,767
94,681
Liabilities
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
18
(1,578)
(778)
(2,783)
(1,153)
Loans
19
—
—
(4,004)
(4,004)
Lease liabilities
21
(621)
—
(456)
—
Income tax liability
9
—
—
(770)
—
Deferred revenue
20
(5,934)
—
(6,123)
—
(8,133)
(778)
(14,136)
(5,157)
Non-current liabilities
Loans
19
—
—
(557)
—
Lease liabilities
21
(1,288)
—
(1,415)
—
Provisions
23
(659)
—
(445)
—
Deferred revenue
20
(37,594)
—
(17,801)
—
(39,541)
—
(20,218)
—
Total liabilities
(47,674)
(778)
(34,354)
(5,157)
Net (liabilities)/assets
(17,011)
69,377
16,413
89,524
Capital and reserves
Share capital
22
20,257
20,257
32,443
32,443
Capital redemption reserve
22
12,186
12,186
—
—
Reverse acquisition reserve
22
(77,868)
—
(77,868)
—
Share-based payment reserve
24
1,572
1,572
5,610
5,610
Merger reserve
25
(1,242)
—
(1,242)
—
Shares held by EBT
26
(3,348)
(28)
(105)
—
Retained earnings
26
31,432
35,390
57,575
51,471
Total equity
(17,011)
69,377
16,413
89,524
The Parent Company’s result for the year ended 31 July 2024 was a profit of £8,807,000 (2023: profit of £46,182,000). There was no 
other comprehensive income in either the current or prior year.
The notes on pages 102 to 131 form an integral part of these financial statements. The financial statements on pages 98 to 131 
were approved by the Board of Directors on 21 November 2024 and signed on its behalf by:
Dr Christopher Richards	
	
Liam Gray
Chairman	
	
Chief Financial Officer
21 November 2024	
	
21 November 2024
Group and Company statements of financial position
at 31 July 2024
Registered no. 05067291

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
101
Notes
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Profit before tax
1,865
8,807
9,573
46,182
Adjustments for:
Net finance (income)/expense
8
(158)
(275)
5,419
5,337
(Profit)/loss on exchange rate translations
(852)
(350)
1,747
(10)
Depreciation of tangible fixed assets
11
117
—
76
—
Depreciation of right of use assets
12
698
—
555
—
Amortisation of intangible assets
13
224
—
279
—
Profit on disposal of intangible assets
6
—
—
(68,687)
—
Impairment of intangible assets
13
132
—
92
—
Reversal of previous impairment of investment
—
(3,816)
—
—
Share-based payments
24
957
—
953
—
Loss on disposal of tangible fixed assets
11
2
—
8
—
Increase/(decrease) in inventory provision
93
—
(15)
—
Decrease in receivables provision
—
(2,993)
—
(52,323)
Changes in working capital:
  Increase in inventories
(90)
—
(119)
—
  Decrease/(increase) in trade and other receivables
33,459
55,148
282
(378)
  (Decrease)/increase in trade and other payables
(1,209)
(380)
970
316
  Decrease in provisions
—
—
(176)
—
  Increase in deferred revenue
19,604
—
23,320
—
Cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities
54,842
56,141
(25,723)
(876)
Foreign withholding tax paid
(2,566)
—
(2,641)
—
Tax paid
(797)
—
—
—
Research and development tax credit received
—
—
524
—
Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities
51,479
56,141
(27,840)
(876)
Cash flow from investing activities
Purchases of tangible fixed assets
11
(1,466)
—
(305)
—
Purchases of intangible fixed assets
13
(135)
—
(76)
—
Proceeds from sale of tangible fixed assets
—
—
15
—
Proceeds from sale of intangible fixed assets
—
—
34,509
—
Interest received
8
785
722
38
—
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from investing activities
(816)
722
34,181
—
Cash flow from financing activities
Proceeds from placing of ordinary share capital
—
—
199
199
Purchase of shares to satisfy options
(97)
—
—
—
Return of capital to shareholders
(32,000)
(32,000)
—
—
Fees on return of capital to shareholders
(1,027)
(654)
—
—
Repayment of loan - capital
(3,550)
(3,150)
—
—
Repayment of loan - interest
(1,528)
(1,350)
—
—
Payment of lease liabilities (capital)
(558)
—
(463)
—
Payment of lease liabilities (interest)
(103)
—
(86)
—
Interest paid
(57)
—
(4,728)
(4,725)
Net cash outflow from financing activities 
(38,920)
(37,154)
(5,078)
(4,526)
Increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
11,743
19,709
1,263
(5,402)
Cash and cash equivalents at the start of the year
8,207
105
6,762
5,497
Effects of exchange rate changes
343
350
182
10
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
17
20,293
20,164
8,207
105
The notes on pages 102 to 131 form an integral part of these financial statements.
Group and Company cash flow statements
for the year ended 31 July 2024

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
102
1. Reporting entity
Nanoco Group plc (the “Company”), a public company limited by shares, is on the equity shares (commercial companies) list of 
the London Stock Exchange. The Company is incorporated and domiciled in England, UK. The registered number is 05067291 and 
the address of its registered office is Science Centre, The Heath Business and Technical Park, Runcorn WA7 4QX. The Company is 
registered in England.
These group financial statements consolidate those of the Company and its subsidiaries (together referred to as the “group” 
and individually as “group entities”) for the year ended 31 July 2024.
The financial statements of the group for the year ended 31 July 2024 were authorised for issue by the Board of Directors on 
21 November 2024 and the statements of financial position were signed on the Board’s behalf by Dr Christopher Richards and 
Liam Gray.
The Company has elected to take the exemption under section 408 of the Companies Act 2006 not to present the Parent 
Company’s income statement. 
The significant accounting policies adopted by the group are set out in note 3.
2. Basis of preparation
(a) Statement of compliance
The group’s and Parent Company’s financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Accounting 
Standards in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and UK-adopted IFRSs as issued by the International 
Accounting Standards Board for the year ended 31 July 2024.
(b) Basis of measurement 
The Parent Company and group financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost basis, except for the revaluation 
of financial assets classified as “fair value through other comprehensive income” or “fair value through profit or loss”, which are 
reported in accordance with the accounting policies below. 
(c) Going concern 
All of the following matters are taken into account by the Directors in forming their assessment of going concern: The group’s 
business activities and market conditions are set out on pages 9 to 27; the principal risks and uncertainties are shown on pages 
33 to 35, and; the group’s financial position is described in the Financial review on pages 30 to 32. Furthermore, note 27 
summarises the group’s financial risk management objectives, policies and processes. 
The key factor in the group’s going concern assessment is the strength of the balance sheet at 31 July 2014 with £20.3 million of 
cash reserves and all external loans having been repaid during the year. There are sufficient cash reserves to support the group’s 
cost base throughout the going concern period in any of its forecast scenarios. Any future distribution of surplus cash will take 
into consideration the viability of the group and sufficient cash will be retained to ensure viability.
For the purposes of their going concern assessment and the basis for the preparation of the 2024 Annual Report, the Directors 
have reviewed the same trading and cash flow forecasts and sensitivity analyses that were used by the group in the viability 
assessment described on page 36, with the going concern assessment covering the period to November 2025. The same base 
case and downside sensitivities were also used.
The base case represents the Board’s current expectations. Assumptions in the base case are:
	
| reduced revenue in FY25 following the loss of the European electronics customer;
	
| new services revenue will be generated from 2025;
	
| ramp up of product sales from FY26 moving to larger scale in FY27;
	
| other companies pay to access Nanoco’s technology in the future;
	
| reduction in headcount and overheads to reflect reduced short-term revenue expectations;
	
| costs associated with being a listed entity and other costs reflect the current inflationary environment; and
	
| the reduced cost base is capable of supporting significant increases in revenue above those assumed in the base case 
so there is no immediate requirement for short-term increases or new capital expenditure.
The downside case then flexes those assumptions as follows:
	
| a full-year delay in small scale commercial production revenues (into FY26); and
	
| no new service customers until FY27.
Notes to the financial statements

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
103
2. Basis of preparation continued
(c) Going concern continued
Both cases above produce cash flow statements that demonstrate that the group has sufficient cash throughout the period 
of the forecast, being a period to November 2025.
Accordingly, the Directors continue to adopt the going concern basis in preparing the consolidated financial statements. 
The financial statements do not reflect any adjustments that would be required to be made if they were prepared on a 
basis other than the going concern basis.
(d) Functional and presentational currency 
These financial statements are presented in Pounds Sterling, which is the presentational currency of the group and the functional 
currency of the Company. All financial information presented has been rounded to the nearest thousand.
(e) Use of estimates and judgements 
The preparation of financial statements requires management to make estimates and judgements that affect the amounts 
reported for assets and liabilities as at the reporting date and the amounts reported for revenues and expenses during the year. 
The nature of estimation means that actual amounts could differ from those estimates. Estimates and judgements used in the 
preparation of the financial statements are continually reviewed and revised as necessary. While every effort is made to ensure 
that such estimates and judgements are reasonable, by their nature they are uncertain and, as such, changes in estimates and 
judgements may have a material impact on the financial statements.
In the process of applying the group’s accounting policies, management has made the following estimates and judgements, 
which have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in the consolidated financial statements.
Estimates
Samsung licence of IP
Following the judgement over the method of revenue recognition of the Samsung contract described below, it was determined 
that the appropriate period for revenue recognition was the average remaining life of the relevant IP of 8.8 years. The average 
remaining life of the IP is a significant estimate and is reviewed each year. A sensitivity analysis is included in note 6.
Equity-settled share-based payments
The group has historically issued LTIPs to incentivise employees. The determination of share-based payment costs requires: the 
selection of an appropriate valuation method; consideration as to the inputs necessary for the valuation model chosen; and 
judgement regarding when and if performance conditions will be met. Inputs required for this arise from judgements relating to 
the future volatility of the share price of Nanoco and comparable companies, risk-free interest rates and expected lives of the 
options. The Directors draw on a variety of sources to aid in the determination of the appropriate data to use in such calculations. 
The share-based payment expense is most sensitive to non-market vesting assumptions. Further information is included in note 24.
Deferred tax
The group recognises deferred tax assets only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits, feasible tax planning 
strategies and deferred tax liabilities will be available against which the tax losses can be utilised. Estimation of the level of future 
taxable profits is therefore required in order to determine the appropriate carrying value of the deferred tax asset. Future profits 
are based on sensitised management forecasts for the following three years which is the period over which the profits are 
considered to be probable. The period over which forecast profits are considered to be probable is a key assumption and as 
such a sensitivity analysis has been performed in note 9. The Company has recognised £2.4 million of deferred tax assets in the 
year (2023: £2.6 million) which represents the proportion of accumulated losses that are expected to be utilised in the medium term. 
Recoverability of investment
An estimate is required to assess the carrying value of the Company’s investments at each reporting date.
Indicators of potential impairment noted in IAS 36 (paragraph 12) include, but are not limited to, situations where the carrying amount of 
the net assets of the entity is more than its market value and where significant changes with an adverse effect on the entity have taken 
place during the year. The return of capital in the year and the associated decrease in market value are considered to be indications 
of impairment. Given the main trading entity is Nanoco Technologies Limited (owned by Nanoco Tech Limited), this holds the majority of 
the value for the investment. Where indicators of impairment have been identified, the group estimated the recoverable amount 
based on the value in use of the underlying business.
The computation uses cash flows based on the most recently approved financial budgets and strategic forecasts covering a period of 
5 years and further projections taking the analysis out into perpetuity.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
104
2. Basis of preparation continued
(e) Use of estimates and judgements continued
Key assumptions for the value in use computations are those regarding:
•	
Forecasted cash inflows/income based on strategic income streams and associated related costs;
•	
Strategic operating period ; and
•	
The discount rate.
The values assigned to the variables that underpin the Group’s expectations of future operating performance were determined based 
on historical performance and the Group’s expectations with regard to future strategic forecasts. The strategic operating period used 
is the five years to 31 July 2029. The forecast cash flows are discounted at a pre-tax rate of 18.5% (2023: 19.7%). The discount rate is 
derived from a calculation using the capital asset pricing model to calculate cost of equity utilising available market data. The 
discount rate is compared to the published discount rates of comparable businesses and relevant industry data prior to being 
adopted. Based on the base case VIU calculated, a reversal of previous impairment losses was identified, leaving a carrying value of 
£46.5 million (2023: £41.7 million). See note 14 for more detail. 
Judgements 
Revenue recognition
Judgement is required in reviewing the terms of development agreements to identify separate components of revenue, if any, 
that are distinct and in turn the period over which development revenue should be recognised. Management judgements are 
similarly required to determine whether services or rights under licence agreements have been delivered so as to enable licence 
revenue to be recognised. This matter is further complicated where a contract may have different elements which may result in 
separate recognition treatments under IFRS 15. Further information is included in note 3(d).
Samsung licence of IP
Judgement is required in reviewing the terms of the licence agreement with Samsung as to whether the associated revenue 
should be recognised at a point in time or over time, and if over time, over what period. The Directors reviewed the contract 
in detail and analysed the terms against the specific requirements of IFRS 15 in relation to licences. They concluded that the 
group had an ongoing performance obligation in regard to the licence and therefore the revenue should be recognised over time.
Research and development
Careful judgement by the Directors is applied when deciding whether the recognition requirements for development costs 
have been met. This is necessary as the economic success of any product development is uncertain until such time as technical 
viability has been proven and commercial supply agreements are likely to be achieved. Judgements are based on the information 
available at each reporting date, which includes the progress with testing and certification and progress on, for example, 
establishment of commercial arrangements with third parties. In addition, all internal activities related to research and 
development of new products are continuously monitored by the Directors. Further information is included in note 3(h).
3. Significant accounting policies
The accounting policies set out below are consistent with those of the previous financial year and are applied consistently 
by group entities.
(a) Basis of consolidation
The group financial statements consolidate the financial statements of Nanoco Group plc and the entities it controls (its 
subsidiaries) drawn up to 31 July each year.
Subsidiaries are all entities over which the group has the power over the investee (i.e. existing rights that give it the current ability 
to direct the relevant activities of the investee), exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and 
ability to use its power over the investee to affect its returns. All of Nanoco Group plc’s subsidiaries are 100% owned. Subsidiaries 
are fully consolidated from the date control passes. During the prior year, the group established an Employee Benefit Trust (“EBT”) 
for the purpose of awarding shares to employees on exercise of options under the share-based compensation schemes. Although 
the EBT is an independent legal entity and not owned by the group, it is reliant on funding from the group and acts at its request; 
as such, it is deemed to be controlled by the group and is consolidated into the group accounts.
The acquisition method of accounting is used to account for the acquisition of subsidiaries by the group. The costs of an acquisition 
are measured as the fair value of the assets given, equity instruments issued and liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of 
exchange, plus costs directly attributable to the acquisition. Identifiable assets acquired and liabilities and contingent liabilities 
assumed in a business combination are initially measured at fair value at acquisition date irrespective of the extent of any 
minority interest. 
The difference between the cost of acquisition of shares in subsidiaries and the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired 
is capitalised as goodwill and reviewed annually for impairment. Any deficiency in the cost of acquisition below the fair value of 
identifiable net assets acquired (i.e. discount on acquisition) is recognised directly in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
105
3. Significant accounting policies continued
(a) Basis of consolidation continued
In the consolidated financial statements, the assets and liabilities of the foreign operations are translated into Sterling at 
the exchange rate prevailing at the reporting date. Income and cash flow statement items for group entities with a functional 
currency other than Sterling are translated into Sterling at monthly average exchange rates, which approximate to the actual 
rates, for the relevant accounting periods. The exchange differences arising on translation are recognised in other comprehensive 
income. See note 3(b).
All intra-group transactions, balances and unrealised gains on transactions between group companies are eliminated on 
consolidation. Subsidiaries’ accounting policies are amended where necessary to ensure consistency with the policies adopted 
by the group.
(b) Foreign currency transactions
Transactions in foreign currencies are initially recorded in the functional currency by applying the spot rate ruling at the date of 
the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies (including those of the group’s US subsidiary) 
are retranslated at the functional currency rate of exchange ruling at the reporting date. All differences are taken to the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income.
Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates 
as at the dates of the initial transactions. Non-monetary items measured at fair value in a foreign currency are translated using 
the exchange rates at the date when the fair value was determined.
(c) Segmental reporting
An operating segment is a component of an entity that engages in business activities from which it may earn revenues and incur 
expenses, whose operating results are regularly reviewed by the entity’s chief operating decision maker to make decisions about 
resources to be allocated to the segment and assess its performance, and for which discrete financial information is available. 
As at the reporting date, the Company operated with only a single segment, being the research, development and manufacture 
of products and services based on high performance nanoparticles.
(d) Revenue recognition
Revenue comprises the fair value of the sale of products and services to external customers, net of value added tax or other sales 
taxes or duties, rebates, discounts and returns. Revenue is recognised according to the five-step model set out in IFRS 15 as follows:
1.	 identify the contract(s) with a customer;
2.	 identify the performance obligations in the contract;
3.	 determine the transaction price;
4.	 allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations in the contract; and
5.	 recognise revenue when (or as) the entity satisfied a performance obligation.
Products sold
Revenue from the sale of products is recognised at the point of transfer of control, which is generally on shipment or delivery 
of the product. This is dependent on the delivery terms agreed with the customer. At this stage the group has completed its 
performance obligations. The supply and delivery of products are not deemed to be separable performance obligations as 
the customer is obliged to make use of the group’s delivery arrangements in most cases. Invoices are raised at the point of 
shipment and payment terms are usually 30 days.
Rendering of services
Revenues from development programmes are recognised over time as the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the 
benefit of the performance obligation as the group performs the service. Where revenue is recognised over time the group uses 
an input method whereby cost is used to measure progress and costs are incurred evenly throughout the period. Under the 
development contracts, the customer pays in accordance with a pre-arranged payment schedule, usually quarterly. If the 
amount of revenue recognised at a point in time is different from the cash received then the difference is held on the balance 
sheet as a contract asset or liability, Some contracts include clauses for compensation on early termination, such compensation 
is only recognised at the point the clause is triggered.
Licences
Licences grant customers access to the group’s technology over a set length of time. Therefore, revenue related to the granting 
of a licence is recognised over the same period of time. The length of time to which the licence, and therefore the revenue, relates 
varies by customer and agreement. Where payments for licences are received upfront, the value is held as deferred revenue until 
it is recognised. Payment terms for licences are specific to the individual contracts based on the agreed terms.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
106
3. Significant accounting policies continued
(e) Government grants
Government grants are recognised when it is reasonable to expect that the grants will be received and that all related 
conditions are met, usually on submission of a valid claim for payment.
Government grants of a revenue nature are recognised as other operating income in the consolidated statement of comprehensive 
income. Government grants of an expense nature are recognised as a credit to administrative expenses in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income.
Government grants relating to capital expenditure are deducted in arriving at the carrying amount of the asset.
(f) Cost of sales
Cost of sales comprises the materials, direct labour, duty, freight, and employee and employee-associated costs incurred in 
the generation of revenue from products sold and research and development services supplied. 
Revenue from royalties and licences, which comprises payments from customers to gain preferential treatment in terms of supply 
or pricing, does not have an associated cost of sale.
(g) Contract assets and contract liabilities
When either party to a contract has performed, the contract balance is presented in the statement of financial position as 
accrued income or deferred revenue depending on the relationship between the completion of the performance obligations and 
the customer’s payment. Accrued income represents consideration earned through the completion of performance obligation, or 
part performance where revenue is recognised over time, that is not yet due for payment. Deferred revenue represents advanced 
consideration received from customers for which the corresponding performance obligation has not been performed or is only 
part performed where revenue is recognised over time.
(h) Research and development
Research costs are charged in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income as they are incurred. Development costs 
will be capitalised as intangible assets when it is probable that future economic benefits will flow to the group. Such intangible 
assets will be amortised on a straight-line basis from the point at which the assets are ready for use over the period of the 
expected benefit and will be reviewed for impairment at each reporting date based on the circumstances at the reporting date.
The criteria for recognising expenditure as an asset are:
	
| it is technically feasible to complete the product;
	
| management intends to complete the product and use or sell it;
	
| there is an ability to use or sell the product;
	
| it can be demonstrated how the product will generate probable future economic benefits;
	
| adequate technical, financial and other resources are available to complete the development, use and sale of the product; and
	
| expenditure attributable to the product can be reliably measured.
Development costs are currently charged against income as incurred since the criteria for their recognition as an asset are not 
met, the exception being the costs of filing intellectual property as these are considered to generate probable future economic 
benefit and are capitalised as intangible assets (see note 13).
(i) Finance income and expense
Finance income comprises interest income on funds invested and changes in the fair value of financial assets at fair value 
through the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Interest income is recognised as interest accrues using the 
effective interest rate method.
Finance expense comprises interest expense on borrowings and lease liabilities. All borrowing costs are recognised using 
the effective interest method.
(j) Income tax
Income tax expense comprises current and deferred tax. Income tax expense is recognised in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income except to the extent that it relates to items recognised directly in equity or in other comprehensive income.
Current income tax assets (including research and development income tax credit) and liabilities for the current and prior periods 
are measured at the amount expected to be recovered from, or paid to, the tax authorities. The tax rates and tax laws used to 
compute the amount are those that are enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
107
3. Significant accounting policies continued
(j) Income tax continued
Deferred income tax is recognised on all temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their 
carrying amounts in the financial statements with the following exceptions:
	
| where the temporary difference arises from the initial recognition of goodwill or of an asset or liability in a transaction that 
is not a business combination that at the time of the transaction affects neither accounting nor taxable profit or loss; and
	
| in respect of taxable temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries where the timing of the reversal of the 
temporary differences can be controlled and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are measured on an undiscounted basis using the tax rates and tax laws that have 
been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date and which are expected to apply when the related deferred 
tax asset is realised or the deferred tax liability is settled.
Deferred income tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which 
differences can be utilised. An asset is not recognised to the extent that the transfer of economic benefits in the future is uncertain.
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are offset only if a legally enforceable right exists to set off current tax assets against 
current tax liabilities, the deferred income taxes relate to the same taxation authority and that authority permits the group to 
make a single payment.
(k) Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment assets are recognised initially at cost. After initial recognition, these assets are carried at cost less 
any accumulated depreciation and any accumulated impairment losses. Cost comprises the aggregate amount paid and the 
fair value of any other consideration given to acquire the asset and includes costs directly attributable to making the asset 
capable of operating as intended.
Depreciation is computed by allocating the depreciable amount of an asset on a systematic basis over its useful life and is 
applied separately to each identifiable component.
The following bases and rates are used to depreciate classes of assets:
Laboratory infrastructure	 –	 straight line over five years or the remainder of the lease period (if shorter)
Fixtures and fittings	
–	 straight line over five years
Office equipment	
–	 straight line over three years
Plant and machinery	
–	 straight line over five years
The carrying values of tangible fixed assets are reviewed for impairment if events or changes in circumstances indicate that the 
carrying value may not be recoverable and are written down immediately to their recoverable amount. Useful lives and residual 
values are reviewed annually and where adjustments are required these are made prospectively.
A tangible fixed asset item is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the 
continued use of the asset. Any gain or loss arising on the derecognition of the asset is included in the consolidated statement 
of comprehensive income in the period of derecognition.
Assets under construction, which principally relate to leasehold improvements and plant and machinery, are not depreciated until 
such time as they are available for use. If there are indications of impairment in the carrying value, then the recoverable amount 
is estimated and compared to the carrying amount. The recoverable amount is determined as the value that will ultimately be 
capitalised as an asset, based upon IAS 16 recognition and capitalisation criteria.
(l) Intangible assets
Intangible assets acquired either as part of a business combination or from contractual or other legal rights are recognised 
separately from goodwill provided they are separable and their fair value can be measured reliably. This includes the costs 
associated with acquiring and registering patents in respect of intellectual property rights.
Where consideration for the purchase of an intangible asset includes contingent consideration, the fair value of the contingent 
consideration is included in the cost of the asset.
Where intangible assets recognised have finite lives, after initial recognition their carrying value is amortised on a straight-line 
basis over those lives. The nature of those intangibles recognised and their estimated useful lives are as follows:
Patents	
– 	 straight line over ten years

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
108
3. Significant accounting policies continued
(m) Impairment of non-financial assets
At each reporting date the group reviews the carrying value of its plant, equipment and intangible assets to determine whether 
there is an indication that these assets have suffered an impairment loss. If any such indication exists, or when annual impairment 
testing for an asset is required, the Company makes an assessment of the asset’s recoverable amount.
An asset’s recoverable amount is the higher of an asset’s fair value less costs to sell and its value in use and is determined for an 
individual asset, unless the asset does not generate cash inflows that are largely independent of those from other assets or 
groups of assets. Where the carrying value of an asset exceeds its recoverable amount, the asset is considered impaired and is 
written down to its recoverable amount. In assessing value in use, the group reviews the potential markets for the asset and 
considers the possibility of short to medium-term commercial success being derived from the asset. In determining fair value less 
costs of disposal, an appropriate valuation model is used and these calculations are corroborated by valuation multiples or other 
available fair value indicators. Impairment losses on continuing operations are recognised in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income in those expense categories consistent with the function of the impaired asset.
An assessment is made at each reporting date as to whether there is any indication that previously recognised impairment losses 
may no longer exist or may have decreased. If such indication exists, the recoverable amount is estimated. A previously recognised 
impairment loss is reversed only if there has been a change in the assumptions used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount 
since the last impairment loss was recognised. If that is the case, the carrying amount of the asset is increased to its recoverable 
amount. That increased amount cannot exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation, 
had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset in prior years. Such reversal is recognised in the consolidated statement 
of comprehensive income unless the asset is carried at a revalued amount, in which case the reversal is treated as a valuation 
increase. After such a reversal, the depreciation charge is adjusted in future periods to allocate the asset’s revised carrying 
amount, less any residual value, on a systematic basis over its remaining useful life.
Impairment charges have been posted during the year in relation to intangible assets. See the relevant note for more information.
(n) Investments in subsidiaries
Investments in subsidiaries are stated in the Company statement of financial position at cost less provision for any impairment. 
The long-term loans to subsidiaries form part of the investment in subsidiaries balance.
(o) Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost based on latest contractual prices includes all costs 
incurred in bringing each product to its present location and condition. Net realisable value is based on estimated selling price 
less any further costs expected to be incurred to disposal. Provision is made for slow-moving or obsolete items.
(p) Financial instruments
Financial assets and financial liabilities are recognised when the group becomes party to the contractual provisions of the 
relevant instrument and derecognised when it ceases to be party to such provisions. Such assets and liabilities are classified as 
current if they are expected to be realised or settled within twelve months after the balance sheet date. Financial assets and 
liabilities are initially recognised at amortised cost and subsequently measured at amortised cost including directly attributable 
transaction costs.
The group has the following categories of financial assets and liabilities:
Receivables
(i) Trade and other receivables
Trade receivables, which generally have 30 to 60-day terms, are recognised and carried at the lower of their original invoiced 
value and recoverable amount. The time value of money is not material.
For trade receivables and contract assets, the group applies the IFRS 9 simplified approach in calculating ECLs. Therefore, the 
group does not track changes in credit risk but instead recognises a loss allowance based on lifetime ECLs at each reporting 
date. The group has established a provision matrix that is based on shared credit risk characteristics, its historical credit loss 
experience and days past due, adjusted for forward-looking factors specific to the debtors and the economic environment. 
The amount of the provision is recognised in the balance sheet within trade receivables. Movements in the provision are 
recognised in the profit and loss account in administrative expenses.
The loss allowances for inter-company financial assets are based on assumptions on risk of non-payment. The Company 
recognises an allowance for expected credit loss based on the difference between contractual cashflows and the cash flows 
that the Company expects to receive.
(ii) Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments
Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash at hand and deposits with maturities of three months or less. Short-term investments 
comprise deposits with maturities of more than three months but no greater than twelve months.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
109
3. Significant accounting policies continued
Financial liabilities at amortised cost
(i) Trade and other payables
Trade and other payables are non-interest bearing and are initially recognised at amortised cost. They are subsequently 
measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. 
(ii) Loans and convertible loan notes
Obligations for loans and borrowings are measured initially at fair value and subsequently interest-bearing loans are measured 
at amortised cost. Convertible loan notes are presented as financial liabilities as rights of the note holder to convert the loan 
notes into equity are within the control of the Company.
Derivatives
The group occasionally uses forward foreign currency contracts to manage its exposure to fluctuations in foreign exchange rates. 
These instruments are initially recognised at fair value on the trade date and are subsequently remeasured at their fair value at 
the end of the reporting period. The group does not designate forward contracts as hedging instruments, as such changes in the 
fair value of the derivative are recognised in the income statement as they arise.
(q) Share capital
Proceeds on issue of shares are included in shareholders’ equity, net of transaction costs. The carrying amount is not remeasured 
in subsequent years.
(r) Share-based payments
Equity-settled share-based payment transactions are measured with reference to the fair value at the date of grant, recognised 
on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on the Company’s estimate of shares that will eventually vest. Fair value is 
measured using a suitable option pricing model.
At each reporting date before vesting, the cumulative expense is calculated, representing the extent to which the vesting period 
has expired and management’s best estimate of the achievement or otherwise of non-market conditions and the number of 
equity instruments that will ultimately vest. The movement in cumulative expense since the previous reporting date is recognised 
in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, with a corresponding entry in equity.
Where the terms of an equity-settled award are modified or a new award is designated as replacing a cancelled or settled 
award, the cost based on the original award terms continues to be recognised over the original vesting period. In addition, an 
expense is recognised over the remainder of the new vesting period for the incremental fair value of any modification, based 
on the difference between the fair value of the original award and the fair value of the modified award, both as measured on 
the date of the modification. No reduction is recognised if this difference is negative.
Where awards are granted to the employees of the subsidiary company, the fair value of the awards at grant date is recorded in 
the Company’s financial statements as an increase in the value of the investment with a corresponding increase in equity via the 
share-based payment reserve.
Where awards relating to services within the year have not been issued and therefore the fair value has not been calculated at 
the year end, an estimate, based on the current share price, is made of the cost incurred to date and a true-up is performed 
once the valuation is complete.
(s) Defined contribution pension scheme
The group operates a defined contribution pension scheme. The assets of the scheme are held separately from those of the 
Company in an independently administered fund. The amounts charged against profits represent the contributions payable 
to the scheme in respect of the accounting period.
(t) Provisions
Provisions are recognised when the group has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event, it is 
probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable 
estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. Provision is not made for future operating losses. Provisions are discounted 
where the impact is deemed to be material. Where obligations are covered by “no win, no fee” funding arrangements, the liability 
is recognised in full at the point when the group becomes liable, i.e. when the outcome is known.
(u) Alternative performance measurements
Items of income and expenditure which are material and non-recurring are presented separately in the consolidated statement 
of comprehensive income. The separate reporting of such items helps to provide an indication of the underlying performance of 
the group and hence allows the user of the accounts a fuller understanding of that performance.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
110
3. Significant accounting policies continued
(v) Contingent assets and liabilities
A contingent asset is a possible asset that arises from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the occurrence 
or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the group. Contingent assets are not 
recognised but are disclosed in the notes to the financial statements when an inflow of economic benefits is probable. 
Contingent liabilities are possible obligations that arise from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the 
occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of Nanoco. Additionally, contingent liabilities may 
be present obligations that arise from past events but which are not recognised because it is not probable that an outflow of 
resources will be required to settle the obligation or the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. 
Contingent liabilities are not recognised in the consolidated statement of financial position but are disclosed and explained in 
the notes.
(w) IFRS 16 Leases
IFRS 16 sets out the principles for the recognition, measurement, presentation and disclosure of leases for both the lessee 
and the lessor. 
Lease payments for low value or short-term leases where the group has elected not to recognise a right of use asset and lease 
liability are charged as an expense on a straight-line basis. 
At the date of commencement of property leases, the group determines the lease term to be the full term of the lease, assuming 
that any option to break or extend is not likely to be exercised. Leases are regularly reviewed and will be revalued if it becomes 
likely that a break clause or option to extend will be exercised. The weighted average incremental borrowing rate applied at the 
date of transition was 3.75%. For new leases entered into in the year ended 31 July 2024, the weighted average incremental 
borrowing rate applied was 8.25% (2023: 8.00%).
The group recognises a right of use asset at the lease commencement date. The right of use asset is measured at its carrying 
amount as if IFRS 16 had been applied since the commencement date, discounted using the lessee’s incremental rate at the date 
of initial application. Subsequent to measurement, right of use assets are amortised on a straight-line basis over the remaining 
term of the lease or over the remaining economic life of the asset if assessed to be shorter.
The lease liabilities are measured at the present value of the remaining lease payments, discounted using the group’s incremental 
borrowing rate as at initial application or commencement date if later. The group’s incremental borrowing rate is the rate at 
which a similar borrowing could be obtained over a similar term in a similar economic environment. Judgement is required to 
determine an approximation with consideration given to the Bank of England base rates adjusted by an indicative credit 
premium and lease-specific adjustment. Subsequently, the lease liability is increased by the interest cost on the lease liability 
and decreased by the lease payments made. It is remeasured if there is a modification, a change in lease term or a change 
in the fixed lease payment. 
(x) New accounting standards and interpretations	
The following standards have been issued but have not been applied by the group in these financial statements. 
These amendments to standards and interpretations had no significant impact on the financial statements.
IFRS standards effective from 1 January 2024 (UK adopted):
	
| IAS 1 Amendment: Classification of Liabilities as Current or Non-current 
	
| IAS 1 Amendment: Non-current Liabilities with Covenants
	
| IFRS 16 Leases Amendment: Lease Liability in a Sale and Leaseback
	
| IAS 7 and IFRS 7 Amendment: Supplier Finance Arrangements
IFRS standards effective from 1 January 2025 (UK adopted):
	
| IAS 21 The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates (Amendment): Lack of Exchangeability
The amendments to standards and interpretations noted above are expected to have no significant impact on the financial statements.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
111
4. Segmental information
Operating segments
During the years ended 31 July 2024 and 2023, the group operated as one segment, being the research, development and 
manufacture of products and services based on high performance nanoparticles. This is the level at which operating results 
are reviewed by the Chief Operating Decision Maker (i.e. the Board) to make decisions about resources and for which financial 
information is available. All revenues have been generated from continuing operations and are from external customers.
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Analysis of revenue
Products sold
408
867
Rendering of services
1,410
1,685
Licences
6,056
3,066
7,874
5,618
There was one material customer who generated product and service revenue of £1,194,000 (2023: one material customer 
amounting to £2,014,000). £6,013,000 of the licence income related to the Samsung licence (2023: £2,963,000).
Revenue from the provision of services delivered over time totalled £7,466,000 (2023: £4,751,000). Revenue from the sale of goods 
transferred at a point in time amounted to £408,000 (2023: £867,000).
The group operates in a number of countries across the world, although all are managed in the UK. The group’s revenue per 
country based on the customer’s location is as follows:
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Revenue
South Korea
6,013
2,963
Netherlands
926
1,423
Japan
573
447
France
268
385
USA
46
59
Taiwan
42
323
Canada
3
9
Belgium
2
—
UK
1
1
Poland
—
8
7,874
5,618
All of the group’s assets are held in the UK and all of its capital expenditure arises in the UK. The profit before taxation and 
attributable to the single segment was £1,865,000 (2023: loss of £9,573,000).
5. Other operating income
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Government grants
142
230
Grants of £142,000 (2023: £230,000) are included in other operating income. The grants were in the form of reimbursement for a 
proportion of qualifying expenditure on supported development projects. There are no unfulfilled conditions or other 
contingencies attached to these grants.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
112
6. Operating profit/(loss)
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Operating profit/(loss) is stated after charging/(crediting):
Depreciation of tangible fixed assets (see note 11)
117
76
Depreciation of right of use assets (see note 12)
698
555
Loss on disposal of fixed assets
2
8
Amortisation of intangible assets (see note 13)
224
279
Impairment of intangible assets (see note 13)
132
92
Profit on disposal of intangible assets
—
(68,687)
Settled litigation costs
—
49,337
Requisitioned general meeting
—
490
Realised gain on derivative financial instrument
(1,814)
—
Lease costs of low value/short life lease obligations
16
7
Staff costs (see note 7)
3,396
3,480
Foreign exchange (gains)/losses
(852)
1,747
Research and development expense1
1,630
1,802
Share-based payments
957
953
Employer’s tax on share-based payments
0
(225)
1	
Included within research and development expense are staff costs totalling £1,225,000 (2023: £1,117,000) also included in note 7. Included in research and 
development expenses are £777,000 (2023: £507,000) included in cost of sales.
On 3 February 2023, the group signed agreements with Samsung for a sale of part of the group’s IP portfolio and a licence on the 
remaining IP. The two contracts also ended the litigation against Samsung for the alleged infringement of the group’s IP on a 
no-fault basis. The payment for the agreements was received in two halves: one in February 2023 and one in January 2024. 
Nanoco took out a forward contract to exchange the $71.75 million receipt of the second tranche to GBP at a rate of 1.22 in 
February 24. The information and tables below set out the impact of the transactions on the group’s financial statements for FY24. 
Income statement impact
31 July 
2024
£’000
31 July 
2023
£’000
Revenue (licence fee income)
6,013
2,963
Administrative costs (litigation costs)
—
(49,337)
Profit on disposal of intangible assets
—
68,687
Gain on derivative financial instrument
1,814
—
FX gain on cash held prior to conversion
349
—
Unrealised foreign exchange gain/(loss) on accrued income
504
(1,929)
Net operating profit
8,680
20,384
Interest payable on loan notes
—
(4,725)
Profit before tax
8,680
15,659
The sale of IP was recognised in full in FY23 as a profit on disposal of intangible assets. The litigation costs were also recognised 
in full in FY23 as an administrative expense. The profit on disposal of intangible assets is made up of proceeds of £69,067,000 less 
£356,000 of net book value at the time of sale and £24,000 of IP registration transfer fees. 
The IP licence income will be recognised as revenue over the average remaining life of the patent portfolio as it exists at 
3 February 2023. This is estimated to be 8.8 years from 3 February 2023. The licence income in FY23 reflects the six months of the 
revenue recognition period included in FY23. The estimated remaining life of the patent profile is reviewed each year and as at 
31 July 2024 was concluded to be 8.8 years. The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to the estimate of the remaining life 
of the patent portfolio.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
113
6. Operating profit/(loss) continued
Income statement impact continued
Remaining patent life at start of licence
Impact on
 revenue
2024
£’000
7 years
1,555
8 years
609
9 years
(127)
10 years
(715)
The following table sets out the balance sheet impact of the agreements: 
Balance sheet impact 
 
31 July 
2024
£’000
31 July 
2023
£’000
Proceeds receivable (debtors due within one year)
—
33,041
Deferred income (due within one year)
(5,944)
(6,080)
Deferred income (due after more than one year)
(37,583)
(17,801)
Disposal of intangible assets
—
(356)
Withholding tax asset
4,314
2,269
Cash
58,811
4,458
Net assets
19,598
15,531
The figures above are shown before the impact of any UK taxation. Tax treatment is disclosed in note 9.
Auditors’ remuneration
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Audit services:
– Fees payable to Company auditors for the audit of the Parent and the consolidated accounts
200
102
– Auditing the accounts of subsidiaries pursuant to legislation
62
60
Total audit fees
262
 162
Non-audit services:
– Fees payable for working capital review
100
—
Total auditors’ remuneration
362
162
7. Staff costs
The group’s costs for employees, including Directors, during the year were as follows:
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Wages and salaries
2,925
3,022
Social security costs
295
340
Defined contribution pension costs
176
118
3,396
3,480
Share-based payments
957
953
Social security costs/(credits) on share-based payments
26
(225)
Total staff costs
4,379
4,208
Directors’ remuneration (including benefits in kind) included in the aggregate remuneration above comprised:
Emoluments for qualifying services
961
1,401

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
114
7. Staff costs continued
Emoluments for Directors of the group (excluding social security costs and long-term incentives, but including benefits in kind) 
disclosed above include £323,000 paid to the highest paid Director (2023: £542,000). Details of the compensation of key 
management personnel are described in note 29.
The group made contributions to money purchase pension schemes for two current Directors (2023: two). Aggregate gains made 
by Directors during the year following the exercise of share options were £191,000 (2023: £357,000). An analysis of the highest paid 
Director’s remuneration is included in the Directors’ remuneration report.
The monthly average number of employees during the year (including Directors) was as follows: 
Group
31 July
2024
Number
31 July
2023
Number
Directors
3
3
Laboratory and administrative staff
43
36
46
39
Staff numbers exclude Non-Executive Directors; the prior year comparative has been amended in line with this.
8. Finance income and expense
Group
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Finance income
Interest receivable on bank deposits
835
38
Finance expense
Loan note interest
(517)
(643)
Loan note success fee
—
(4,725)
Unwinding interest on lease liabilities
(103)
(86)
Interest on tax payable
(53)
—
Other interest payable
(4)
(3)
158
(5,419)
The loan note success fee in FY23 was a one-off interest payment to the loan note holders on the successful conclusion to the 
Samsung litigation.
9. Taxation
The tax charge/(credit) is made up as follows:
Group
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Current income tax
UK corporation tax
—
1,072
Research and development income tax credit receivable
(235)
(302)
Foreign taxation
601
291
Provision for unrecoverable foreign tax incurred
2,501
—
Adjustment in respect of prior years
28
—
2,895
1,061
Deferred tax
Origination and reversal of temporary differences
397
(2,522)
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
(174)
(51)
Total income tax charge/(credit)
3,118
(1,512)
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
115
9. Taxation continued
The tax assessed for the year varies from the standard rate of corporation tax as explained below:
Group
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Profit before taxation
1,865
9,573
Tax at standard rate of 25% (2023: 21%)
466
2,011
Effects of:
Expenses not deductible for tax purposes
16
1,237
Capital allowances in excess of depreciation
(10)
13
Research and development tax credit receivable
78
(302)
Share options exercised (CTA 2009 Pt 12 deduction) 
—
(75)
Losses recognised
(412)
(4,636)
Credit for foreign tax expensed
(150)
—
Provision for unrecoverable foreign tax incurred
2,501
—
Foreign tax charges
601
291
Adjustment in respect of prior years 
28
(51)
Tax charge/(credit) in income statement
3,118
(1,512)
The group has accumulated losses available to carry forward against future trading profits of £30.0 million (2023: £31.6 million).
Deferred tax liabilities/(assets) provided/(recognised) at a standard rate of 25% (2023: 25%) are as follows:
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
Accelerated capital allowances 
311
(37)
Short-term temporary differences
(475)
(272)
Tax losses 
(2,186)
(2,264)
(2,350)
(2,573)
Foreign withholding tax receivable – current
(149)
(592)
Foreign withholding tax receivable – non-current
(1,664)
(1,756)
Total foreign withholding tax receivable 
(1,813)
(2,348)
The group also has deferred tax assets, measured at a standard rate of 25% (2023: 25%), in respect of share-based payments 
and tax losses of £5,159,000 (2023: £5,326,000) which have not been recognised as assets as it is not yet sufficiently probable 
that future taxable profits will be available against which the assets can be utilised. The foreign withholding tax receivable 
relates to withholding tax incurred on licence income that will be recovered through tax deductions in future years. The group 
also has foreign withholding tax receivable, measured at a standard rate of 25% (2023: 25%), of £2,501,000 (2023: £nil) which have 
not been recognised as assets as it is not yet sufficiently probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the 
assets can be utilised. There is no expiry for the utilisation of these losses.
The following table demonstrates the sensitivity of the deferred tax assets to the period over which tax losses are recognised as 
described in note 2(e):
Number of years over which losses are recognised
Impact on
 deferred tax 
assets
2024
£’000
2 years
(1,331)
3 years
—
4 years
1,350
5 years
2,715

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
116
10. Earnings per share
Group
31 July
2024
£’000
31 July
2023
£’000
(Loss)/profit for the financial year attributable to equity shareholders
(1,253)
11,085
Share-based payments 
957
953
(Loss)/profit for the financial year before share-based payments
(296)
12,038
Weighted average number of shares
Ordinary shares in issue
288,791,171
322,472,939
Options exercisable at the reporting date
160,664
195,000
Options not yet exercisable at the reporting date
12,717,665
11,720,600
Diluted weighted average number of shares
301,669,500 334,388,539
Adjusted (loss)/profit per share before share-based payments (pence)
(0.10)
3.73
Basic (loss)/profit per share (pence)
(0.43)
3.44
Diluted adjusted (loss)/profit per share before share-based payments (pence)
(0.10)
3.60
Diluted (loss)/profit per share (pence)
(0.43)
3.32
The convertible potential ordinary shares were anti-dilutive in nature, therefore, their effect was not included in the calculation of 
diluted EPS. Adjusted (loss)/profit per share and diluted adjusted (loss)/profit per share are non-GAAP measures included for 
reference.
11. Tangible fixed assets
Group
Laboratory
infrastructure
£’000
Office 
equipment, 
fixtures and 
fittings
£’000
Plant and
machinery
£’000
Total
£’000
Cost
At 1 August 2022
3,338
399
7,228
10,965
Additions
25
50
230
305
Disposals
(1,825)
(88)
(1,385)
(3,298)
At 31 July 2023
1,538
361
6,073
7,972
Additions
375
95
996
1,466
Disposals
—
(29)
(46)
(75)
At 31 July 2024
1,913
427
7,023
9,363
Accumulated depreciation
At 1 August 2022
3,338
388
7,141
10,867
Charged during the year
4
8
64
76
Disposals
(1,825)
(86)
(1,364)
(3,275)
At 31 July 2023
1,517
310
5,841
7,668
Charged during the year
11
27
79
117
Disposals
—
(29)
(44)
(73)
At 31 July 2024
1,528
308
5,876
7,712
Net book value
At 31 July 2024
385
119
1,147
1,651
At 31 July 2023
21
51
232
304
The aggregate original cost of tangible assets now fully depreciated but considered to be still in use is £7,523,000 
(2023: £7,458,000). 
Capital commitments
At 31 July 2024, the group had capital commitments amounting to £159,000 in respect of orders placed for capital expenditure 
(2023: £nil).
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
117
12. Right of use assets
Right of use assets
Office
 equipment
£’000
Property
 leases
£’000
Total
£’000
Cost
At 1 August 2023
34
3,208
3,242
Additions
—
811
811
Disposals
—
—
—
At 31 July 2024
34
4,019
4,053
Accumulated depreciation
At 1 August 2023
6
1,161
1,167
Charged during the year
11
687
698
Disposals
—
—
—
At 31 July 2024
17
1,848
1,865
Net book value
At 31 July 2024
17
2,171
2,188
At 1 August 2023
28
2,047
2,075
Lease liabilities
Total
£’000
Opening liabilities at 1 August 2023
(1,871)
Additions
(596)
Lease payments
661
Interest charge
(103)
Closing liabilities at 31 July 2024
(1,909)
A provision for dilapidations of £659,000 is recognised in relation to the right of use assets; see note 23. 
The group had undiscounted future lease payments due as follows:
Within 1 year
£’000
1 to 2 years
£’000
2 to 3 years
£’000
3 to 4 years
£’000
4 to 5 years
£’000
More than
5 years
£’000
Total
£’000
31 July 2024
709
678
677
—
—
—
2,064
31 July 2023
509
509
500
496
—
—
2,014
The group has several lease contracts that include extension and termination options. These options are negotiated by management 
to provide flexibility in managing the leased-asset portfolio and align with the group’s business needs. Management exercises 
judgement in determining whether these extension and termination options are reasonably certain to be exercised.
Set out below are the undiscounted potential future rental payments related to periods following the exercise date of extension 
and termination options that are not included in the lease term:
31 July 2024
Within
five years
£’000
More than
five years
£’000
Total
£’000
Extension options expected not to be exercised
—
—
—
Termination options expected not to be exercised
1,254
—
1,254
Total
1,254
—
1,254
31 July 2023
Within
five years
£’000
More than
five years
£’000
Total
£’000
Extension options expected not to be exercised
—
—
—
Termination options expected not to be exercised
1,739
—
1,739
Total
1,739
—
1,739

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
118
12. Right of use assets continued
Capital commitments
At 31 July 2024, the group had capital commitments amounting to £nil in respect of new leases (2023: £nil).
13. Intangible assets
Group
Patents
£’000
Cost
At 1 August 2022
4,779
Additions
76
Disposals
(1,034)
At 31 July 2023
3,821
Additions
135
Disposals
(238)
At 31 July 2024
3,718
Accumulated amortisation
At 1 August 2022
3,163
Charged during the year
279
Impairment charge
92
Disposals
(679)
At 31 July 2023
2,855
Charged during the year
224
Impairment charge
132
Disposals
(238)
At 31 July 2024
2,973
Net book value
At 31 July 2024
745
At 31 July 2023
966
Contingent consideration of $150,000 is payable in respect of a purchase of patents made during a previous period. The amount 
is payable if the group reaches a revenue target in a future reporting period.
Intangible assets are amortised on a straight-line basis over ten years. Amortisation provided during the period is recognised in 
administrative expenses. The group does not believe that any of its patents in isolation are material to the business. The aggregate 
original cost of intangible assets now fully depreciated but considered to be still in use is £1,686,000 (2023: £1,470,000). 
The group continues to undertake annual reviews to identify patents which are deemed insufficiently certain to recover their 
carrying value and should therefore be allowed to lapse. The lapses in the current year related to patents whose potential of 
commercial viability was considered to be lower than the costs of maintaining the patents. As a consequence, patents with a 
value of £132,000 (2023: £92,000) have been fully impaired in these financial statements. The impairment charge is recognised 
within administrative expenses.
14. Investment in subsidiaries
Company
Shares
£’000
Share
impairment
£’000
Loans
£’000
Loan
impairment
£’000
Total
£’000
At 1 August 2022
63,235
(24,006)
25,693
(24,175)
40,747
Increase in respect of share-based payments 
—
—
953
—
953
At 31 July 2023
63,235
(24,006)
26,646
(24,175)
41,700
Increase in respect of share-based payments 
—
—
957
—
957
Reversal of previous impairments
—
3,816
—
—
3,816
At 31 July 2024
63,235
(20,190)
27,603
(24,175)
46,473
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
119
14. Investment in subsidiaries continued
By subsidiary
Shares
£’000
Share
impairment
£’000
Loans
£’000
Loan
impairment
£’000
Total
£’000
Nanoco Tech Limited
63,235
(20,190)
—
—
43,045
Nanoco Life Sciences Limited
—
—
20,286
(20,286)
—
Nanoco Technologies Limited 
—
—
7,317
(3,889)
3,428
At 31 July 2024
63,235
(20,190)
27,603
(24,175)
46,473
Accounting standards (IAS 36 Impairment of Assets) require investments in subsidiary undertakings (equity and loans) to be 
carried at the lower of cost or recoverable value. Recoverable value is defined as the higher of fair value less costs of disposal 
(effectively net sale proceeds) and value in use. Indicators of potential impairment noted in IAS 36 (paragraph 12) include, but are 
not limited to, situations where the carrying amount of the net assets of the entity is more than its market value and where 
significant changes with an adverse effect on the entity have taken place during the year.
Consistent with IAS 36 and the indicator of impairment noted above, the Directors have concluded that the reduction in market 
capitalisation of the group as a result of the tender offer and buy-back constitutes an indicator of impairment. As such, a 
valuation exercise was performed by an external party to assess the value of the trading companies and it was concluded that 
recoverable amount was the value in use of £46,473,000. As a result, the Company has recognised an impairment reversal of 
£3,816,000 in the year. This reversal primarily relates to the increased maturity of the markets in which the group operates and 
consequently higher returns from strategic income streams.
The investment balance with Nanoco Technologies Limited arises due to the recharge for share-based payments. There is no 
immediate intention for this to be repaid.
Loans to subsidiary undertakings included in investments carry no interest and are not expected to be repaid. 
Share of issued
ordinary share capital
Subsidiary undertakings
Country of incorporation
Principal activity
31 July
2024
31 July
2023
Nanoco Life Sciences Limited 
England and Wales
Research and development
100%
100%
Nanoco Tech Limited
England and Wales
Holding company
100%
100%
Nanoco Technologies Limited1
England and Wales
Manufacture and development of nanoparticles
100%
100%
Nanoco 2D Materials Limited
England and Wales
Research and development
100%
100%
Nanoco US Inc.2
USA
Management services
100%
100%
All subsidiaries incorporated in England and Wales are registered at Science Centre, The Heath Business and Technical Park, 
Runcorn WA7 4QX. Nanoco US Inc. is registered at 33 Bradford Street, Concord, MA 01742.
With the exception of the two companies footnoted below, all other shareholdings are owned by Nanoco Group plc.
1	 Share capital is owned by Nanoco Tech Limited.
2	 Nanoco US Inc. is a wholly owned subsidiary of Nanoco Tech Limited. It was formed in July 2013 primarily in order to provide the services of US-located 
staff to the rest of the group.
15. Inventories
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Finished goods
—
—
37
—
Raw materials and consumables
305
—
271
—
Total
305
—
308
—
Inventories are measured at the lower of cost and net realisable value. The group uses a standard costing method based on 
latest contractual prices which is reviewed every six months.
A total of £441,000 (2023: £626,000) was included in cost of sales with respect to the cost of inventory expensed during the year. 
Inventories are stated net of an allowance of £204,000 (2023: £111,000) in respect of excess or slow-moving items. Movement in 
the allowance was due to additional provisions in the year as a result of the loss of a key contract.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
120
16. Trade and other receivables
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Trade receivables
301
—
87
—
Accrued income 
40
—
33,139
—
Accrued interest
50
50
—
—
Prepayments
372
—
430
—
Loan to EBT
—
3,322
—
—
Inter-company loan to subsidiary
—
11,497
—
67,220
Less impairment provision
—
(11,497)
—
(14,490)
Other receivables
320
146
330
146
1,083
3,518
33,986
52,876
The impairment of the loan to subsidiary is due to the subsidiary holding insufficient funds to repay the loan on demand. The quantum 
of this provision will be reviewed at each reporting date. The provision has decreased by £2,993,000 in the year due to a higher than 
expected repayment figure. The loan to EBT consists of shares transferred to the EBT for the satisfaction of further option exercises.
Trade receivables are non-interest bearing and are generally due and paid within 30 to 60 days. The Directors consider that the 
carrying amount of trade and other receivables approximates to their fair value. An expected credit loss of £nil (2023: £nil) has 
been recognised at the year end.
The movement in accrued income is due to the receipt of the second tranche of IP sale proceeds from Samsung as described in 
note 6.
Other receivables include an amount of £146,000 (2023: £146,000) relating to consideration due on shares awarded as part of 
the Deferred Bonus Plan.
Trade receivables are denominated in the following currencies:
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
US Dollars
300
—
87
—
Sterling
1
—
—
—
301
—
87
—
At 31 July, the ageing analysis of trade receivables was as follows:
Not
yet due
£’000
Due
£’000
Past due
> 120
£’000
Total
£’000
2024
1
296
4
301
2023
58
29
—
87
17. Cash and cash equivalents 
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Cash and cash equivalents
20,293
20,164
8,207
105
Under IAS 7, cash held on long-term deposits (being deposits with original maturity of greater than three months and no more 
than twelve months) that cannot readily be converted into cash must be classified as a short-term investment. There were no 
such deposits at 31 July 2024 (2023: none).
An analysis of cash, cash equivalents and deposits by denominated currency is given in note 27.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
121
18. Trade and other payables
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Current
Trade payables
752
—
864
—
Other payables
182
146
338
146
Accruals
644
4
1,581
381
Inter-company payable
—
628
—
626
1,578
778
2,783
1,153
The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other payables approximates to their fair value. The average credit 
period taken is 39 days (2023: 67 days). Interest is not charged on inter-company loans (2023: no interest). 
19. Loans
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Convertible Series A loan note 2028 
—
—
400
—
Accrued interest on Convertible Series A loan note 2028
—
—
157
—
Loan notes (net of costs)
—
—
2,989
2,989
Accrued interest on loan notes
—
—
1,015
1,015
—
—
4,561
4,004
The loan note issued by Nanoco 2D Materials Limited is unsecured, bears a fixed interest at 6.5% per annum and was fully repaid 
in February 2024.
On 26 July 2021, there was a non-dilutive loan note subscription with two major shareholders, raising net proceeds before fees 
(£161,000) of £3.15 million on a loan note price of £4.50 million. The loan notes are unsecured and have a nominal value of £1 each 
and an arrangement fee of 1.4% of the nominal amount and are repayable three years from completion. The subscription price of 
70 pence represents a discount to the nominal value of £1 equivalent to 12% interest per annum. The Company may redeem the 
loan notes at any time prior to their maturity at 80% of nominal value during the first year of the term, 90% at any time in year two, 
and 100% at any time in year three. The loan notes were fully repaid in April 2024. There have been no changes in liabilities arising 
from financing activities other than described in this note.
Group
£’000
Company
£’000
Movement in loans
At 1 August 2022
3,919
3,392
Accrued interest on loan note
612
612
Success fee due following Samsung agreement
4,725
4,725
Success fee paid
(4,725)
(4,725)
Interest on convertible loan
30
—
At 31 July 2023
4,561
4,004
Accrued interest on loan note
496
496
Loan note paid
(4,500)
(4,500)
Interest on convertible loan
21
—
Convertible loan paid
(578)
—
At 31 July 2024
—
—

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
122
20. Deferred revenue
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Current
Upfront licence fees
5,934
—
6,123
—
Non-current
Upfront licence fees
37,594
—
17,801
—
43,528
—
23,924
—
Deferred revenue arises under IFRS where upfront licence fees are accounted for on a straight-line basis over the initial term of 
the contract or where performance criteria have not been satisfied in the accounting period. 
31 July 2024
£’000
31 July 2023
£’000
Opening deferred revenue
23,924
604
Revenue deferred
25,660
26,843
Revenue booked current year
(6,056)
(3,523)
Closing deferred revenue
43,528
23,924
The movements in deferred revenue in the year relates to the Samsung licence agreement and are described in detail in note 6. 
Of the revenue recognised in the current year £3,050,000 relates to revenue deferred at the start of the year.
21. Lease liabilities
31 July 2024
Group
£’000
31 July 2024
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Group
£’000
31 July 2023
Company
£’000
Current
Property leases
612
—
448
—
Equipment leases
9
—
8
—
Total current
621
—
456
—
Non-current
Property leases
1,284
—
1,399
—
Equipment leases
4
—
16
—
Total non-current
1,288
—
1,415
—
22. Issued equity capital
Group
Number
Share
capital
£’000
Share
premium
£’000
Capital 
redemption 
reserve
£’000
Reverse
acquisition
reserve
£’000
Total
£’000
Allotted, called up and fully paid ordinary shares of 10p
At 1 August 2022
322,445,744
32,244
121,145
—
(77,868)
75,521
Capital reduction
—
—
(121,145)
—
—
(121,145)
Shares issued on exercise of options
1,985,206
199
—
—
—
199
At 31 July 2023
324,430,950
32,443
—
—
(77,868)
(45,425)
Tender offer shares cancelled
(111,250,000)
(11,125)
—
11,125
—
—
Buy-back shares cancelled
(10,609,453)
(1,061)
—
1,061
—
—
At 31 July 2024
202,571,497
20,257
—
12,186
(77,868)
(45,425)
The balances classified as share capital and share premium include the total net proceeds (nominal value and share premium 
respectively) on issue of the Company’s equity share capital, comprising ordinary shares.
On 18 July 2023, the Company undertook a capital reduction which cancelled the share premium reserve.
The capital redemption reserve is the nominal value of shares cancelled by the company following re-purchase.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
123
22. Issued equity capital continued
On 12 April 2024, the Company purchased 125,000,000 of its own shares via a tender offer priced at 24 pence per share. 
111,250,000 of these shares were subsequently cancelled while the remaining 13,750,000 were transferred to the EBT in order to 
satisfy future share option exercises. The existing 12,222 treasury shares were transferred to the EBT at the same time.
Between 11 April 2024 and 31 July 2024 the Company purchased a further 10,792,463 of its own shares via an on-market buy-back; 
10,609,453 of these shares were cancelled in the year with the remaining 183,010 cancelled after the year end. 
The retained loss and other equity balances recognised in the group financial statements reflect the consolidated retained loss 
and other equity balances of Nanoco Tech Limited immediately before the business combination which was reported in the year 
ended 31 July 2009. The consolidated results for the period from 1 August 2008 to the date of the acquisition by the Company 
are those of Nanoco Tech Limited. However, the equity structure appearing in the group financial statements reflects the equity 
structure of the legal Parent, including the equity instruments issued under the share-for-share exchange to effect the transaction. 
The effect of using the equity structure of the legal Parent gives rise to an adjustment to the group’s issued equity capital in the 
form of a reverse acquisition reserve.
23. Provisions
Property 
dilapidations
£’000
Total
£’000
At 1 August 2023
445
445
Provided during the period
214
214
At 31 July 2024
659
659
The provision relates to the potential dilapidation costs from the exit of all its premises. Because of the long-term nature of the 
liability, there is uncertainty in estimating the provision. The extent and cost of potential dilapidation costs represent a best 
estimate applied across the group’s lease portfolio based on past experience, the extent of remediation work required and 
the expected timing of activity, for which there is a high level of uncertainty.
During the year, an additional provision was included in relation to the new lease for extra space at our Runcorn site.
24. Share-based payment reserve
Group and Company
£’000
At 1 August 2022
4,916
Share-based payments 
953
Exercise of share options
(259)
At 31 July 2023
5,610
Share-based payments 
957
Exercise of share options
(207)
Transfer of expired options
(4,788)
At 31 July 2024
1,572
The share-based payment reserve accumulates the corresponding credit entry in respect of share-based payment charges. 
Movements in the reserve are disclosed in the consolidated statement of changes in equity.
A charge of £957,000 has been recognised in the statement of comprehensive income for the year (2023: charge of £953,000).
£4,788,000 of the reserve has been transferred to retained earnings in relation to options that expired or lapsed in the current 
and previous years.
Share option schemes
The group operates the following share option schemes, all of which are operated as Enterprise Management Incentive (“EMI”) 
schemes insofar as the share options being issued meet the EMI criteria as defined by HM Revenue & Customs. Share options issued 
that do not meet EMI criteria are issued as unapproved share options but are subject to the same exercise performance conditions. 

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
124
24. Share-based payment reserve continued
Share option schemes continued
Nanoco Group plc 2015 Long Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”)
Grants in December 2015 (fully lapsed), April 2016 (fully lapsed), November 2017 (fully lapsed), November 2018 (fully lapsed), 
October 2020 (fully lapsed), November 2021 (fully lapsed), December 2021, October 2022 and January 2024
Following approval of the new scheme at the 2015 AGM, share options have been granted to Executive Directors and key staff on 
a number of occasions at nil cost and have an exercise price of £nil. The fair value benefit is measured using a stochastic model, 
taking into account the terms and conditions upon which the share options are issued. In each case, the options vest at the end 
of the three-year performance period subject to meeting the performance criteria (as detailed in the Directors’ remuneration 
report) in each reporting period and are exercisable after a two-year holding period until the tenth anniversary of the award. 
Deferred Bonus Plan (“DBP”)
On 9 November 2021, awards in the form of nil-cost options were granted to the Executive Directors and certain other employees 
in respect of 100% of their bonuses for the year ended 31 July 2021 which are delivered in the form of a share award under the 
DBP. These awards vested in FY24, after the required two-year holding period.
On 27 October 2022, awards in the form of nil-cost options were granted to the Executive Directors and certain other employees 
in respect of 100% of their bonuses for the year ended 31 July 2022 which are delivered in the form of a share award under the 
DBP. The awards will vest in FY25, after the required two-year holding period.
On 23 January 2024, awards in the form of nil-cost options were granted to the Executive Directors and certain other employees 
in respect of 33% of their bonuses for the year ended 31 July 2023 which are delivered in the form of a share award under the DBP. 
The awards will vest in FY26, after the required two-year holding period.
The following tables illustrate the number and weighted average exercise prices of, and movements in, share options during the year:
Group and Company
2024 total
Number
2023 total
Number
Outstanding at 1 August
11,915,600
19,820,352
Granted during the year
9,056,742
5,314,890
Exercised during the year
(928,580)
(1,985,206)
Forfeited during the year
(1,797,099)
(237,388)
Expired during the year
(35,000)
(2,853,193)
Lapsed during the year
(5,333,334)
(8,143,855)
Outstanding at 31 July 2024
12,878,329
11,915,600
Exercisable at 31 July 2024
160,664
195,000
Weighted average exercise price of options
Group and Company
2024
Pence
2023
Pence
Outstanding at 1 August
1.0
8.9
Granted during the year
—
—
Exercised during the year
—
—
Expired during the year
89.0
57.0
Lapsed during the year
0.1
0.2
Outstanding at 31 July 2024
0.7
1.0
The weighted average exercise price of options granted during the year to 31 July 2024 was £nil (2023: £nil). The range of exercise 
prices for options outstanding at the end of the year was £nil–56.5 pence (2023: £nil–89 pence). The weighted average exercise 
price of options exercisable at 31 July 2024 was 53 pence (2023: 64 pence).
For the share options outstanding as at 31 July 2024, the weighted average remaining contractual life is 8.9 years (2023: 8.6 years). 
The aggregate fair value of options issued in the year was £1,368,000 (2023: £1,550,000).
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
125
24. Share-based payment reserve continued
Weighted average exercise price of options continued
The following table lists the inputs to the models used for the years ended 31 July 2024 and 31 July 2023:
Market 
performance-linked grants
Non-market
performance-linked grants
Group and Company
2024
2023
2024
2023
Expected volatility
57.55%
89.5%
N/A
N/A
Risk-free interest rate
4.18%
3.19%
N/A
N/A
Expected life of options (years average)
3
3
2
2
Weighted average exercise price
£nil
£nil
£nil
£nil
Weighted average share price at date of grant
20.5p
35.6p
20.5p
35.6p
Expected dividends
£nil
£nil
£nil
£nil
Model used
Stochastic
Stochastic
Black-Scholes
Black-Scholes
The expected life of the options is based on historical data and is not necessarily indicative of exercise patterns that may occur. 
The expected volatility reflects the assumption that the historical volatility is indicative of future trends, which may also not 
necessarily be the actual outcome.
Certain awards are subject to a holding period after vesting. A Finnerty model has been used to determine a discount for the 
lack of marketability of the shares.
Sensitivity analysis to movement in non-market vesting assumptions
The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in the non-market vesting assumptions, with all 
other variables held constant, of the group’s share-based payment charge for the year:
Increase/(decrease) at vesting %
Impact on 
share-based
payment expense
2024
£’000
100%
142
60%
2
25%
(121)
0%
(209)
25. Merger reserve and capital redemption reserve
Merger reserve
Group
£’000
At 1 August 2022, 31 July 2023 and 31 July 2024
(1,242)
The merger reserve arises under section 612 of the Companies Act 2006 on the shares issued by Nanoco Tech Limited to acquire 
Nanoco Technologies Limited as part of a simple group reorganisation on 27 June 2007.
Capital redemption reserve
Company
£’000
At 1 August 2022 
4,402
Capital reduction
(4,402)
At 31 July 2023
—
Cancellation of shares following tender offer and buy-back
12,186
At 31 July 2024
12,186
The capital redemption reserve arises from the off-market purchase of deferred shares on 4 May 2005 and their subsequent 
cancellation. On 18 July 2023, the Company undertook a capital reduction which cancelled the capital redemption reserve.
The reserve was reinstated on 12 April 2024 following the tender offer and buy-back and subsequent cancellation of shares 
as detailed in note 22.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
126
26. Movement in retained earnings/(accumulated losses)
Group
Profit
and
loss
£’000
Foreign 
currency
translation
reserve
£’000
Treasury
shares
£’000
Shares held 
by EBT
£’000
Total
(accumulated
losses)/retained
earnings
£’000
At 1 August 2022
(74,699)
4
(20)
—
(74,715)
Profit for the year
11,085
—
—
—
11,085
Capital reduction
121,145
—
—
—
121,145
Issue of shares to EBT
—
—
—
(199)
(199)
Shares utilised by EBT to satisfy options
60
—
—
94
154
At 31 July 2023
57,591
4
(20)
(105)
57,470
Profit for the year
(1,253)
—
—
—
(1,253)
Shares utilised by EBT to satisfy options
—
—
—
105
105
Transfer of expired options
4,788
—
—
—
4,788
Tender offer and share buy-back
(29,703)
—
(8)
(3,320)
(33,031)
Share option exercise
5
—
—
—
5
At 31 July 2024
31,428
4
(28)
(3,320)
28,084
Profit and loss represents the cumulative profit/(loss) attributable to the equity holders of the Parent Company.
At 31 July 2024, 13,762,222 shares in the Company were held by the EBT for future distribution to employees on the exercise 
of share options (2023: 1,050,282). In addition there are 183,010 (2023: 12,222) treasury shares not held by the EBT. 
Company
Accumulated
 losses
£’000
Treasury
shares
£’000
Total
(accumulated
losses)/retained
 earnings
£’000
At 1 August 2022
(120,298)
(20)
(120,318)
Profit for the year 
46,182
—
46,182
Capital reduction
125,547
—
125,547
Exercise of share options
60
—
60
At 31 July 2023
51,491
(20)
51,471
Profit for the year 
8,807
—
8,807
Transfer of expired options
4,788
—
4,788
Tender offer and share buy-back
(29,703)
(8)
(29,711)
Exercise of share options
7
—
7
At 31 July 2024
35,390
(28)
35,362
27. Financial risk management
Overview
This note presents information about the group’s exposure to various kinds of financial risks, the group’s objectives, policies 
and processes for measuring and managing risk, and the group’s management of capital.
The Board of Directors has overall responsibility for the establishment and oversight of the group’s risk management framework. 
The Executive Directors report regularly to the Board on group risk management.
Capital risk management
The Company reviews its forecast capital requirements on a half-yearly basis to ensure that entities in the group will be able to 
continue as a going concern while maximising the return to stakeholders.
The capital structure of the group consists of equity attributable to equity holders of the Parent, comprising issued share capital, 
reserves and accumulated losses as disclosed in notes 22 to 26 and in the group statement of changes in equity. At 31 July 2024 
total equity was -£17,011,000 (2023: £16,413,000).
The Company is not subject to externally imposed capital requirements.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
127
27. Financial risk management continued
Liquidity risk
The group’s approach to managing liquidity is to ensure that, as far as possible, it will always have sufficient liquidity to meet its 
liabilities when due, under both normal and stressed conditions, without incurring unacceptable losses or risking damage to the 
group’s reputation.
The group manages all of its external bank relationships centrally in accordance with defined treasury policies. The policies 
include the minimum acceptable credit rating of relationship banks and financial transaction authority limits. Any material 
change to the group’s principal banking facility requires Board approval. The group seeks to mitigate the risk of bank failure 
by ensuring that it maintains relationships with a number of investment-grade banks.
Categorisation of financial instruments
Financial assets/(liabilities)
Group 
financial
assets at
amortised
cost 
£’000
Group
financial
liabilities at
amortised
cost 
£’000
Financial assets 
and liabilities at 
amortised cost
Group
£’000
Company
£’000
31 July 2024
Cash and cash equivalents
20,293
—
20,293
20,164
Trade receivables
301
—
301
—
Other receivables
174
—
174
—
Inter-company short-term loan to subsidiary
—
—
—
11,497
Less impairment provision
—
—
—
(11,497)
Trade and other payables
—
(1,432)
(1,432)
(4)
Lease liabilities
—
(1,909)
(1,909)
—
Inter-company payable
—
—
—
(628)
20,768
(3,341)
17,427
19,532
Financial assets/(liabilities)
Group
financial
assets at
amortised
cost 
£’000
Group
financial
liabilities at
amortised
cost 
£’000
Financial assets 
and liabilities at 
amortised cost
Group
£’000
Company
£’000
31 July 2023
Cash and cash equivalents
8,207
—
8,207
105
Trade receivables
87
—
87
—
Other receivables
184
—
184
—
Inter-company short-term loan to subsidiary
—
—
—
67,220
Less impairment provision
—
—
—
(14,490)
Trade and other payables
—
(2,637)
(2,637)
(378)
Lease liabilities
—
(1,871)
(1,871)
—
Loan notes and accrued interest
—
(4,561)
(4,561)
(4,004)
Inter-company payable
—
—
—
(626)
8,478
(9,069)
(591)
47,827
The values disclosed in the above table are carrying values. The Board considers that the carrying amount of financial assets 
and liabilities approximates to their fair value. 
The main risks arising from the group’s financial instruments are credit risk and foreign currency risk. The Board of Directors reviews 
and agrees policies for managing each of these risks which are summarised below.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
128
27. Financial risk management continued
Credit risk
The group’s principal financial assets are cash, cash equivalents and deposits. The group seeks to limit the level of credit risk on 
the cash balances by only depositing surplus liquid funds with multiple counterparty banks that have investment-grade credit 
ratings. The maximum exposure to credit risk in relation to cash, cash equivalents and deposits is the carrying value at the 
balance sheet date.
The group trades only with recognised, creditworthy third parties. Receivable and accrued income balances are monitored on 
an ongoing basis with the result that the group’s exposure to bad debts is not significant. The group’s maximum exposure is the 
carrying amount as disclosed in note 16, which was neither past due nor impaired. All trade receivables and accrued income 
are ultimately overseen by the CFO and are managed on a day-to-day basis by the UK finance team. Credit limits are set as 
deemed appropriate for the customer.
Foreign currency risk 
The group is exposed to currency risk on sales and purchases that are denominated in a currency other than the respective 
functional currency of the Company. These are primarily US Dollars (“USD”) and Euros. Transactions outside of these currencies 
are limited.
Almost all of the Company’s revenue is denominated in USD. The group purchases some raw materials, certain services and some 
assets in USD which partly offsets its USD revenue, thereby reducing net foreign exchange exposure.
The group may use forward exchange contracts as an economic hedge against currency risk, where cash flows can be judged 
with reasonable certainty. Foreign exchange swaps and options may be used to hedge foreign currency receipts in the event 
that the timing of the receipt is less certain. There were no open forward contracts as at 31 July 2024 or at 31 July 2023.
The split of group assets between Sterling and other currencies at the year end is analysed as follows (Company assets are all 
in Sterling):
31 July 2024
31 July 2023
Group
GBP
£’000
EUR
£’000
USD
£’000
Total
£’000
GBP
£’000
EUR
£’000
USD
£’000
Total
£’000
Cash and cash equivalents
20,255
—
38
20,293
7,948
1
258
8,207
Trade receivables
1
—
300
301
—
—
87
87
Accrued income
—
—
40
40
97
—
33,042
33,139
Trade payables
(712)
(11)
(29)
(752)
(775)
(5)
(84)
(864)
19,544
(11)
349
19,882
7,270
(4)
33,303
40,569
All other categories of assets and liabilities in the statement of financial position are denominated in Sterling.
Sensitivity analysis to movement in exchange rates
The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in the Sterling rate against other currencies 
used within the business, with all other variables held constant, of the group’s loss before tax (due to foreign exchange translation 
of monetary assets and liabilities) and the group’s equity.
Increase/(decrease)
Impact on 
loss before 
tax and 
group equity
2024
£’000
Impact on 
loss before 
tax and 
group equity
2023
£’000
10%
38
3,700
5%
18
1,753
(5%) 
(16)
(1,586)
(10%)
(31)
(3,027)
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
129
27. Financial risk management continued
Interest rate risk
As the group’s borrowing is in the form of loan notes with a fixed rate of return and which are held at amortised cost, interest rate 
risk is limited to the reduction of interest received on cash surpluses held at bank which receive a floating rate of interest. The group’s 
financial instruments with interest rate risk exposure and maximum exposures are set out below:
31 July 2024
31 July 2023
Group
Fixed
rate
£’000
Floating
rate
£’000
Total
£’000
Fixed
rate
£’000
Floating
rate
£’000
Total
£’000
Cash and cash equivalents 
—
20,293
20,293
—
8,207
8,207
Loan notes
—
—
—
4,561
—
4,561
Company
Cash and cash equivalents 
—
20,164
20,164
—
105
105
Loan notes
—
—
—
4,004
—
4,004
Sensitivity analysis to movement in interest rates
The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in the UK base rate, with all other variables held 
constant, of the group’s loss before tax (due to finance income) and the group’s equity.
Increase/(decrease)
Impact on 
profit before 
tax and 
group equity
2024
£’000
Impact on 
profit before 
tax and 
group equity
2023
£’000
1%
203
82
0.5%
101
41
(0.5%) 
(101)
(41)
(1%)
(203)
(82)
Maturity profile
Set out below is the maturity profile of the group’s financial liabilities at 31 July 2024 and 31 July 2023 based on contractual 
undiscounted payments, including contractual interest.
2024
Up to
one year
£’000
One to
five
years
£’000
Greater
than five
years
£’000
Total
£’000
Financial liabilities
Trade and other payables
1,432
—
—
1,432
Lease liabilities
709
1,354
—
2,063
2,141
1,354
—
3,495
2023
Up to
one year
£’000
One to
five
years
£’000
Greater
than five
years
£’000
Total
£’000
Financial liabilities
Trade and other payables
2,521
445
—
2,966
Lease liabilities
509
1,505
—
2,014
Loans (including contractual interest)
4,500
751
—
5,251
7,530
2,701
—
10,231
Trade and other payables are due within three months.
As all financial assets are expected to mature within the next twelve months, an aged analysis of financial assets has not 
been presented.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
130
28. Related party transactions
The group
There were no sales to, purchases from or, at the year end, balances with any related party.
The Company
The following table summarises inter-company balances at the year end between Nanoco Group plc and subsidiary entities:
Notes
31 July 
2024
£’000
31 July 
2023
£’000
Loan from Nanoco Group plc to:
 
Nanoco Technologies Limited2
16
11,497
67,220
Less impairment provision
16
(11,497)
(14,490)
—
52,730
Inter-company payable by Nanoco Group plc to:
 
Nanoco Tech Limited
18
(450)
(450)
Nanoco US Inc.
18
(178)
(176)
2	 The movement in the short-term loan due from Nanoco Technologies Limited relates to transfers of cash balances between the entities for the purposes 
of investing short-term funds and the funding of trading losses.
None of the loans are interest bearing.
There is no controlling party of the group or Company.
29. Compensation of key management personnel (including Directors)
Company
31 July 
2024
£’000
31 July 
2023
£’000
Short-term employee benefits
765
753
Pension costs
62
56
Cash bonus
—
549
Share-based payments
197
283
1,024
1,641
The key management team comprises the Executive Directors and one member of staff (2023: one) who is not a Director 
of the Company. The staff member of the team is the Operations Director.
Notes to the financial statements continued

Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
131
30. Reconciliation of net debt
Liabilities from financing activities
Group
Loans
£’000
Lease
liabilities
£’000
Total 
liabilities from
financing
activities
£’000
Cash 
and cash
equivalents
£’000
Total 
net debt
£’000
At 1 August 2022
(3,919)
(169)
(4,088)
6,762
2,674
Financing cash flows
4,725
549
5,274
1,263
6,537
New leases
— 
(2,165)
(2,165)
— 
(2,165)
Foreign exchange adjustments
— 
— 
— 
182
182
Interest expense
(5,367)
(86)
(5,453)
— 
(5,453)
At 31 July 2023
(4,561)
(1,871)
(6,432)
8,207
1,775
Financing cash flows
5,078
661
5,739
11,743
17,482
New leases
— 
(596)
(596)
—
(596)
Foreign exchange adjustments
— 
— 
— 
343
343
Interest expense
(517)
(103)
(620)
—
(620)
At 31 July 2024
— 
(1,909)
(1,909)
20,293
18,384
Company
Loans
£’000
Cash 
and cash
equivalents
£’000
Total 
net debt
£’000
Net debt as at 1 August 2022
(3,392)
5,497
2,105
Financing cash flows
4,725
(5,402)
(677)
Foreign exchange adjustments
— 
10
10
Interest expense
(5,337)
— 
(5,337)
Net debt at 31 July 2023
(4,004)
105
(3,899)
Financing cash flows
4,500
19,709
24,209
Foreign exchange adjustments
—
350
350
Interest expense
(496)
—
(496)
Net debt at 31 July 2024
—
20,164
20,164
31. Subsequent events
Between 1 August 2024 and 29 October 2024, the Company returned a further £1.0 million to shareholders through the completion 
of the on-market buy-back. This constituted 7,780,449 shares which were subsequently cancelled alongside the 183,010 shares 
held at 31 July 2024, leaving the Company with 194,608,038 shares in issue.
On 30 August 2024, the group announced it had received confirmation that its European customer would be placing no further 
orders for the first generation sensing product. We have considered the impact across the financial statements and the lack of 
orders for first generation sensing products was considered to be an adjusting event in relation to the realisable value of the 
stock held at 31 July 2024. As a consequence, an additional provision of £140,000 was included in the accounts. There is no 
further impact on the numbers shown in these accounts.
On 30 August 2024, the group also announced the termination of the two-year Joint Development Agreement with its European 
customer. Under IAS 10, the termination of the Joint Development Agreement is a non-adjusting event for the purposes of these 
financial statements. There is no post year-end impact on the carrying value of the groups assets as the related assets can be 
used in other areas of the business and their recoverability is supported by the remaining business.
On 3 October 2024, the group announced measures to reduce its cost base, including reducing headcount through a redundancy 
process. This is considered to be a non-adjusting event in these financial statements but will reduce the group’s annualised cost 
base by £2.6 million following a restructuring cost of £0.1 million.
On 25 October 2024, the group received a Requisition from a shareholder for a general meeting. On 15 November 2024 a circular 
was issued in response to the requisition. There is no impact on the financial statements of this event.

Financial statements
Nanoco Group plc  –  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
132
Investor information
Directors 
Dr Christopher Richards 	
	
Non-Executive Chairman 
Dmitry Shashkov 	
	
Chief Executive Officer 
Dr Nigel Pickett 	
	
Chief Technology Officer 
Liam Gray	
	
Chief Financial Officer
Dr Alison Fielding 	
	
Senior Independent and
Non-Executive Director
Chris Batterham 	
	
Non-Executive Director
Dieter May 	
	
Non-Executive Director
Dr Jalal Bagherli	
	
Non-Executive Director
Secretary 
Liam Gray 
Registered office 
Science Centre
The Heath Business and Technical Park
Heath Road South
Runcorn WA7 4QX
Website 
www.nanocotechnologies.com 
Independent auditors 
Forvis Mazars LLP 
1 St Peter’s Square
Manchester M2 3DE 
 
Legal adviser 
Reed Smith LLP 
The Broadgate Tower 
20 Primrose Street 
London EC2A 2RS 
Investor relations 
Sodali & Co
122 Leadenhall Street
London EC4Y 0AH
Corporate brokers 
Cavendish Capital Markets 
One Bartholomew Close
London EC1A 7BL
Registrar 
Neville Registrars 
Neville House 
Steelpark Road 
Halesowen B62 8HD

CBP028125
Nanoco Group plc’s commitment to environmental issues is reflected in 
this Annual Report, which has been printed on Arena Extra White Smooth, 
an FSC® certified material.
This document was printed by Pureprint Group using its environmental print 
technology, with 99% of dry waste diverted from landfill, minimising the impact 
of printing on the environment. The printer is a CarbonNeutral® company.
Both the printer and the paper mill are registered to ISO 14001. 

Nanoco Group plc
The Science Centre
The Heath Business and 
Technical Park
Runcorn
WA7 4QX